gdb
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24 @syncodeindex tp cp
25
26 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
27 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
28 @syncodeindex vr cp
29 @syncodeindex fn cp
30
31 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
32 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
33 @set EDITION Ninth
34
35 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
36 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
37
38 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
39
40 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
41 @c manuals to an info tree.
42 @dircategory Software development
43 @direntry
44 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
45 @end direntry
46
47 @copying
48 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996,
49 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009
50 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
51
52 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
53 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
54 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
55 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
56 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
57 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
58
59 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
60 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
61 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
62 @end copying
63
64 @ifnottex
65 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
66
67 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
68 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
69 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
70 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
71 @end ifset
72 Version @value{GDBVN}.
73
74 @insertcopying
75 @end ifnottex
76
77 @titlepage
78 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
79 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
80 @sp 1
81 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
82 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
83 @sp 1
84 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
85 @end ifset
86 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
87 @page
88 @tex
89 {\parskip=0pt
90 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
91 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
92 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
93 }
94 @end tex
95
96 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
97 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
98 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
99 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
100 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
101
102 @insertcopying
103 @page
104 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
105 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
106 software in general. We will miss him.
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
143 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
144 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
145
146 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
147
148 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
149 * Altering:: Altering execution
150 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
151 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
152 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
153 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
154 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
155 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
156 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
157 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
158 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
159 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
160 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
161
162 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
163
164 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
165 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
166 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
167 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
168 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
169 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
170 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
171 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
172 @value{GDBN}
173 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
174 the operating system
175 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
176 how you can copy and share GDB
177 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
178 * Index:: Index
179 @end menu
180
181 @end ifnottex
182
183 @contents
184
185 @node Summary
186 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
187
188 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
189 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
190 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
191
192 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
193 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
194
195 @itemize @bullet
196 @item
197 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
198
199 @item
200 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
201
202 @item
203 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
204
205 @item
206 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
207 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
208 @end itemize
209
210 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
211 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
212 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
213
214 @cindex Modula-2
215 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
216 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
217
218 @cindex Pascal
219 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
220 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
221 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
222 syntax.
223
224 @cindex Fortran
225 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
226 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
227 underscore.
228
229 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
230 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
231
232 @menu
233 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
234 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
235 @end menu
236
237 @node Free Software
238 @unnumberedsec Free Software
239
240 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
241 General Public License
242 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
243 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
244 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
245 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
246 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
247 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
248
249 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
250 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
251 from anyone else.
252
253 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
254
255 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
256 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
257 include with the free software. Many of our most important
258 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
259 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
260 when an important free software package does not come with a free
261 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
262 gaps today.
263
264 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
265 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
266 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
267 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
268 them from the free software world.
269
270 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
271 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
272 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
273 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
274 contract to make it non-free.
275
276 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
277 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
278 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
279 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
280 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
281 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
282 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
283
284 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
285 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
286 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
287 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
288
289 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
290 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
291 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
292 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
293 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
294 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
295 community.
296
297 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
298 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
299 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
300 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
301 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
302 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
303 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
304 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
305 of the manual.
306
307 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
308 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
309 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
310 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
311 manual to replace it.
312
313 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
314 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
315 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
316 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
317 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
318 the free software community.
319
320 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
321 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
322 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
323 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
324 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
325 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
326 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
327 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
328 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
329
330 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
331 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
332 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
333 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
334 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
335 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
336 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
337 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
338
339 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
340 published by other publishers, at
341 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
342
343 @node Contributors
344 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
345
346 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
347 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
348 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
349 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
350 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
351 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
352 blow-by-blow account.
353
354 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
355
356 @quotation
357 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
358 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
359 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
360 @end quotation
361
362 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
363 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
364 releases:
365 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
366 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
367 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
368 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
369 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
370 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
371 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
372 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
373 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
374
375 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
376 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
377
378 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
379 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
380 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
381 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
382 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
383
384 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
385 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
386 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
387
388 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
389 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
390
391 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
392
393 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
394 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
395 support.
396 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
397 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
398 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
399 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
400 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
401 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
402 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
403 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
404 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
405 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
406 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
407 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
408 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
409 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
410 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
411 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
412
413 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
414
415 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
416 libraries.
417
418 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
419 about several machine instruction sets.
420
421 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
422 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
423 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
424 and RDI targets, respectively.
425
426 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
427 command-line editing and command history.
428
429 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
430 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
431
432 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
433 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
434 symbols.
435
436 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
437 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
438
439 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
440
441 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
442 processors.
443
444 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
445
446 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
447
448 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
449
450 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
451 watchpoints.
452
453 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
454
455 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
456
457 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
458 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
459
460 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
461 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
462 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
463 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
464 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
465 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
466 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
467
468 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
469 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
470
471 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
472 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
473 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
474 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
475 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
476 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
477 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
478 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
479 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
480 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
481 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
482 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
483 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
484 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
485 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
486
487 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
488 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
489
490 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
491 Hat.
492
493 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
494 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
495 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
496 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
497 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
498 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
499
500 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
501 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
502 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
503 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
504 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
505 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
506 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
507 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
508 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
509 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
510 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
511 Weigand.
512
513 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
514 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
515 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
516 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
517
518 @node Sample Session
519 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
520
521 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
522 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
523 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
524
525 @iftex
526 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
527 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
528 @end iftex
529
530 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
531 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
532
533 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
534 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
535 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
536 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
537 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
538 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
539 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
540 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
541 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
542
543 @smallexample
544 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
545 $ @b{./m4}
546 @b{define(foo,0000)}
547
548 @b{foo}
549 0000
550 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
551
552 @b{bar}
553 0000
554 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
555
556 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
557 @b{baz}
558 @b{Ctrl-d}
559 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
560 @end smallexample
561
562 @noindent
563 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
564
565 @smallexample
566 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
567 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
568 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
569 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
570 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
571 the conditions.
572 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
573 for details.
574
575 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
576 (@value{GDBP})
577 @end smallexample
578
579 @noindent
580 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
581 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
582 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
583 that examples fit in this manual.
584
585 @smallexample
586 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
587 @end smallexample
588
589 @noindent
590 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
591 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
592 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
593 @code{break} command.
594
595 @smallexample
596 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
597 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
598 @end smallexample
599
600 @noindent
601 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
602 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
603 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
604
605 @smallexample
606 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
607 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
608 @b{define(foo,0000)}
609
610 @b{foo}
611 0000
612 @end smallexample
613
614 @noindent
615 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
616 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
617 context where it stops.
618
619 @smallexample
620 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
621
622 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
623 at builtin.c:879
624 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
625 @end smallexample
626
627 @noindent
628 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
629 the next line of the current function.
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
633 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
634 : nil,
635 @end smallexample
636
637 @noindent
638 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
639 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
640 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
641 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
642
643 @smallexample
644 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
645 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
646 at input.c:530
647 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
648 @end smallexample
649
650 @noindent
651 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
652 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
653 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
654 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
655 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
656 stack frame for each active subroutine.
657
658 @smallexample
659 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
660 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
661 at input.c:530
662 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
663 at builtin.c:882
664 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
665 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
666 at macro.c:71
667 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
668 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
669 @end smallexample
670
671 @noindent
672 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
673 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
674 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
675
676 @smallexample
677 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
678 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
679 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
680 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
681 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
682 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
683 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
684 : xstrdup(rq);
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
686 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
687 @end smallexample
688
689 @noindent
690 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
691 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
692 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
693 (@code{print}) to see their values.
694
695 @smallexample
696 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
697 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
698 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
699 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
700 @end smallexample
701
702 @noindent
703 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
704 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
705 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
706
707 @smallexample
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
709 533 xfree(rquote);
710 534
711 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
712 : xstrdup (lq);
713 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
714 : xstrdup (rq);
715 537
716 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
717 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
718 540 @}
719 541
720 542 void
721 @end smallexample
722
723 @noindent
724 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
725 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
726
727 @smallexample
728 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
729 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
730 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
731 540 @}
732 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
733 $3 = 9
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
735 $4 = 7
736 @end smallexample
737
738 @noindent
739 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
740 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
741 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
742 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
743 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
744 assignments.
745
746 @smallexample
747 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
748 $5 = 7
749 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
750 $6 = 9
751 @end smallexample
752
753 @noindent
754 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
755 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
756 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
757 example that caused trouble initially:
758
759 @smallexample
760 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
761 Continuing.
762
763 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
764
765 baz
766 0000
767 @end smallexample
768
769 @noindent
770 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
771 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
772 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
773
774 @smallexample
775 @b{Ctrl-d}
776 Program exited normally.
777 @end smallexample
778
779 @noindent
780 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
781 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
782 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
783
784 @smallexample
785 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
786 @end smallexample
787
788 @node Invocation
789 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
790
791 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
792 The essentials are:
793 @itemize @bullet
794 @item
795 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
796 @item
797 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
798 @end itemize
799
800 @menu
801 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
802 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
803 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
804 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
805 @end menu
806
807 @node Invoking GDB
808 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
809
810 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
811 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
812
813 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
814 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
815
816 The command-line options described here are designed
817 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
818 options may effectively be unavailable.
819
820 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
821 specifying an executable program:
822
823 @smallexample
824 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
825 @end smallexample
826
827 @noindent
828 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
829 specified:
830
831 @smallexample
832 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
833 @end smallexample
834
835 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
836 to debug a running process:
837
838 @smallexample
839 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
840 @end smallexample
841
842 @noindent
843 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
844 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
845
846 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
847 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
848 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
849 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
850 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
851
852 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
853 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
854 option processing.
855 @smallexample
856 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
857 @end smallexample
858 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
859 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
860
861 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
862 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
863
864 @smallexample
865 @value{GDBP} -silent
866 @end smallexample
867
868 @noindent
869 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
870 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
871
872 @noindent
873 Type
874
875 @smallexample
876 @value{GDBP} -help
877 @end smallexample
878
879 @noindent
880 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
881 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
882
883 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
884 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
885 @samp{-x} option is used.
886
887
888 @menu
889 * File Options:: Choosing files
890 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
891 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
892 @end menu
893
894 @node File Options
895 @subsection Choosing Files
896
897 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
898 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
899 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
900 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
901 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
902 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
903 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
904 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
905 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
906 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
907 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
908 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
909 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
910
911 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
912 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
913 argument and ignore it.
914
915 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
916 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
917 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
918 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
919 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
920
921 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
922 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
923 @c it.
924
925 @table @code
926 @item -symbols @var{file}
927 @itemx -s @var{file}
928 @cindex @code{--symbols}
929 @cindex @code{-s}
930 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
931
932 @item -exec @var{file}
933 @itemx -e @var{file}
934 @cindex @code{--exec}
935 @cindex @code{-e}
936 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
937 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
938
939 @item -se @var{file}
940 @cindex @code{--se}
941 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
942 file.
943
944 @item -core @var{file}
945 @itemx -c @var{file}
946 @cindex @code{--core}
947 @cindex @code{-c}
948 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
949
950 @item -pid @var{number}
951 @itemx -p @var{number}
952 @cindex @code{--pid}
953 @cindex @code{-p}
954 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
955
956 @item -command @var{file}
957 @itemx -x @var{file}
958 @cindex @code{--command}
959 @cindex @code{-x}
960 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
961 Files,, Command files}.
962
963 @item -eval-command @var{command}
964 @itemx -ex @var{command}
965 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
966 @cindex @code{-ex}
967 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
968
969 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
970 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
971
972 @smallexample
973 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
974 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
975 @end smallexample
976
977 @item -directory @var{directory}
978 @itemx -d @var{directory}
979 @cindex @code{--directory}
980 @cindex @code{-d}
981 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
982
983 @item -r
984 @itemx -readnow
985 @cindex @code{--readnow}
986 @cindex @code{-r}
987 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
988 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
989 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
990
991 @end table
992
993 @node Mode Options
994 @subsection Choosing Modes
995
996 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
997 batch mode or quiet mode.
998
999 @table @code
1000 @item -nx
1001 @itemx -n
1002 @cindex @code{--nx}
1003 @cindex @code{-n}
1004 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
1005 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
1006 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
1007 Files}.
1008
1009 @item -quiet
1010 @itemx -silent
1011 @itemx -q
1012 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1013 @cindex @code{--silent}
1014 @cindex @code{-q}
1015 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1016 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1017
1018 @item -batch
1019 @cindex @code{--batch}
1020 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1021 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1022 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1023 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1024 in the command files.
1025
1026 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1027 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1028 make this more useful, the message
1029
1030 @smallexample
1031 Program exited normally.
1032 @end smallexample
1033
1034 @noindent
1035 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1036 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1037 mode.
1038
1039 @item -batch-silent
1040 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1041 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1042 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1043 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1044 for an interactive session.
1045
1046 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1047 messages, for example.
1048
1049 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1050 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1051
1052 @item -return-child-result
1053 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1054 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1055 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1056
1057 @itemize @bullet
1058 @item
1059 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1060 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1061 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1062 @item
1063 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1064 @item
1065 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1066 the exit code will be -1.
1067 @end itemize
1068
1069 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1070 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1071 interface.
1072
1073 @item -nowindows
1074 @itemx -nw
1075 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1076 @cindex @code{-nw}
1077 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1078 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1079 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1080
1081 @item -windows
1082 @itemx -w
1083 @cindex @code{--windows}
1084 @cindex @code{-w}
1085 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1086 used if possible.
1087
1088 @item -cd @var{directory}
1089 @cindex @code{--cd}
1090 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1091 instead of the current directory.
1092
1093 @item -fullname
1094 @itemx -f
1095 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1096 @cindex @code{-f}
1097 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1098 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1099 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1100 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1101 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1102 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1103 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1104 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1105 frame.
1106
1107 @item -epoch
1108 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1109 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1110 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1111 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1112 separate window.
1113
1114 @item -annotate @var{level}
1115 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1116 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1117 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1118 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1119 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1120 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1121 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1122 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1123 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1124
1125 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1126 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1127
1128 @item --args
1129 @cindex @code{--args}
1130 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1131 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1132 This option stops option processing.
1133
1134 @item -baud @var{bps}
1135 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1136 @cindex @code{--baud}
1137 @cindex @code{-b}
1138 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1139 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1140
1141 @item -l @var{timeout}
1142 @cindex @code{-l}
1143 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1144 for remote debugging.
1145
1146 @item -tty @var{device}
1147 @itemx -t @var{device}
1148 @cindex @code{--tty}
1149 @cindex @code{-t}
1150 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1151 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1152
1153 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1154 @item -tui
1155 @cindex @code{--tui}
1156 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1157 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1158 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1159 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1160 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1161 @samp{@value{GDBTUI}}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1162 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1163
1164 @c @item -xdb
1165 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1166 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1167 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1168 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1169 @c systems.
1170
1171 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1172 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1173 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1174 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1175 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1176 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1177
1178 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1179 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1180 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1181 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1182 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1183 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1184
1185 @item -write
1186 @cindex @code{--write}
1187 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1188 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1189 (@pxref{Patching}).
1190
1191 @item -statistics
1192 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1193 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1194 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1195
1196 @item -version
1197 @cindex @code{--version}
1198 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1199 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1200
1201 @end table
1202
1203 @node Startup
1204 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1205 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1206
1207 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1208
1209 @enumerate
1210 @item
1211 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1212 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1213
1214 @item
1215 @cindex init file
1216 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1217 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1218 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1219 that file.
1220
1221 @item
1222 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1223 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1224 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1225 that file.
1226
1227 @item
1228 Processes command line options and operands.
1229
1230 @item
1231 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1232 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1233 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1234 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1235 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1236 @value{GDBN}.
1237
1238 @item
1239 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1240 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1241
1242 @item
1243 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1244 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1245 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1246 @end enumerate
1247
1248 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1249 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1250 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1251 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1252 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1253 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1254
1255 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1256 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1257
1258 @cindex init file name
1259 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1260 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1261 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1262 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1263 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1264 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1265 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1266 the file to the standard name.
1267
1268
1269 @node Quitting GDB
1270 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1271 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1272 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1273
1274 @table @code
1275 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1276 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1277 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1278 @itemx q
1279 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1280 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1281 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1282 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1283 error code.
1284 @end table
1285
1286 @cindex interrupt
1287 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1288 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1289 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1290 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1291 until a time when it is safe.
1292
1293 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1294 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1295 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1296
1297 @node Shell Commands
1298 @section Shell Commands
1299
1300 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1301 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1302 just use the @code{shell} command.
1303
1304 @table @code
1305 @kindex shell
1306 @cindex shell escape
1307 @item shell @var{command string}
1308 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1309 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1310 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1311 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1312 @end table
1313
1314 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1315 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1316 @value{GDBN}:
1317
1318 @table @code
1319 @kindex make
1320 @cindex calling make
1321 @item make @var{make-args}
1322 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1323 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1324 @end table
1325
1326 @node Logging Output
1327 @section Logging Output
1328 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1329 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1330
1331 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1332 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1333
1334 @table @code
1335 @kindex set logging
1336 @item set logging on
1337 Enable logging.
1338 @item set logging off
1339 Disable logging.
1340 @cindex logging file name
1341 @item set logging file @var{file}
1342 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1343 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1344 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1345 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1346 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1347 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1348 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1349 @kindex show logging
1350 @item show logging
1351 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1352 @end table
1353
1354 @node Commands
1355 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1356
1357 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1358 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1359 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1360 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1361 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1362
1363 @menu
1364 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1365 * Completion:: Command completion
1366 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1367 @end menu
1368
1369 @node Command Syntax
1370 @section Command Syntax
1371
1372 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1373 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1374 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1375 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1376 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1377 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1378
1379 @cindex abbreviation
1380 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1381 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1382 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1383 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1384 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1385 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1386 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1387
1388 @cindex repeating commands
1389 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1390 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1391 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1392 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1393 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1394 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1395 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1396
1397 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1398 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1399 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1400
1401 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1402 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1403 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1404 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1405 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1406
1407 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1408 @cindex comment
1409 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1410 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1411 Files,,Command Files}).
1412
1413 @cindex repeating command sequences
1414 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1415 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1416 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1417 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1418 for editing.
1419
1420 @node Completion
1421 @section Command Completion
1422
1423 @cindex completion
1424 @cindex word completion
1425 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1426 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1427 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1428 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1429
1430 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1431 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1432 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1433 enter it). For example, if you type
1434
1435 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1436 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1437 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1438 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1439 @smallexample
1440 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1441 @end smallexample
1442
1443 @noindent
1444 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1445 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1446
1447 @smallexample
1448 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1449 @end smallexample
1450
1451 @noindent
1452 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1453 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1454 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1455 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1456 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1457 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1458
1459 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1460 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1461 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1462 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1463 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1464 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1465 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1466 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1467 example:
1468
1469 @smallexample
1470 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1471 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1472 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1473 make_abs_section make_function_type
1474 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1475 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1476 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1477 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1478 @end smallexample
1479
1480 @noindent
1481 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1482 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1483 command.
1484
1485 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1486 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1487 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1488 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1489 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1490
1491 @cindex quotes in commands
1492 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1493 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1494 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1495 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1496 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1497 @value{GDBN} commands.
1498
1499 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1500 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1501 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1502 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1503 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1504 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1505 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1506 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1507 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1508 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1509 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1510
1511 @smallexample
1512 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1513 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1514 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1515 @end smallexample
1516
1517 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1518 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1519 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1520 place:
1521
1522 @smallexample
1523 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1524 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1525 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1526 @end smallexample
1527
1528 @noindent
1529 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1530 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1531 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1532
1533 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1534 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1535 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1536 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1537
1538 @cindex completion of structure field names
1539 @cindex structure field name completion
1540 @cindex completion of union field names
1541 @cindex union field name completion
1542 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1543 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1544 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1545 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1546 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1547 left-hand-side:
1548
1549 @smallexample
1550 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1551 magic to_delete to_fputs to_put to_rewind
1552 to_data to_flush to_isatty to_read to_write
1553 @end smallexample
1554
1555 @noindent
1556 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1557 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1558 follows:
1559
1560 @smallexample
1561 struct ui_file
1562 @{
1563 int *magic;
1564 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1565 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1566 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1567 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1568 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1569 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1570 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1571 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1572 void *to_data;
1573 @}
1574 @end smallexample
1575
1576
1577 @node Help
1578 @section Getting Help
1579 @cindex online documentation
1580 @kindex help
1581
1582 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1583 using the command @code{help}.
1584
1585 @table @code
1586 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1587 @item help
1588 @itemx h
1589 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1590 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1591
1592 @smallexample
1593 (@value{GDBP}) help
1594 List of classes of commands:
1595
1596 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1597 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1598 data -- Examining data
1599 files -- Specifying and examining files
1600 internals -- Maintenance commands
1601 obscure -- Obscure features
1602 running -- Running the program
1603 stack -- Examining the stack
1604 status -- Status inquiries
1605 support -- Support facilities
1606 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1607 stopping the program
1608 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1609
1610 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1611 commands in that class.
1612 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1613 documentation.
1614 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1615 (@value{GDBP})
1616 @end smallexample
1617 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1618
1619 @item help @var{class}
1620 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1621 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1622 help display for the class @code{status}:
1623
1624 @smallexample
1625 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1626 Status inquiries.
1627
1628 List of commands:
1629
1630 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1631 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1632 info -- Generic command for showing things
1633 about the program being debugged
1634 show -- Generic command for showing things
1635 about the debugger
1636
1637 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1638 documentation.
1639 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1640 (@value{GDBP})
1641 @end smallexample
1642
1643 @item help @var{command}
1644 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1645 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1646
1647 @kindex apropos
1648 @item apropos @var{args}
1649 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1650 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1651 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1652
1653 @smallexample
1654 apropos reload
1655 @end smallexample
1656
1657 @noindent
1658 results in:
1659
1660 @smallexample
1661 @c @group
1662 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1663 multiple times in one run
1664 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1665 multiple times in one run
1666 @c @end group
1667 @end smallexample
1668
1669 @kindex complete
1670 @item complete @var{args}
1671 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1672 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1673 command you want completed. For example:
1674
1675 @smallexample
1676 complete i
1677 @end smallexample
1678
1679 @noindent results in:
1680
1681 @smallexample
1682 @group
1683 if
1684 ignore
1685 info
1686 inspect
1687 @end group
1688 @end smallexample
1689
1690 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1691 @end table
1692
1693 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1694 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1695 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1696 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1697 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1698 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1699
1700 @c @group
1701 @table @code
1702 @kindex info
1703 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1704 @item info
1705 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1706 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1707 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1708 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1709 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1710 @w{@code{help info}}.
1711
1712 @kindex set
1713 @item set
1714 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1715 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1716 @code{set prompt $}.
1717
1718 @kindex show
1719 @item show
1720 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1721 @value{GDBN} itself.
1722 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1723 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1724 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1725 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1726
1727 @kindex info set
1728 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1729 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1730 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1731 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1732 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1733 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1734 @end table
1735 @c @end group
1736
1737 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1738 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1739
1740 @table @code
1741 @kindex show version
1742 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1743 @item show version
1744 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1745 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1746 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1747 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1748 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1749 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1750 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1751 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1752 @value{GDBN}.
1753
1754 @kindex show copying
1755 @kindex info copying
1756 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1757 @item show copying
1758 @itemx info copying
1759 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1760
1761 @kindex show warranty
1762 @kindex info warranty
1763 @item show warranty
1764 @itemx info warranty
1765 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1766 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1767
1768 @end table
1769
1770 @node Running
1771 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1772
1773 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1774 debugging information when you compile it.
1775
1776 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1777 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1778 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1779 kill a child process.
1780
1781 @menu
1782 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1783 * Starting:: Starting your program
1784 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1785 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1786
1787 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1788 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1789 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1790 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1791
1792 * Inferiors:: Debugging multiple inferiors
1793 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1794 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1795 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1796 @end menu
1797
1798 @node Compilation
1799 @section Compiling for Debugging
1800
1801 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1802 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1803 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1804 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1805 and addresses in the executable code.
1806
1807 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1808 the compiler.
1809
1810 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1811 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, many
1812 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1813 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1814 executables containing debugging information.
1815
1816 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1817 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1818 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1819 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1820 in pushing your luck.
1821
1822 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1823 @cindex debugging optimized code
1824 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1825 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1826 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1827 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1828 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1829 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1830
1831 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1832 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1833 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1834 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1835 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
1836
1837 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1838 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1839 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1840
1841 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1842 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1843 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1844 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1845 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1846 provides macro information if you specify the options
1847 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1848 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1849 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1850 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1851 @option{-g} alone.
1852
1853 @need 2000
1854 @node Starting
1855 @section Starting your Program
1856 @cindex starting
1857 @cindex running
1858
1859 @table @code
1860 @kindex run
1861 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1862 @item run
1863 @itemx r
1864 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1865 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1866 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1867 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1868 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1869
1870 @end table
1871
1872 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1873 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1874 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1875 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1876 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1877 message like this one:
1878
1879 @smallexample
1880 The "remote" target does not support "run".
1881 Try "help target" or "continue".
1882 @end smallexample
1883
1884 @noindent
1885 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
1886 first (@pxref{load}).
1887
1888 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1889 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1890 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1891 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1892 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1893 divided into four categories:
1894
1895 @table @asis
1896 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1897 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1898 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1899 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1900 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1901 the arguments.
1902 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1903 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1904 @xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1905
1906 @item The @emph{environment.}
1907 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1908 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1909 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1910 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1911
1912 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1913 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1914 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1915 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1916
1917 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1918 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1919 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1920 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1921 set a different device for your program.
1922 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1923
1924 @cindex pipes
1925 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1926 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1927 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1928 wrong program.
1929 @end table
1930
1931 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1932 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1933 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1934 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1935 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1936
1937 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1938 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1939 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1940 your current breakpoints.
1941
1942 @table @code
1943 @kindex start
1944 @item start
1945 @cindex run to main procedure
1946 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1947 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1948 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1949 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1950 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1951 procedure, depending on the language used.
1952
1953 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1954 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1955 the @samp{run} command.
1956
1957 @cindex elaboration phase
1958 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1959 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1960 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1961 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1962 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1963 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1964 will remain to halt execution.
1965
1966 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1967 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1968 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1969 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1970 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1971
1972 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1973 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1974 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1975 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1976 elaboration code before running your program.
1977
1978 @kindex set exec-wrapper
1979 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
1980 @itemx show exec-wrapper
1981 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
1982 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
1983 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
1984 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
1985 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
1986 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
1987 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
1988 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
1989
1990 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
1991 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
1992 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
1993 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
1994
1995 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
1996 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
1997 environment:
1998
1999 @smallexample
2000 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2001 (@value{GDBP}) run
2002 @end smallexample
2003
2004 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2005 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2006
2007 @kindex set disable-randomization
2008 @item set disable-randomization
2009 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2010 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2011 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2012 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2013 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2014
2015 This feature is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux. You can get the same
2016 behavior using
2017
2018 @smallexample
2019 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2020 @end smallexample
2021
2022 @item set disable-randomization off
2023 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2024 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2025 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2026 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2027 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2028 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2029
2030 The virtual address space randomization is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2031 It protects the programs against some kinds of security attacks. In these
2032 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2033 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2034 a code at its expected addresses.
2035
2036 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2037 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2038 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2039 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2040 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2041 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2042 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2043 a randomly chosen address.
2044
2045 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2046 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2047 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2048 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2049 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2050
2051 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2052 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2053
2054 @item show disable-randomization
2055 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2056 the virtual address space of the started program.
2057
2058 @end table
2059
2060 @node Arguments
2061 @section Your Program's Arguments
2062
2063 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2064 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2065 @code{run} command.
2066 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2067 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2068 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2069 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2070 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2071
2072 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2073 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2074 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2075 the program, not by the shell.
2076
2077 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2078 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2079
2080 @table @code
2081 @kindex set args
2082 @item set args
2083 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2084 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2085 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2086 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2087 it again without arguments.
2088
2089 @kindex show args
2090 @item show args
2091 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2092 @end table
2093
2094 @node Environment
2095 @section Your Program's Environment
2096
2097 @cindex environment (of your program)
2098 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2099 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2100 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2101 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2102 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2103 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2104 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2105
2106 @table @code
2107 @kindex path
2108 @item path @var{directory}
2109 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2110 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2111 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2112 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2113 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2114 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2115 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2116
2117 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2118 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2119 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2120 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2121 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2122 @var{directory} to the search path.
2123 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2124 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2125
2126 @kindex show paths
2127 @item show paths
2128 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2129 environment variable).
2130
2131 @kindex show environment
2132 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2133 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2134 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2135 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2136 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2137
2138 @kindex set environment
2139 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2140 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2141 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2142 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2143 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2144 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2145 null value.
2146 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2147 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2148
2149 For example, this command:
2150
2151 @smallexample
2152 set env USER = foo
2153 @end smallexample
2154
2155 @noindent
2156 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2157 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2158 are not actually required.)
2159
2160 @kindex unset environment
2161 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2162 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2163 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2164 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2165 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2166 @end table
2167
2168 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2169 the shell indicated
2170 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2171 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2172 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2173 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2174 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2175 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2176 @file{.profile}.
2177
2178 @node Working Directory
2179 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2180
2181 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2182 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2183 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2184 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2185 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2186 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2187
2188 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2189 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2190 Specify Files}.
2191
2192 @table @code
2193 @kindex cd
2194 @cindex change working directory
2195 @item cd @var{directory}
2196 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2197
2198 @kindex pwd
2199 @item pwd
2200 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2201 @end table
2202
2203 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2204 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2205 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2206 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2207 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2208 current working directory of the debuggee.
2209
2210 @node Input/Output
2211 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2212
2213 @cindex redirection
2214 @cindex i/o
2215 @cindex terminal
2216 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2217 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2218 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2219 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2220 running your program.
2221
2222 @table @code
2223 @kindex info terminal
2224 @item info terminal
2225 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2226 program is using.
2227 @end table
2228
2229 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2230 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2231
2232 @smallexample
2233 run > outfile
2234 @end smallexample
2235
2236 @noindent
2237 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2238
2239 @kindex tty
2240 @cindex controlling terminal
2241 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2242 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2243 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2244 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2245 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2246
2247 @smallexample
2248 tty /dev/ttyb
2249 @end smallexample
2250
2251 @noindent
2252 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2253 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2254 that as their controlling terminal.
2255
2256 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2257 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2258 terminal.
2259
2260 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2261 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2262 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2263 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2264
2265 @cindex inferior tty
2266 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2267 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2268 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2269 program.
2270
2271 @table @code
2272 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2273 @kindex set inferior-tty
2274 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2275
2276 @item show inferior-tty
2277 @kindex show inferior-tty
2278 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2279 @end table
2280
2281 @node Attach
2282 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2283 @kindex attach
2284 @cindex attach
2285
2286 @table @code
2287 @item attach @var{process-id}
2288 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2289 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2290 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2291 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2292 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2293
2294 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2295 executing the command.
2296 @end table
2297
2298 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2299 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2300 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2301 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2302
2303 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2304 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2305 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2306 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2307 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2308 Specify Files}.
2309
2310 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2311 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2312 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2313 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2314 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2315 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2316 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2317
2318 @table @code
2319 @kindex detach
2320 @item detach
2321 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2322 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2323 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2324 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2325 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2326 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2327 executing the command.
2328 @end table
2329
2330 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2331 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2332 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2333 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2334 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2335 Messages}).
2336
2337 @node Kill Process
2338 @section Killing the Child Process
2339
2340 @table @code
2341 @kindex kill
2342 @item kill
2343 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2344 @end table
2345
2346 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2347 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2348 is running.
2349
2350 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2351 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2352 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2353 outside the debugger.
2354
2355 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2356 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2357 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2358 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2359 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2360 breakpoint settings).
2361
2362 @node Inferiors
2363 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors
2364
2365 Some @value{GDBN} targets are able to run multiple processes created
2366 from a single executable. This can happen, for instance, with an
2367 embedded system reporting back several processes via the remote
2368 protocol.
2369
2370 @cindex inferior
2371 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2372 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2373 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2374 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2375 may (in future) be retained after a process exits. Each run of an
2376 executable creates a new inferior, as does each attachment to an
2377 existing process. Inferiors have unique identifiers that are
2378 different from process ids, and may optionally be named as well.
2379 Usually each inferior will also have its own distinct address space,
2380 although some embedded targets may have several inferiors running in
2381 different parts of a single space.
2382
2383 Each inferior may in turn have multiple threads running in it.
2384
2385 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @code{info inferiors}:
2386
2387 @table @code
2388 @kindex info inferiors
2389 @item info inferiors
2390 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2391
2392 @kindex set print inferior-events
2393 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2394 @item set print inferior-events
2395 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2396 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2397 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2398 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2399 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2400 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2401
2402 @kindex show print inferior-events
2403 @item show print inferior-events
2404 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2405 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2406 @end table
2407
2408 @node Threads
2409 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2410
2411 @cindex threads of execution
2412 @cindex multiple threads
2413 @cindex switching threads
2414 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2415 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2416 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2417 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2418 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2419 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2420 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2421
2422 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2423 programs:
2424
2425 @itemize @bullet
2426 @item automatic notification of new threads
2427 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2428 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2429 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2430 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2431 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2432 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2433 messages on thread start and exit.
2434 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2435 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2436 isn't compatible with the program.
2437 @end itemize
2438
2439 @quotation
2440 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2441 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2442 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2443 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2444 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2445 like this:
2446
2447 @smallexample
2448 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2449 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2450 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2451 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2452 @end smallexample
2453 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2454 @c doesn't support threads"?
2455 @end quotation
2456
2457 @cindex focus of debugging
2458 @cindex current thread
2459 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2460 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2461 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2462 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2463 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2464
2465 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2466 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2467 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2468 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2469 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2470 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2471 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2472 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2473 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2474 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2475
2476 @smallexample
2477 [New Thread 46912507313328 (LWP 25582)]
2478 @end smallexample
2479
2480 @noindent
2481 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2482 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2483 further qualifier.
2484
2485 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2486 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2487 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2488 @c program?
2489 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2490 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2491 @c threads ab initio?
2492
2493 @cindex thread number
2494 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2495 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2496 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2497
2498 @table @code
2499 @kindex info threads
2500 @item info threads
2501 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2502 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2503
2504 @enumerate
2505 @item
2506 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2507
2508 @item
2509 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2510
2511 @item
2512 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2513 @end enumerate
2514
2515 @noindent
2516 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2517 indicates the current thread.
2518
2519 For example,
2520 @end table
2521 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2522
2523 @smallexample
2524 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2525 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2526 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2527 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2528 at threadtest.c:68
2529 @end smallexample
2530
2531 On HP-UX systems:
2532
2533 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2534 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2535 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2536 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2537 thread in your program.
2538
2539 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2540 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2541 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2542 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2543 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2544 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2545 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2546 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2547 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2548 HP-UX, you see
2549
2550 @smallexample
2551 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2552 @end smallexample
2553
2554 @noindent
2555 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2556
2557 @table @code
2558 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2559 @item info threads
2560 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2561 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2562
2563 @enumerate
2564 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2565
2566 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2567
2568 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2569 @end enumerate
2570
2571 @noindent
2572 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2573 indicates the current thread.
2574
2575 For example,
2576 @end table
2577 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2578
2579 @smallexample
2580 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2581 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2582 at quicksort.c:137
2583 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2584 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2585 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2586 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2587 @end smallexample
2588
2589 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2590 Solaris-specific command:
2591
2592 @table @code
2593 @item maint info sol-threads
2594 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2595 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2596 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2597 @end table
2598
2599 @table @code
2600 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2601 @item thread @var{threadno}
2602 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2603 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2604 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2605 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2606 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2607
2608 @smallexample
2609 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2610 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2611 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2612 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2613 @end smallexample
2614
2615 @noindent
2616 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2617 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2618 threads.
2619
2620 @kindex thread apply
2621 @cindex apply command to several threads
2622 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2623 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2624 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2625 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2626 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2627 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2628 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2629 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2630
2631 @kindex set print thread-events
2632 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
2633 @item set print thread-events
2634 @itemx set print thread-events on
2635 @itemx set print thread-events off
2636 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
2637 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
2638 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
2639 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
2640 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
2641
2642 @kindex show print thread-events
2643 @item show print thread-events
2644 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
2645 have started and exited.
2646 @end table
2647
2648 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2649 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2650 programs with multiple threads.
2651
2652 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2653 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2654
2655 @table @code
2656 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
2657 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
2658 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
2659 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
2660 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
2661 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
2662 an empty list.
2663
2664 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
2665 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
2666 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
2667 to find @code{libthread_db}. If that fails, @value{GDBN} will continue
2668 with default system shared library directories, and finally the directory
2669 from which @code{libpthread} was loaded in the inferior process.
2670
2671 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
2672 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
2673 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
2674 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
2675 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
2676 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
2677 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
2678
2679 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
2680 only on some platforms.
2681
2682 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
2683 @item show libthread-db-search-path
2684 Display current libthread_db search path.
2685 @end table
2686
2687 @node Processes
2688 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Processes
2689
2690 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2691 @cindex multiple processes
2692 @cindex processes, multiple
2693 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2694 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2695 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2696 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2697 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2698 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2699 will cause it to terminate.
2700
2701 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2702 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2703 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2704 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2705 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2706 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2707 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2708 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2709 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2710 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2711
2712 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2713 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2714 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2715 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2716
2717 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2718 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2719
2720 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2721 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2722
2723 @table @code
2724 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2725 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2726 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2727 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2728 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2729
2730 @table @code
2731 @item parent
2732 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2733 unimpeded. This is the default.
2734
2735 @item child
2736 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2737 unimpeded.
2738
2739 @end table
2740
2741 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2742 @item show follow-fork-mode
2743 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2744 @end table
2745
2746 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2747 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2748 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2749
2750 @table @code
2751 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2752 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2753 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2754 retain debugger control over them both.
2755
2756 @table @code
2757 @item on
2758 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2759 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2760 independently. This is the default.
2761
2762 @item off
2763 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2764 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2765 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2766 is held suspended.
2767
2768 @end table
2769
2770 @kindex show detach-on-fork
2771 @item show detach-on-fork
2772 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
2773 @end table
2774
2775 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then
2776 @value{GDBN} will retain control of all forked processes (including
2777 nested forks). You can list the forked processes under the control of
2778 @value{GDBN} by using the @w{@code{info forks}} command, and switch
2779 from one fork to another by using the @w{@code{fork}} command.
2780
2781 @table @code
2782 @kindex info forks
2783 @item info forks
2784 Print a list of all forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2785 The listing will include a fork id, a process id, and the current
2786 position (program counter) of the process.
2787
2788 @kindex fork @var{fork-id}
2789 @item fork @var{fork-id}
2790 Make fork number @var{fork-id} the current process. The argument
2791 @var{fork-id} is the internal fork number assigned by @value{GDBN},
2792 as shown in the first field of the @samp{info forks} display.
2793
2794 @kindex process @var{process-id}
2795 @item process @var{process-id}
2796 Make process number @var{process-id} the current process. The
2797 argument @var{process-id} must be one that is listed in the output of
2798 @samp{info forks}.
2799
2800 @end table
2801
2802 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2803 from it by using the @w{@code{detach fork}} command (allowing it to
2804 run independently), or delete (and kill) it using the
2805 @w{@code{delete fork}} command.
2806
2807 @table @code
2808 @kindex detach fork @var{fork-id}
2809 @item detach fork @var{fork-id}
2810 Detach from the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number
2811 @var{fork-id}, and remove it from the fork list. The process will be
2812 allowed to run independently.
2813
2814 @kindex delete fork @var{fork-id}
2815 @item delete fork @var{fork-id}
2816 Kill the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number @var{fork-id},
2817 and remove it from the fork list.
2818
2819 @end table
2820
2821 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2822 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2823 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2824 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2825 the child process's @code{main}.
2826
2827 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2828 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2829
2830 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2831 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2832 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2833 argument.
2834
2835 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2836 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2837 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
2838
2839 @node Checkpoint/Restart
2840 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
2841
2842 @cindex checkpoint
2843 @cindex restart
2844 @cindex bookmark
2845 @cindex snapshot of a process
2846 @cindex rewind program state
2847
2848 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
2849 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
2850 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
2851 later.
2852
2853 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
2854 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
2855 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
2856 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
2857 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
2858
2859 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
2860 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
2861 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
2862 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
2863 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
2864 start again from there.
2865
2866 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
2867 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
2868
2869 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
2870
2871 @table @code
2872 @kindex checkpoint
2873 @item checkpoint
2874 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
2875 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
2876 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
2877
2878 @kindex info checkpoints
2879 @item info checkpoints
2880 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
2881 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
2882 listed:
2883
2884 @table @code
2885 @item Checkpoint ID
2886 @item Process ID
2887 @item Code Address
2888 @item Source line, or label
2889 @end table
2890
2891 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2892 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2893 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
2894 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
2895 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
2896 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
2897 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
2898
2899 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
2900 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
2901 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
2902 the debugger.
2903
2904 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2905 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2906 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
2907
2908 @end table
2909
2910 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
2911 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
2912 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
2913 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
2914 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
2915 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
2916 previously read data can be read again.
2917
2918 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
2919 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
2920 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
2921 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
2922 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
2923 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
2924
2925 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
2926 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
2927 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
2928 different execution path this time.
2929
2930 @cindex checkpoints and process id
2931 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
2932 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
2933 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
2934 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
2935 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
2936 potentially pose a problem.
2937
2938 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
2939
2940 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
2941 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
2942 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
2943 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
2944 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
2945 next.
2946
2947 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
2948 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
2949 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
2950 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
2951 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
2952
2953 @node Stopping
2954 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2955
2956 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2957 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2958 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2959
2960 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2961 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2962 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2963 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2964 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2965 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2966 explicitly request this information at any time.
2967
2968 @table @code
2969 @kindex info program
2970 @item info program
2971 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2972 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2973 @end table
2974
2975 @menu
2976 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2977 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2978 * Signals:: Signals
2979 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2980 @end menu
2981
2982 @node Breakpoints
2983 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
2984
2985 @cindex breakpoints
2986 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2987 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2988 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2989 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2990 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2991 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2992 program.
2993
2994 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
2995 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
2996 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
2997 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
2998 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
2999 call).
3000
3001 @cindex watchpoints
3002 @cindex data breakpoints
3003 @cindex memory tracing
3004 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3005 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3006 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3007 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3008 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3009 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3010 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3011 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3012 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3013 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3014 same commands.
3015
3016 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3017 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3018 Automatic Display}.
3019
3020 @cindex catchpoints
3021 @cindex breakpoint on events
3022 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3023 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3024 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3025 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3026 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3027 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3028 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3029
3030 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3031 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3032 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3033 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3034 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3035 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3036 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3037 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3038 enable it again.
3039
3040 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3041 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3042 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3043 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3044 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3045 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3046 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3047
3048 @menu
3049 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3050 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3051 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3052 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3053 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3054 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3055 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3056 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3057 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3058 @end menu
3059
3060 @node Set Breaks
3061 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3062
3063 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3064 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3065 @c
3066 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3067
3068 @kindex break
3069 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3070 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3071 @cindex latest breakpoint
3072 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3073 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3074 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3075 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3076 convenience variables.
3077
3078 @table @code
3079 @item break @var{location}
3080 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3081 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3082 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3083 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3084 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3085
3086 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3087 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3088 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3089 that situation.
3090
3091 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3092 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3093 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3094
3095 @item break
3096 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3097 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3098 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3099 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3100 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3101 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3102 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3103 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3104 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3105 inside loops.
3106
3107 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3108 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3109 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3110 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3111 existed when your program stopped.
3112
3113 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3114 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3115 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3116 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3117 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3118 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3119 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3120
3121 @kindex tbreak
3122 @item tbreak @var{args}
3123 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
3124 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3125 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3126 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3127
3128 @kindex hbreak
3129 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3130 @item hbreak @var{args}
3131 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
3132 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3133 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3134 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3135 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3136 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3137 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3138 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3139 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3140 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3141 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3142 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3143 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3144 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3145 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3146 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3147 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3148 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3149
3150 @kindex thbreak
3151 @item thbreak @var{args}
3152 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
3153 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3154 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3155 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3156 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3157 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3158 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3159 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3160
3161 @kindex rbreak
3162 @cindex regular expression
3163 @cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
3164 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3165 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3166 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3167 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3168 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3169 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3170 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3171 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3172
3173 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3174 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3175 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3176 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3177 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3178 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3179
3180 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3181 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3182 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3183 classes.
3184
3185 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3186 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3187 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3188
3189 @smallexample
3190 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3191 @end smallexample
3192
3193 @kindex info breakpoints
3194 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3195 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3196 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3197 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3198 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3199 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3200 about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
3201 each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3202
3203 @table @emph
3204 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3205 @item Type
3206 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3207 @item Disposition
3208 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3209 @item Enabled or Disabled
3210 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3211 that are not enabled.
3212 @item Address
3213 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3214 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3215 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3216 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3217 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3218 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3219 @item What
3220 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3221 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3222 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3223 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3224 @end table
3225
3226 @noindent
3227 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3228 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3229 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3230 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3231 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3232 valid location.
3233
3234 @noindent
3235 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3236 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3237 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3238 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3239 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3240
3241 @noindent
3242 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3243 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3244 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3245 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3246 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3247 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3248 @end table
3249
3250 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3251 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3252 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3253 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3254
3255 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3256 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3257 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3258 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3259
3260 @itemize @bullet
3261 @item
3262 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3263 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3264
3265 @item
3266 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3267 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3268
3269 @item
3270 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3271 several places where that function is inlined.
3272 @end itemize
3273
3274 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3275 the relevant locations@footnote{
3276 As of this writing, multiple-location breakpoints work only if there's
3277 line number information for all the locations. This means that they
3278 will generally not work in system libraries, unless you have debug
3279 info with line numbers for them.}.
3280
3281 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3282 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3283 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3284 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3285 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3286 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3287 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3288
3289 For example:
3290
3291 @smallexample
3292 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3293 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3294 stop only if i==1
3295 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3296 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3297 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3298 @end smallexample
3299
3300 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3301 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3302 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3303 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3304 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3305 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3306 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3307 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3308 that belong to that breakpoint.
3309
3310 @cindex pending breakpoints
3311 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3312 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3313 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3314 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3315 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3316 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3317 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3318 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3319 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3320 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3321 is not yet resolved.
3322
3323 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3324 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3325 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3326 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3327 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3328 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3329
3330 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3331 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3332 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3333 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3334
3335 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3336 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3337 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3338
3339 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3340 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3341 address specification to an address:
3342
3343 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3344 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3345 @table @code
3346 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3347 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3348 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3349
3350 @item set breakpoint pending on
3351 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3352 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3353
3354 @item set breakpoint pending off
3355 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3356 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3357 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3358
3359 @item show breakpoint pending
3360 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3361 @end table
3362
3363 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3364 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3365 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3366
3367 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3368 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3369 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3370 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3371 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3372 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3373 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3374 breakpoints.
3375
3376 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3377
3378 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3379 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3380 @table @code
3381 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3382 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3383 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3384 breakpoint must be used.
3385
3386 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3387 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3388 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3389 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3390 @end table
3391
3392 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3393 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3394 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3395 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3396 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3397 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3398 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3399 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3400 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3401
3402 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3403 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3404 @table @code
3405 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3406 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3407 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3408 removed from the target when it stops.
3409
3410 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3411 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3412 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3413 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3414 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is removed.
3415
3416 @cindex non-stop mode, and @code{breakpoint always-inserted}
3417 @item set breakpoint always-inserted auto
3418 This is the default mode. If @value{GDBN} is controlling the inferior
3419 in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), gdb behaves as if
3420 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is on. If @value{GDBN} is
3421 controlling the inferior in all-stop mode, @value{GDBN} behaves as if
3422 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is off.
3423 @end table
3424
3425 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3426 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3427 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3428 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3429 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3430 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3431 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3432 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3433
3434
3435 @node Set Watchpoints
3436 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3437
3438 @cindex setting watchpoints
3439 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3440 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3441 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3442 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3443 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3444
3445 @itemize @bullet
3446 @item
3447 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3448
3449 @item
3450 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3451 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3452 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3453
3454 @item
3455 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3456 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3457 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3458 @end itemize
3459
3460 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3461 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3462 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3463 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3464 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3465 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3466 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3467 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3468 the expression changes.
3469
3470 @cindex software watchpoints
3471 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3472 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3473 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3474 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3475 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3476 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3477 culprit.)
3478
3479 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3480 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3481 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3482
3483 @table @code
3484 @kindex watch
3485 @item watch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3486 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3487 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3488 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3489 to watch the value of a single variable:
3490
3491 @smallexample
3492 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3493 @end smallexample
3494
3495 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3496 clause, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3497 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3498 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3499 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3500 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3501
3502 @kindex rwatch
3503 @item rwatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3504 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3505 by the program.
3506
3507 @kindex awatch
3508 @item awatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3509 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3510 or written into by the program.
3511
3512 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3513 @item info watchpoints
3514 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3515 it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3516 @end table
3517
3518 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3519 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3520 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3521 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3522 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3523 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3524
3525 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3526 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3527 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3528 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3529 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3530 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3531 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3532 mechanism of watching expression values.)
3533
3534 @table @code
3535 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3536 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3537 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3538
3539 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3540 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3541 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3542 @end table
3543
3544 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3545 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3546 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3547
3548 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3549
3550 @smallexample
3551 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3552 @end smallexample
3553
3554 @noindent
3555 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3556
3557 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3558 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3559 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3560 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3561 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3562 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3563 will print a message like this:
3564
3565 @smallexample
3566 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3567 @end smallexample
3568
3569 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3570 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3571 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3572 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3573 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3574 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3575 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3576 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3577
3578 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3579 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3580 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3581 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3582 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3583 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3584
3585 @smallexample
3586 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3587 @end smallexample
3588
3589 @noindent
3590 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3591
3592 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3593 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3594 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3595 expression with separately allocated resources.
3596
3597 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3598 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3599 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3600
3601 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3602 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3603 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3604 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3605 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3606 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3607 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3608 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3609 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3610
3611 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3612 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3613 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
3614 watched expression from every thread.
3615
3616 @quotation
3617 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
3618 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3619 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3620 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3621 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3622 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3623 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3624 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3625 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3626 @end quotation
3627
3628 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3629
3630 @node Set Catchpoints
3631 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
3632 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3633 @cindex exception handlers
3634 @cindex event handling
3635
3636 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3637 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3638 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3639
3640 @table @code
3641 @kindex catch
3642 @item catch @var{event}
3643 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3644 @table @code
3645 @item throw
3646 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3647 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3648
3649 @item catch
3650 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3651
3652 @item exception
3653 @cindex Ada exception catching
3654 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
3655 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3656 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3657 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3658 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3659
3660 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
3661 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
3662 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
3663 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
3664 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
3665 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
3666 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
3667 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
3668
3669 @item exception unhandled
3670 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3671
3672 @item assert
3673 A failed Ada assertion.
3674
3675 @item exec
3676 @cindex break on fork/exec
3677 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3678 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3679
3680 @item fork
3681 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3682 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3683
3684 @item vfork
3685 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3686 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3687
3688 @end table
3689
3690 @item tcatch @var{event}
3691 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3692 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3693
3694 @end table
3695
3696 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3697
3698 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3699 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3700
3701 @itemize @bullet
3702 @item
3703 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3704 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3705 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3706 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3707 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3708 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3709 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3710 disabled within interactive calls.
3711
3712 @item
3713 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3714
3715 @item
3716 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3717 @end itemize
3718
3719 @cindex raise exceptions
3720 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3721 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3722 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3723 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3724 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3725 out where the exception was raised.
3726
3727 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3728 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3729 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3730 which has the following ANSI C interface:
3731
3732 @smallexample
3733 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3734 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3735 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3736 @end smallexample
3737
3738 @noindent
3739 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3740 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3741 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
3742
3743 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
3744 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3745 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3746 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3747 raised.
3748
3749
3750 @node Delete Breaks
3751 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
3752
3753 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3754 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3755 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3756 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3757 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3758 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3759
3760 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3761 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3762 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3763 their breakpoint numbers.
3764
3765 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3766 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3767 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3768
3769 @table @code
3770 @kindex clear
3771 @item clear
3772 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3773 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
3774 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3775 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3776
3777 @item clear @var{location}
3778 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
3779 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
3780 most useful ones are listed below:
3781
3782 @table @code
3783 @item clear @var{function}
3784 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3785 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3786
3787 @item clear @var{linenum}
3788 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3789 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3790 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3791 @end table
3792
3793 @cindex delete breakpoints
3794 @kindex delete
3795 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3796 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3797 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3798 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3799 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3800 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3801 @end table
3802
3803 @node Disabling
3804 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
3805
3806 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3807 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3808 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3809 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3810 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3811
3812 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3813 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3814 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3815 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3816 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3817
3818 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
3819 affects all of its locations.
3820
3821 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3822 states of enablement:
3823
3824 @itemize @bullet
3825 @item
3826 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3827 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3828 @item
3829 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3830 @item
3831 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3832 disabled.
3833 @item
3834 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3835 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3836 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3837 @end itemize
3838
3839 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3840 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3841
3842 @table @code
3843 @kindex disable
3844 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3845 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3846 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3847 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3848 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3849 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3850 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3851
3852 @kindex enable
3853 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3854 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3855 become effective once again in stopping your program.
3856
3857 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3858 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3859 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3860
3861 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3862 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3863 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3864 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3865 @end table
3866
3867 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3868 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3869 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3870 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3871 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3872 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3873 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3874 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3875 Stepping}.)
3876
3877 @node Conditions
3878 @subsection Break Conditions
3879 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3880 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3881
3882 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3883 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3884 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3885 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3886 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3887 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3888 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3889 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3890
3891 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3892 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3893 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3894 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3895 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3896
3897 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3898 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3899 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3900 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3901 one.
3902
3903 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3904 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3905 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3906 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3907 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3908 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3909 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3910 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3911 conditions for the
3912 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3913 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
3914
3915 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3916 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3917 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3918 with the @code{condition} command.
3919
3920 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3921 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3922 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3923 catchpoint.
3924
3925 @table @code
3926 @kindex condition
3927 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3928 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3929 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3930 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3931 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3932 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3933 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3934 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3935 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3936 prints an error message:
3937
3938 @smallexample
3939 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3940 @end smallexample
3941
3942 @noindent
3943 @value{GDBN} does
3944 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3945 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3946 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3947
3948 @item condition @var{bnum}
3949 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3950 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3951 @end table
3952
3953 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3954 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3955 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3956 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3957 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3958 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3959 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3960 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3961 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3962 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3963 your program reaches it.
3964
3965 @table @code
3966 @kindex ignore
3967 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3968 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3969 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3970 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3971 takes no action.
3972
3973 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3974 a count of zero.
3975
3976 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3977 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3978 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3979 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
3980
3981 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3982 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3983 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3984
3985 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3986 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3987 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3988 Variables}.
3989 @end table
3990
3991 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3992
3993
3994 @node Break Commands
3995 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
3996
3997 @cindex breakpoint commands
3998 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3999 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4000 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4001 enable other breakpoints.
4002
4003 @table @code
4004 @kindex commands
4005 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4006 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
4007 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4008 @itemx end
4009 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
4010 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4011 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4012
4013 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4014 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4015
4016 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
4017 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
4018 recently encountered).
4019 @end table
4020
4021 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4022 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4023
4024 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4025 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4026 that resumes execution.
4027
4028 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4029 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4030 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4031 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4032 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4033
4034 @kindex silent
4035 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4036 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4037 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4038 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4039 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4040 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4041
4042 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4043 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4044 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4045
4046 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4047 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4048
4049 @smallexample
4050 break foo if x>0
4051 commands
4052 silent
4053 printf "x is %d\n",x
4054 cont
4055 end
4056 @end smallexample
4057
4058 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4059 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4060 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4061 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4062 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4063 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4064 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4065
4066 @smallexample
4067 break 403
4068 commands
4069 silent
4070 set x = y + 4
4071 cont
4072 end
4073 @end smallexample
4074
4075 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
4076 @node Error in Breakpoints
4077 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
4078
4079 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
4080 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
4081
4082 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
4083 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
4084 @smallexample
4085 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
4086 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
4087 @end smallexample
4088
4089 @noindent
4090 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
4091 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
4092 watchpoints it needs to insert.
4093
4094 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
4095 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
4096
4097 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
4098 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
4099 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
4100
4101 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
4102 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
4103 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
4104 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
4105
4106 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
4107 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
4108 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
4109 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
4110 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
4111 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
4112 first in the bundle.
4113
4114 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
4115 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
4116 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
4117 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
4118 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
4119 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
4120 is hit.
4121
4122 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
4123 that's been subject to address adjustment:
4124
4125 @smallexample
4126 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
4127 @end smallexample
4128
4129 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
4130 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
4131 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
4132 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
4133 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
4134 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
4135 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
4136 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
4137
4138 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
4139 adjusted breakpoints:
4140
4141 @smallexample
4142 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
4143 to 0x00010410.
4144 @end smallexample
4145
4146 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
4147 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
4148 frequently than expected.
4149
4150 @node Continuing and Stepping
4151 @section Continuing and Stepping
4152
4153 @cindex stepping
4154 @cindex continuing
4155 @cindex resuming execution
4156 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
4157 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
4158 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
4159 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
4160 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
4161 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
4162 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
4163 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
4164
4165 @table @code
4166 @kindex continue
4167 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
4168 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
4169 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4170 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4171 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4172 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
4173 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
4174 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
4175 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
4176 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
4177
4178 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
4179 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
4180 @code{continue} is ignored.
4181
4182 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
4183 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
4184 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
4185 @code{continue}.
4186 @end table
4187
4188 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
4189 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
4190 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
4191 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
4192
4193 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
4194 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
4195 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
4196 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
4197 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
4198 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
4199
4200 @table @code
4201 @kindex step
4202 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
4203 @item step
4204 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
4205 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
4206 abbreviated @code{s}.
4207
4208 @quotation
4209 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
4210 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
4211 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
4212 @c distinction here.
4213 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
4214 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
4215 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
4216 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
4217 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
4218 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
4219 below.
4220 @end quotation
4221
4222 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
4223 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4224 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
4225 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
4226 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
4227 called within the line.
4228
4229 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
4230 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
4231 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
4232 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
4233 was any debugging information about the routine.
4234
4235 @item step @var{count}
4236 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
4237 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
4238 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
4239
4240 @kindex next
4241 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
4242 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4243 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4244 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4245 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4246 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4247 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4248 is abbreviated @code{n}.
4249
4250 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4251
4252
4253 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4254 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4255 @c
4256 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4257 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4258 @c function are executed without stopping.
4259
4260 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4261 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4262 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4263
4264 @kindex set step-mode
4265 @item set step-mode
4266 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4267 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4268 @itemx set step-mode on
4269 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4270 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4271 information rather than stepping over it.
4272
4273 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4274 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4275 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4276
4277 @item set step-mode off
4278 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4279 debug information. This is the default.
4280
4281 @item show step-mode
4282 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4283 source line debug information.
4284
4285 @kindex finish
4286 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
4287 @item finish
4288 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4289 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
4290 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
4291
4292 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4293 ,Returning from a Function}).
4294
4295 @kindex until
4296 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4297 @cindex run until specified location
4298 @item until
4299 @itemx u
4300 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4301 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4302 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4303 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4304 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4305 than the address of the jump.
4306
4307 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4308 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4309 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4310 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4311 through the next iteration.
4312
4313 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4314 stack frame.
4315
4316 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4317 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4318 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4319 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4320 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4321
4322 @smallexample
4323 (@value{GDBP}) f
4324 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4325 206 expand_input();
4326 (@value{GDBP}) until
4327 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4328 @end smallexample
4329
4330 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4331 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4332 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4333 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4334 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4335 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4336 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4337
4338 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4339 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4340 argument.
4341
4342 @item until @var{location}
4343 @itemx u @var{location}
4344 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4345 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4346 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
4347 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
4348 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4349 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4350 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4351 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4352 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4353 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4354 invocations have returned.
4355
4356 @smallexample
4357 94 int factorial (int value)
4358 95 @{
4359 96 if (value > 1) @{
4360 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4361 98 @}
4362 99 return (value);
4363 100 @}
4364 @end smallexample
4365
4366
4367 @kindex advance @var{location}
4368 @itemx advance @var{location}
4369 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4370 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
4371 @ref{Specify Location}.
4372 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4373 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4374 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4375 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4376
4377
4378 @kindex stepi
4379 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4380 @item stepi
4381 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4382 @itemx si
4383 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4384
4385 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4386 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4387 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4388 Display,, Automatic Display}.
4389
4390 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4391
4392 @need 750
4393 @kindex nexti
4394 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4395 @item nexti
4396 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4397 @itemx ni
4398 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4399 proceed until the function returns.
4400
4401 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4402 @end table
4403
4404 @node Signals
4405 @section Signals
4406 @cindex signals
4407
4408 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4409 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4410 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4411 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4412 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4413 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4414 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4415 requested an alarm).
4416
4417 @cindex fatal signals
4418 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4419 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4420 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4421 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4422 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4423 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4424
4425 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4426 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4427 signal.
4428
4429 @cindex handling signals
4430 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4431 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4432 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4433 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4434 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4435
4436 @table @code
4437 @kindex info signals
4438 @kindex info handle
4439 @item info signals
4440 @itemx info handle
4441 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4442 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4443 the defined types of signals.
4444
4445 @item info signals @var{sig}
4446 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4447
4448 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4449
4450 @kindex handle
4451 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4452 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4453 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4454 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4455 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4456 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4457 say what change to make.
4458 @end table
4459
4460 @c @group
4461 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4462 Their full names are:
4463
4464 @table @code
4465 @item nostop
4466 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4467 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4468
4469 @item stop
4470 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4471 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4472
4473 @item print
4474 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4475
4476 @item noprint
4477 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4478 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4479
4480 @item pass
4481 @itemx noignore
4482 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4483 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4484 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4485
4486 @item nopass
4487 @itemx ignore
4488 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4489 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4490 @end table
4491 @c @end group
4492
4493 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4494 program until you
4495 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4496 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4497 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4498 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4499 program sees that signal when you continue.
4500
4501 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4502 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4503 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4504 erroneous signals.
4505
4506 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4507 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4508 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4509 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4510 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4511 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4512 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4513 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4514 Program a Signal}.
4515
4516 @cindex extra signal information
4517 @anchor{extra signal information}
4518
4519 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
4520 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
4521 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
4522 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
4523 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
4524 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
4525 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
4526 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
4527 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
4528 system header.
4529
4530 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
4531 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
4532
4533 @smallexample
4534 @group
4535 (@value{GDBP}) continue
4536 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
4537 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
4538 69 *(int *)p = 0;
4539 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
4540 type = struct @{
4541 int si_signo;
4542 int si_errno;
4543 int si_code;
4544 union @{
4545 int _pad[28];
4546 struct @{...@} _kill;
4547 struct @{...@} _timer;
4548 struct @{...@} _rt;
4549 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
4550 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
4551 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
4552 @} _sifields;
4553 @}
4554 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
4555 type = struct @{
4556 void *si_addr;
4557 @}
4558 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
4559 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
4560 @end group
4561 @end smallexample
4562
4563 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
4564
4565 @node Thread Stops
4566 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
4567
4568 @cindex stopped threads
4569 @cindex threads, stopped
4570
4571 @cindex continuing threads
4572 @cindex threads, continuing
4573
4574 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
4575 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
4576 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
4577 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
4578 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
4579 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
4580 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
4581 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
4582 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
4583
4584 @menu
4585 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
4586 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
4587 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
4588 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
4589 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
4590 @end menu
4591
4592 @node All-Stop Mode
4593 @subsection All-Stop Mode
4594
4595 @cindex all-stop mode
4596
4597 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4598 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4599 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4600 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4601 underfoot.
4602
4603 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4604 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4605 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4606
4607 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4608 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4609 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4610 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4611 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4612 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4613 stops.
4614
4615 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4616 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4617 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4618 first thread completes whatever you requested.
4619
4620 @cindex automatic thread selection
4621 @cindex switching threads automatically
4622 @cindex threads, automatic switching
4623 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
4624 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
4625 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
4626 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
4627 thread.
4628
4629 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
4630 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
4631
4632 @table @code
4633 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4634 @cindex scheduler locking mode
4635 @cindex lock scheduler
4636 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4637 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4638 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4639 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
4640 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
4641 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
4642 Other threads only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4643 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4644 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4645 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4646 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
4647 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
4648
4649 @item show scheduler-locking
4650 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4651 @end table
4652
4653 @node Non-Stop Mode
4654 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
4655
4656 @cindex non-stop mode
4657
4658 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
4659 @c with more details.
4660
4661 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
4662 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
4663 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
4664 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
4665 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
4666 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
4667
4668 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
4669 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
4670 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
4671 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
4672 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
4673 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
4674 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
4675 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
4676 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
4677 independently and simultaneously.
4678
4679 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
4680 or attach to your program:
4681
4682 @smallexample
4683 # Enable the async interface.
4684 set target-async 1
4685
4686 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
4687 set pagination off
4688
4689 # Finally, turn it on!
4690 set non-stop on
4691 @end smallexample
4692
4693 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
4694
4695 @table @code
4696 @kindex set non-stop
4697 @item set non-stop on
4698 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
4699 @item set non-stop off
4700 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
4701 @kindex show non-stop
4702 @item show non-stop
4703 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
4704 @end table
4705
4706 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
4707 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
4708 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
4709 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
4710 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
4711 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
4712 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
4713 default.
4714
4715 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
4716 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
4717 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
4718
4719 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
4720 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
4721 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
4722 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
4723 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
4724
4725 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
4726 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
4727 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
4728 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
4729 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
4730
4731 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
4732
4733 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
4734 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
4735 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
4736 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
4737 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
4738 previously current thread.
4739
4740 @node Background Execution
4741 @subsection Background Execution
4742
4743 @cindex foreground execution
4744 @cindex background execution
4745 @cindex asynchronous execution
4746 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
4747
4748 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
4749 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
4750 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
4751 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
4752 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
4753 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
4754
4755 You need to explicitly enable asynchronous mode before you can use
4756 background execution commands. You can use these commands to
4757 manipulate the asynchronous mode setting:
4758
4759 @table @code
4760 @kindex set target-async
4761 @item set target-async on
4762 Enable asynchronous mode.
4763 @item set target-async off
4764 Disable asynchronous mode.
4765 @kindex show target-async
4766 @item show target-async
4767 Show the current target-async setting.
4768 @end table
4769
4770 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
4771 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
4772
4773 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
4774 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
4775 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
4776 are:
4777
4778 @table @code
4779 @kindex run&
4780 @item run
4781 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
4782
4783 @item attach
4784 @kindex attach&
4785 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
4786
4787 @item step
4788 @kindex step&
4789 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
4790
4791 @item stepi
4792 @kindex stepi&
4793 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
4794
4795 @item next
4796 @kindex next&
4797 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
4798
4799 @item nexti
4800 @kindex nexti&
4801 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
4802
4803 @item continue
4804 @kindex continue&
4805 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
4806
4807 @item finish
4808 @kindex finish&
4809 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
4810
4811 @item until
4812 @kindex until&
4813 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
4814
4815 @end table
4816
4817 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
4818 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
4819 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
4820 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
4821 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
4822 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
4823
4824 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
4825 using the @code{interrupt} command.
4826
4827 @table @code
4828 @kindex interrupt
4829 @item interrupt
4830 @itemx interrupt -a
4831
4832 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
4833 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
4834 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
4835 use @code{interrupt -a}.
4836 @end table
4837
4838 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
4839 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
4840
4841 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4842 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
4843 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4844
4845 @table @code
4846 @cindex breakpoints and threads
4847 @cindex thread breakpoints
4848 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4849 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4850 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4851 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4852 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
4853 specify some source line.
4854
4855 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4856 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4857 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4858 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4859 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4860
4861 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4862 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4863 program.
4864
4865 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4866 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4867 breakpoint condition, like this:
4868
4869 @smallexample
4870 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4871 @end smallexample
4872
4873 @end table
4874
4875 @node Interrupted System Calls
4876 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
4877
4878 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4879 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4880 @cindex premature return from system calls
4881 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
4882 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
4883 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4884 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4885 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4886 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4887 stop execution.
4888
4889 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4890 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4891 style anyways.
4892
4893 For example, do not write code like this:
4894
4895 @smallexample
4896 sleep (10);
4897 @end smallexample
4898
4899 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4900 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4901
4902 Instead, write this:
4903
4904 @smallexample
4905 int unslept = 10;
4906 while (unslept > 0)
4907 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4908 @end smallexample
4909
4910 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4911 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4912 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4913 @value{GDBN}.
4914
4915 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4916 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4917 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4918 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4919
4920
4921 @node Reverse Execution
4922 @chapter Running programs backward
4923 @cindex reverse execution
4924 @cindex running programs backward
4925
4926 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
4927 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
4928 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
4929 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
4930
4931 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
4932 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
4933 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
4934 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
4935 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
4936 all target environments can support reverse execution.
4937
4938 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
4939 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
4940 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
4941 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
4942 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
4943 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
4944 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
4945 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
4946 prior values@footnote{
4947 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
4948 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
4949 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
4950
4951 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
4952 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
4953 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
4954 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
4955 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
4956 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
4957 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
4958 }.
4959
4960 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
4961 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
4962
4963 @table @code
4964 @kindex reverse-continue
4965 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
4966 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4967 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4968 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
4969 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
4970 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
4971 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
4972
4973 @kindex reverse-step
4974 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
4975 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4976 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
4977 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
4978
4979 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
4980 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
4981 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
4982 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
4983 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
4984 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
4985
4986 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
4987 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
4988
4989 @kindex reverse-stepi
4990 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
4991 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4992 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
4993 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
4994 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
4995 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
4996 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
4997
4998 @kindex reverse-next
4999 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
5000 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5001 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
5002 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
5003 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
5004 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
5005 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
5006 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
5007 line of a function back to its return to its caller
5008 @footnote{Unles the code is too heavily optimized.}.
5009
5010 @kindex reverse-nexti
5011 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
5012 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5013 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
5014 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
5015 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
5016 another instruction, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
5017 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
5018 frame) is reached.
5019
5020 @kindex reverse-finish
5021 @item reverse-finish
5022 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
5023 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
5024 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
5025 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
5026
5027 @kindex set exec-direction
5028 @item set exec-direction
5029 Set the direction of target execution.
5030 @itemx set exec-direction reverse
5031 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
5032 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
5033 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
5034 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
5035 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
5036 @item set exec-direction forward
5037 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
5038 This is the default.
5039 @end table
5040
5041
5042 @node Process Record and Replay
5043 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
5044 @cindex process record and replay
5045 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
5046
5047 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
5048 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
5049 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
5050
5051 @cindex replay mode
5052 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
5053 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
5054 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
5055 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
5056 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
5057 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
5058 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
5059 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
5060 execution log.
5061
5062 @cindex record mode
5063 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
5064 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
5065 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
5066 for future replay.
5067
5068 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
5069 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
5070 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
5071 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
5072 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
5073 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
5074
5075 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
5076 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
5077 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
5078 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
5079
5080 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
5081 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
5082
5083 @table @code
5084 @kindex target record
5085 @kindex record
5086 @kindex rec
5087 @item target record
5088 This command starts the process record and replay target. The process
5089 record and replay target can only debug a process that is already
5090 running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with the
5091 @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording with
5092 the @kbd{target record} command.
5093
5094 Both @code{record} and @code{rec} are aliases of @code{target record}.
5095
5096 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
5097 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
5098 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
5099 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
5100 doesn't support displaced stepping.
5101
5102 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
5103 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
5104 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
5105 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), the
5106 process record and replay target cannot be started because it doesn't
5107 support these two modes.
5108
5109 @kindex record stop
5110 @kindex rec s
5111 @item record stop
5112 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
5113 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
5114 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
5115
5116 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
5117 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
5118 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
5119 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
5120 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
5121
5122 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
5123 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
5124 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
5125 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
5126 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
5127
5128 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
5129 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
5130
5131 @kindex set record insn-number-max
5132 @item set record insn-number-max @var{limit}
5133 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded. Default value is 200000.
5134
5135 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
5136 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
5137 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
5138 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
5139 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
5140 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
5141 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
5142 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
5143
5144 If @var{limit} is zero, @value{GDBN} will never delete recorded
5145 instructions from the execution log. The number of recorded
5146 instructions is unlimited in this case.
5147
5148 @kindex show record insn-number-max
5149 @item show record insn-number-max
5150 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded.
5151
5152 @kindex set record stop-at-limit
5153 @item set record stop-at-limit
5154 Control the behavior when the number of recorded instructions reaches
5155 the limit. If ON (the default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit
5156 is reached for the first time and ask you whether you want to stop the
5157 inferior or continue running it and recording the execution log. If
5158 you decide to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will
5159 cause the oldest one to be deleted.
5160
5161 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
5162 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
5163
5164 @kindex show record stop-at-limit
5165 @item show record stop-at-limit
5166 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
5167
5168 @kindex info record insn-number
5169 @item info record insn-number
5170 Show the current number of recorded instructions.
5171
5172 @kindex record delete
5173 @kindex rec del
5174 @item record delete
5175 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
5176 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
5177 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
5178 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
5179 @end table
5180
5181
5182 @node Stack
5183 @chapter Examining the Stack
5184
5185 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
5186 stopped and how it got there.
5187
5188 @cindex call stack
5189 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
5190 is generated.
5191 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
5192 the arguments of the call,
5193 and the local variables of the function being called.
5194 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
5195 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
5196 stack}.
5197
5198 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
5199 stack allow you to see all of this information.
5200
5201 @cindex selected frame
5202 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
5203 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
5204 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
5205 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
5206 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
5207 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5208
5209 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5210 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
5211 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
5212
5213 @menu
5214 * Frames:: Stack frames
5215 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
5216 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
5217 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
5218
5219 @end menu
5220
5221 @node Frames
5222 @section Stack Frames
5223
5224 @cindex frame, definition
5225 @cindex stack frame
5226 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
5227 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
5228 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
5229 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
5230 which the function is executing.
5231
5232 @cindex initial frame
5233 @cindex outermost frame
5234 @cindex innermost frame
5235 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
5236 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
5237 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
5238 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
5239 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
5240 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
5241 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
5242 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
5243
5244 @cindex frame pointer
5245 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
5246 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
5247 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
5248 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
5249 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
5250 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
5251
5252 @cindex frame number
5253 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
5254 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
5255 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
5256 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
5257 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
5258
5259 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
5260 @c underflow problems.
5261 @cindex frameless execution
5262 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
5263 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
5264 @smallexample
5265 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
5266 @end smallexample
5267 generates functions without a frame.)
5268 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
5269 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
5270 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
5271 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
5272 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
5273 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
5274 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
5275
5276 @table @code
5277 @kindex frame@r{, command}
5278 @cindex current stack frame
5279 @item frame @var{args}
5280 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
5281 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5282 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
5283 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
5284
5285 @kindex select-frame
5286 @cindex selecting frame silently
5287 @item select-frame
5288 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
5289 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
5290 @code{frame}.
5291 @end table
5292
5293 @node Backtrace
5294 @section Backtraces
5295
5296 @cindex traceback
5297 @cindex call stack traces
5298 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
5299 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
5300 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
5301 stack.
5302
5303 @table @code
5304 @kindex backtrace
5305 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
5306 @item backtrace
5307 @itemx bt
5308 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
5309 frames in the stack.
5310
5311 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
5312 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
5313
5314 @item backtrace @var{n}
5315 @itemx bt @var{n}
5316 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
5317
5318 @item backtrace -@var{n}
5319 @itemx bt -@var{n}
5320 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
5321
5322 @item backtrace full
5323 @itemx bt full
5324 @itemx bt full @var{n}
5325 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
5326 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
5327 number of frames to print, as described above.
5328 @end table
5329
5330 @kindex where
5331 @kindex info stack
5332 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
5333 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
5334
5335 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
5336 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
5337 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
5338 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
5339 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
5340 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
5341 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
5342 multi-threaded program.
5343
5344 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
5345 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
5346 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
5347 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
5348 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
5349 line number.
5350
5351 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
5352 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
5353
5354 @smallexample
5355 @group
5356 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
5357 at builtin.c:993
5358 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
5359 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
5360 at macro.c:71
5361 (More stack frames follow...)
5362 @end group
5363 @end smallexample
5364
5365 @noindent
5366 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
5367 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
5368 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
5369
5370 @noindent
5371 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
5372 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
5373 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
5374 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
5375 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
5376
5377 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
5378 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
5379 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
5380 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
5381 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
5382 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
5383 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
5384 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
5385 such a backtrace might look like:
5386
5387 @smallexample
5388 @group
5389 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
5390 at builtin.c:993
5391 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
5392 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
5393 at macro.c:71
5394 (More stack frames follow...)
5395 @end group
5396 @end smallexample
5397
5398 @noindent
5399 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
5400 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
5401
5402 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
5403 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
5404 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
5405
5406 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
5407 @cindex program entry point
5408 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
5409 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
5410 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
5411 @code{main}@footnote{
5412 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
5413 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
5414 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
5415 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
5416 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
5417 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
5418
5419 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
5420 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
5421
5422 @table @code
5423 @item set backtrace past-main
5424 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
5425 @kindex set backtrace
5426 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
5427
5428 @item set backtrace past-main off
5429 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
5430 default.
5431
5432 @item show backtrace past-main
5433 @kindex show backtrace
5434 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
5435
5436 @item set backtrace past-entry
5437 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
5438 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
5439 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
5440 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
5441
5442 @item set backtrace past-entry off
5443 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
5444 application. This is the default.
5445
5446 @item show backtrace past-entry
5447 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
5448
5449 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
5450 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
5451 @cindex backtrace limit
5452 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
5453 unlimited.
5454
5455 @item show backtrace limit
5456 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
5457 @end table
5458
5459 @node Selection
5460 @section Selecting a Frame
5461
5462 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
5463 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
5464 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
5465 of the stack frame just selected.
5466
5467 @table @code
5468 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
5469 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
5470 @item frame @var{n}
5471 @itemx f @var{n}
5472 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
5473 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
5474 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
5475 @code{main}.
5476
5477 @item frame @var{addr}
5478 @itemx f @var{addr}
5479 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
5480 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
5481 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
5482 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
5483 switches between them.
5484
5485 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
5486 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
5487
5488 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
5489 pointer and a program counter.
5490
5491 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
5492 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
5493
5494 @kindex up
5495 @item up @var{n}
5496 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
5497 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
5498 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
5499
5500 @kindex down
5501 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
5502 @item down @var{n}
5503 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
5504 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
5505 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
5506 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
5507 @end table
5508
5509 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
5510 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
5511 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5512 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
5513
5514 @need 1000
5515 For example:
5516
5517 @smallexample
5518 @group
5519 (@value{GDBP}) up
5520 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
5521 at env.c:10
5522 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
5523 @end group
5524 @end smallexample
5525
5526 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
5527 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
5528 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
5529 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
5530 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
5531 for details.
5532
5533 @table @code
5534 @kindex down-silently
5535 @kindex up-silently
5536 @item up-silently @var{n}
5537 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
5538 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
5539 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
5540 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
5541 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
5542 distracting.
5543 @end table
5544
5545 @node Frame Info
5546 @section Information About a Frame
5547
5548 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
5549 stack frame.
5550
5551 @table @code
5552 @item frame
5553 @itemx f
5554 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
5555 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
5556 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
5557 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
5558 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5559
5560 @kindex info frame
5561 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
5562 @item info frame
5563 @itemx info f
5564 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
5565 including:
5566
5567 @itemize @bullet
5568 @item
5569 the address of the frame
5570 @item
5571 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
5572 @item
5573 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
5574 @item
5575 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
5576 @item
5577 the address of the frame's arguments
5578 @item
5579 the address of the frame's local variables
5580 @item
5581 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
5582 @item
5583 which registers were saved in the frame
5584 @end itemize
5585
5586 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
5587 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
5588 the usual conventions.
5589
5590 @item info frame @var{addr}
5591 @itemx info f @var{addr}
5592 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
5593 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
5594 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
5595 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
5596 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5597
5598 @kindex info args
5599 @item info args
5600 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
5601
5602 @item info locals
5603 @kindex info locals
5604 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
5605 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
5606 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
5607
5608 @kindex info catch
5609 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
5610 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
5611 @item info catch
5612 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
5613 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
5614 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
5615 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
5616 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
5617
5618 @end table
5619
5620
5621 @node Source
5622 @chapter Examining Source Files
5623
5624 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
5625 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
5626 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
5627 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
5628 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
5629 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
5630 source files by explicit command.
5631
5632 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
5633 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
5634 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
5635
5636 @menu
5637 * List:: Printing source lines
5638 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
5639 * Edit:: Editing source files
5640 * Search:: Searching source files
5641 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
5642 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
5643 @end menu
5644
5645 @node List
5646 @section Printing Source Lines
5647
5648 @kindex list
5649 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
5650 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
5651 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
5652 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
5653 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
5654
5655 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
5656
5657 @table @code
5658 @item list @var{linenum}
5659 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
5660 current source file.
5661
5662 @item list @var{function}
5663 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
5664 @var{function}.
5665
5666 @item list
5667 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
5668 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
5669 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
5670 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
5671 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
5672
5673 @item list -
5674 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
5675 @end table
5676
5677 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
5678 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
5679 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
5680
5681 @table @code
5682 @kindex set listsize
5683 @item set listsize @var{count}
5684 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
5685 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
5686
5687 @kindex show listsize
5688 @item show listsize
5689 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
5690 @end table
5691
5692 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
5693 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
5694 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
5695 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
5696 each repetition moves up in the source file.
5697
5698 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
5699 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
5700 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
5701 to specify some source line.
5702
5703 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
5704
5705 @table @code
5706 @item list @var{linespec}
5707 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
5708
5709 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
5710 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
5711 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
5712 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
5713 the same source file as the first linespec.
5714
5715 @item list ,@var{last}
5716 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
5717
5718 @item list @var{first},
5719 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
5720
5721 @item list +
5722 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
5723
5724 @item list -
5725 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
5726
5727 @item list
5728 As described in the preceding table.
5729 @end table
5730
5731 @node Specify Location
5732 @section Specifying a Location
5733 @cindex specifying location
5734 @cindex linespec
5735
5736 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
5737 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
5738 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
5739 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
5740
5741 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
5742 @value{GDBN} understands:
5743
5744 @table @code
5745 @item @var{linenum}
5746 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
5747
5748 @item -@var{offset}
5749 @itemx +@var{offset}
5750 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
5751 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
5752 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
5753 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
5754 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
5755 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
5756 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
5757 linespec.
5758
5759 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
5760 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
5761
5762 @item @var{function}
5763 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
5764 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
5765
5766 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
5767 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
5768 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
5769 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
5770 functions in different source files.
5771
5772 @item *@var{address}
5773 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
5774 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
5775 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
5776 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
5777 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
5778 source files.
5779
5780 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
5781 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
5782 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
5783 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
5784 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
5785 of @var{address}:
5786
5787 @table @code
5788 @item @var{expression}
5789 Any expression valid in the current working language.
5790
5791 @item @var{funcaddr}
5792 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
5793 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
5794 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
5795 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
5796 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
5797 (although the Pascal form also works).
5798
5799 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
5800 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
5801
5802 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
5803 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
5804 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
5805 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
5806 functions with identical names in different source files.
5807 @end table
5808
5809 @end table
5810
5811
5812 @node Edit
5813 @section Editing Source Files
5814 @cindex editing source files
5815
5816 @kindex edit
5817 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
5818 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
5819 The editing program of your choice
5820 is invoked with the current line set to
5821 the active line in the program.
5822 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
5823 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
5824
5825 @table @code
5826 @item edit @var{location}
5827 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
5828 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
5829 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
5830 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
5831 command most commonly used:
5832
5833 @table @code
5834 @item edit @var{number}
5835 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
5836
5837 @item edit @var{function}
5838 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
5839 @end table
5840
5841 @end table
5842
5843 @subsection Choosing your Editor
5844 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
5845 @footnote{
5846 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
5847 following command-line syntax:
5848 @smallexample
5849 ex +@var{number} file
5850 @end smallexample
5851 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
5852 the file where to start editing.}.
5853 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
5854 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
5855 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
5856 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
5857 @smallexample
5858 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
5859 export EDITOR
5860 gdb @dots{}
5861 @end smallexample
5862 or in the @code{csh} shell,
5863 @smallexample
5864 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
5865 gdb @dots{}
5866 @end smallexample
5867
5868 @node Search
5869 @section Searching Source Files
5870 @cindex searching source files
5871
5872 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
5873 regular expression.
5874
5875 @table @code
5876 @kindex search
5877 @kindex forward-search
5878 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
5879 @itemx search @var{regexp}
5880 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
5881 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5882 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
5883 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
5884 @code{fo}.
5885
5886 @kindex reverse-search
5887 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
5888 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
5889 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
5890 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
5891 this command as @code{rev}.
5892 @end table
5893
5894 @node Source Path
5895 @section Specifying Source Directories
5896
5897 @cindex source path
5898 @cindex directories for source files
5899 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
5900 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
5901 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
5902 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
5903 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
5904 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
5905 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
5906
5907 For example, suppose an executable references the file
5908 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
5909 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
5910 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
5911 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
5912 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
5913 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
5914 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
5915 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
5916 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
5917 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
5918
5919 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
5920 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
5921 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
5922 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
5923 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
5924 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
5925
5926 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
5927 source files.
5928
5929 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
5930 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
5931 each line is in the file.
5932
5933 @kindex directory
5934 @kindex dir
5935 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
5936 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
5937 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
5938
5939 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
5940 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
5941
5942 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
5943 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
5944 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
5945 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
5946 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
5947 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
5948 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
5949 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
5950 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
5951 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
5952 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
5953 name to look up the sources.
5954
5955 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
5956 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
5957 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
5958 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
5959 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
5960 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
5961 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
5962 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
5963
5964 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
5965 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
5966 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
5967 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
5968 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
5969 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
5970 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
5971
5972 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
5973 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
5974 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
5975 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
5976 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
5977 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
5978 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
5979 command.
5980
5981 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
5982 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
5983 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
5984 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
5985 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
5986 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
5987 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
5988
5989 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
5990 @cindex default source path substitution
5991 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
5992 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
5993 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
5994 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
5995 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
5996 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
5997 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
5998 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
5999 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
6000 together.
6001
6002 @table @code
6003 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
6004 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
6005 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
6006 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
6007 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
6008 part of absolute file names) or
6009 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
6010 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
6011
6012 @kindex cdir
6013 @kindex cwd
6014 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
6015 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
6016 @cindex compilation directory
6017 @cindex current directory
6018 @cindex working directory
6019 @cindex directory, current
6020 @cindex directory, compilation
6021 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
6022 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
6023 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
6024 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
6025 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
6026 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
6027
6028 @item directory
6029 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
6030
6031 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
6032 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
6033
6034 @item show directories
6035 @kindex show directories
6036 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
6037
6038 @anchor{set substitute-path}
6039 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
6040 @kindex set substitute-path
6041 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
6042 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
6043 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
6044
6045 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
6046 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
6047
6048 @smallexample
6049 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
6050 @end smallexample
6051
6052 @noindent
6053 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
6054 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
6055 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
6056
6057 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
6058 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
6059 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
6060 the substitution.
6061
6062 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
6063
6064 @smallexample
6065 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
6066 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
6067 @end smallexample
6068
6069 @noindent
6070 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
6071 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
6072 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
6073 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
6074
6075
6076 @item unset substitute-path [path]
6077 @kindex unset substitute-path
6078 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
6079 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
6080 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
6081
6082 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
6083
6084 @item show substitute-path [path]
6085 @kindex show substitute-path
6086 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
6087 which would rewrite that path, if any.
6088
6089 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
6090 rules.
6091
6092 @end table
6093
6094 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
6095 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
6096 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
6097
6098 @enumerate
6099 @item
6100 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
6101
6102 @item
6103 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
6104 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
6105 directories in one command.
6106 @end enumerate
6107
6108 @node Machine Code
6109 @section Source and Machine Code
6110 @cindex source line and its code address
6111
6112 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
6113 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
6114 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
6115 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
6116 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
6117 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
6118 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
6119 well as hex.
6120
6121 @table @code
6122 @kindex info line
6123 @item info line @var{linespec}
6124 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
6125 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
6126 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
6127 @end table
6128
6129 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
6130 the object code for the first line of function
6131 @code{m4_changequote}:
6132
6133 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
6134 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
6135 @smallexample
6136 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
6137 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
6138 @end smallexample
6139
6140 @noindent
6141 @cindex code address and its source line
6142 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
6143 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
6144 @smallexample
6145 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
6146 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
6147 @end smallexample
6148
6149 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
6150 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
6151 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
6152 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
6153 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
6154 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
6155 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
6156 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
6157 Variables}).
6158
6159 @table @code
6160 @kindex disassemble
6161 @cindex assembly instructions
6162 @cindex instructions, assembly
6163 @cindex machine instructions
6164 @cindex listing machine instructions
6165 @item disassemble
6166 @itemx disassemble /m
6167 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
6168 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
6169 the @code{/m} modifier.
6170 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
6171 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
6172 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
6173 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
6174 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
6175 @end table
6176
6177 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
6178 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
6179
6180 @smallexample
6181 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
6182 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
6183 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
6184 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
6185 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
6186 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
6187 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
6188 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
6189 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
6190 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
6191 End of assembler dump.
6192 @end smallexample
6193
6194 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86:
6195
6196 @smallexample
6197 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
6198 Dump of assembler code for function main:
6199 5 @{
6200 0x08048330 <main+0>: push %ebp
6201 0x08048331 <main+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
6202 0x08048333 <main+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
6203 0x08048336 <main+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
6204 0x08048339 <main+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
6205
6206 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
6207 0x0804833c <main+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
6208 0x08048343 <main+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
6209
6210 7 return 0;
6211 8 @}
6212 0x08048348 <main+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
6213 0x0804834d <main+29>: leave
6214 0x0804834e <main+30>: ret
6215
6216 End of assembler dump.
6217 @end smallexample
6218
6219 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
6220 mnemonics or other syntax.
6221
6222 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
6223 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
6224 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
6225 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
6226 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
6227
6228 @table @code
6229 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
6230 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
6231 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
6232 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
6233 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
6234 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
6235
6236 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
6237 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
6238 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
6239 assemblers for x86-based targets.
6240
6241 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
6242 @item show disassembly-flavor
6243 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
6244 @end table
6245
6246 @table @code
6247 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
6248 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
6249 @item set disassemble-next-line
6250 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
6251 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
6252 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
6253 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
6254 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
6255 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
6256 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
6257 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
6258 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
6259 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
6260 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
6261 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
6262 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
6263 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
6264 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
6265 instruction.
6266 @end table
6267
6268
6269 @node Data
6270 @chapter Examining Data
6271
6272 @cindex printing data
6273 @cindex examining data
6274 @kindex print
6275 @kindex inspect
6276 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
6277 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
6278 @c different window or something like that.
6279 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
6280 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
6281 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
6282 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
6283 Different Languages}).
6284
6285 @table @code
6286 @item print @var{expr}
6287 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
6288 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
6289 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
6290 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
6291 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
6292 Formats}.
6293
6294 @item print
6295 @itemx print /@var{f}
6296 @cindex reprint the last value
6297 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
6298 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
6299 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
6300 @end table
6301
6302 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
6303 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
6304 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6305
6306 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
6307 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
6308 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
6309 Table}.
6310
6311 @menu
6312 * Expressions:: Expressions
6313 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
6314 * Variables:: Program variables
6315 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
6316 * Output Formats:: Output formats
6317 * Memory:: Examining memory
6318 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
6319 * Print Settings:: Print settings
6320 * Value History:: Value history
6321 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
6322 * Registers:: Registers
6323 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
6324 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
6325 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
6326 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
6327 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
6328 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
6329 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
6330 character set than GDB does
6331 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
6332 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
6333 @end menu
6334
6335 @node Expressions
6336 @section Expressions
6337
6338 @cindex expressions
6339 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
6340 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
6341 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
6342 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
6343 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
6344 you compiled your program to include this information; see
6345 @ref{Compilation}.
6346
6347 @cindex arrays in expressions
6348 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
6349 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
6350 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
6351 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
6352 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
6353 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
6354
6355 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
6356 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
6357 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
6358 languages.
6359
6360 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
6361 expressions regardless of your programming language.
6362
6363 @cindex casts, in expressions
6364 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
6365 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
6366 at that address in memory.
6367 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
6368
6369 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
6370 to programming languages:
6371
6372 @table @code
6373 @item @@
6374 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
6375 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
6376
6377 @item ::
6378 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
6379 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
6380
6381 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
6382 @cindex type casting memory
6383 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
6384 @cindex casts, to view memory
6385 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
6386 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
6387 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
6388 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
6389 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
6390 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
6391 @end table
6392
6393 @node Ambiguous Expressions
6394 @section Ambiguous Expressions
6395 @cindex ambiguous expressions
6396
6397 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
6398 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
6399 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
6400 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
6401 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
6402 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
6403 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
6404
6405 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
6406 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
6407 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
6408 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
6409 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
6410 as well.
6411
6412 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
6413 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
6414 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
6415 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
6416 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
6417 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
6418 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
6419 choices.
6420
6421 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
6422 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
6423 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
6424
6425 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
6426 @smallexample
6427 @group
6428 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
6429 [0] cancel
6430 [1] all
6431 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
6432 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
6433 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
6434 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
6435 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
6436 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
6437 > 2 4 6
6438 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
6439 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
6440 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
6441 Multiple breakpoints were set.
6442 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
6443 breakpoints.
6444 (@value{GDBP})
6445 @end group
6446 @end smallexample
6447
6448 @table @code
6449 @kindex set multiple-symbols
6450 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
6451 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
6452
6453 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
6454 is ambiguous.
6455
6456 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
6457 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
6458 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
6459 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
6460 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
6461 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
6462 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
6463 in the use of the menu.
6464
6465 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
6466 when an ambiguity is detected.
6467
6468 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
6469 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
6470
6471 @kindex show multiple-symbols
6472 @item show multiple-symbols
6473 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
6474 @end table
6475
6476 @node Variables
6477 @section Program Variables
6478
6479 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
6480 in your program.
6481
6482 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
6483 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
6484
6485 @itemize @bullet
6486 @item
6487 global (or file-static)
6488 @end itemize
6489
6490 @noindent or
6491
6492 @itemize @bullet
6493 @item
6494 visible according to the scope rules of the
6495 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
6496 @end itemize
6497
6498 @noindent This means that in the function
6499
6500 @smallexample
6501 foo (a)
6502 int a;
6503 @{
6504 bar (a);
6505 @{
6506 int b = test ();
6507 bar (b);
6508 @}
6509 @}
6510 @end smallexample
6511
6512 @noindent
6513 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
6514 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
6515 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
6516 the block where @code{b} is declared.
6517
6518 @cindex variable name conflict
6519 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
6520 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
6521 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
6522 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
6523 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
6524 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
6525 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
6526
6527 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
6528 @ifnotinfo
6529 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
6530 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
6531 @end ifnotinfo
6532 @smallexample
6533 @var{file}::@var{variable}
6534 @var{function}::@var{variable}
6535 @end smallexample
6536
6537 @noindent
6538 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
6539 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
6540 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
6541 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
6542
6543 @smallexample
6544 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
6545 @end smallexample
6546
6547 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
6548 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
6549 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
6550 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
6551 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
6552 @c conflict?? --mew
6553
6554 @cindex wrong values
6555 @cindex variable values, wrong
6556 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
6557 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
6558 @quotation
6559 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
6560 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
6561 scope, and just before exit.
6562 @end quotation
6563 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
6564 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
6565 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
6566 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
6567 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
6568 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
6569 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
6570 variable definitions may be gone.
6571
6572 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
6573 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
6574 when compiling.
6575
6576 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
6577 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
6578 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
6579 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
6580 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
6581 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
6582 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
6583
6584 @smallexample
6585 No symbol "foo" in current context.
6586 @end smallexample
6587
6588 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
6589 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
6590 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
6591 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
6592 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
6593 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
6594 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
6595 for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
6596 Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
6597 @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats
6598 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
6599
6600 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
6601 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
6602 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
6603 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
6604
6605 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
6606 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
6607 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
6608 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
6609 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
6610 For program code
6611
6612 @smallexample
6613 char var0[] = "A";
6614 signed char var1[] = "A";
6615 @end smallexample
6616
6617 You get during debugging
6618 @smallexample
6619 (gdb) print var0
6620 $1 = "A"
6621 (gdb) print var1
6622 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
6623 @end smallexample
6624
6625 @node Arrays
6626 @section Artificial Arrays
6627
6628 @cindex artificial array
6629 @cindex arrays
6630 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
6631 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
6632 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
6633 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
6634 program.
6635
6636 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
6637 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
6638 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
6639 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
6640 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
6641 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
6642 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
6643 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
6644 example. If a program says
6645
6646 @smallexample
6647 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
6648 @end smallexample
6649
6650 @noindent
6651 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
6652
6653 @smallexample
6654 p *array@@len
6655 @end smallexample
6656
6657 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
6658 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
6659 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
6660 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
6661 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
6662
6663 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
6664 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
6665 The value need not be in memory:
6666 @smallexample
6667 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
6668 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
6669 @end smallexample
6670
6671 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
6672 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
6673 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
6674 @smallexample
6675 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
6676 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
6677 @end smallexample
6678
6679 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
6680 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
6681 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
6682 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
6683 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
6684 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
6685 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
6686 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
6687 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
6688 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
6689
6690 @smallexample
6691 set $i = 0
6692 p dtab[$i++]->fv
6693 @key{RET}
6694 @key{RET}
6695 @dots{}
6696 @end smallexample
6697
6698 @node Output Formats
6699 @section Output Formats
6700
6701 @cindex formatted output
6702 @cindex output formats
6703 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
6704 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
6705 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
6706 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
6707 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
6708
6709 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
6710 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
6711 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
6712 letters supported are:
6713
6714 @table @code
6715 @item x
6716 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
6717 hexadecimal.
6718
6719 @item d
6720 Print as integer in signed decimal.
6721
6722 @item u
6723 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
6724
6725 @item o
6726 Print as integer in octal.
6727
6728 @item t
6729 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
6730 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
6731 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
6732 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
6733
6734 @item a
6735 @cindex unknown address, locating
6736 @cindex locate address
6737 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
6738 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
6739 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
6740
6741 @smallexample
6742 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
6743 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
6744 @end smallexample
6745
6746 @noindent
6747 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
6748 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
6749
6750 @item c
6751 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
6752 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
6753 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
6754 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
6755
6756 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
6757 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
6758 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
6759 data.
6760
6761 @item f
6762 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
6763 using typical floating point syntax.
6764
6765 @item s
6766 @cindex printing strings
6767 @cindex printing byte arrays
6768 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
6769 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
6770 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
6771 natural types.
6772
6773 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
6774 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
6775 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
6776 array.
6777 @end table
6778
6779 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
6780
6781 @smallexample
6782 p/x $pc
6783 @end smallexample
6784
6785 @noindent
6786 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
6787 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
6788
6789 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
6790 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
6791 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
6792
6793 @node Memory
6794 @section Examining Memory
6795
6796 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
6797 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
6798
6799 @cindex examining memory
6800 @table @code
6801 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
6802 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
6803 @itemx x @var{addr}
6804 @itemx x
6805 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
6806 @end table
6807
6808 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
6809 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
6810 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
6811 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
6812 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
6813
6814 @table @r
6815 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
6816 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
6817 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
6818 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
6819 @c 4.1.2.
6820
6821 @item @var{f}, the display format
6822 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
6823 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
6824 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
6825 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
6826 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
6827
6828 @item @var{u}, the unit size
6829 The unit size is any of
6830
6831 @table @code
6832 @item b
6833 Bytes.
6834 @item h
6835 Halfwords (two bytes).
6836 @item w
6837 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
6838 @item g
6839 Giant words (eight bytes).
6840 @end table
6841
6842 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
6843 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
6844 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
6845
6846 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
6847 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
6848 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
6849 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
6850 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
6851 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
6852 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
6853 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
6854 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
6855 a value from memory).
6856 @end table
6857
6858 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
6859 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
6860 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
6861 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
6862 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
6863
6864 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
6865 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
6866 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
6867 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
6868 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
6869
6870 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
6871 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
6872 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
6873 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
6874 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
6875 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
6876 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
6877 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
6878 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
6879
6880 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
6881 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
6882 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
6883 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
6884 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
6885 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
6886 for successive uses of @code{x}.
6887
6888 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
6889 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
6890 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
6891 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
6892 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
6893 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
6894 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
6895 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
6896 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
6897
6898 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
6899 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
6900 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
6901
6902 @cindex remote memory comparison
6903 @cindex verify remote memory image
6904 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
6905 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
6906 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
6907 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
6908 situations.
6909
6910 @table @code
6911 @kindex compare-sections
6912 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
6913 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
6914 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
6915 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
6916 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
6917 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
6918 remote request.
6919 @end table
6920
6921 @node Auto Display
6922 @section Automatic Display
6923 @cindex automatic display
6924 @cindex display of expressions
6925
6926 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
6927 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
6928 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
6929 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
6930 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
6931 The automatic display looks like this:
6932
6933 @smallexample
6934 2: foo = 38
6935 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
6936 @end smallexample
6937
6938 @noindent
6939 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
6940 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
6941 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
6942 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
6943 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
6944 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
6945
6946 @table @code
6947 @kindex display
6948 @item display @var{expr}
6949 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
6950 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
6951
6952 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
6953
6954 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
6955 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
6956 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
6957 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
6958 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
6959
6960 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
6961 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
6962 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
6963 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
6964 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6965 @end table
6966
6967 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
6968 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
6969 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6970
6971 @table @code
6972 @kindex delete display
6973 @kindex undisplay
6974 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
6975 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6976 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
6977
6978 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
6979 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
6980
6981 @kindex disable display
6982 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6983 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
6984 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
6985 enabled again later.
6986
6987 @kindex enable display
6988 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6989 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
6990 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
6991
6992 @item display
6993 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
6994 done when your program stops.
6995
6996 @kindex info display
6997 @item info display
6998 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
6999 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
7000 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
7001 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
7002 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
7003 @end table
7004
7005 @cindex display disabled out of scope
7006 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
7007 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
7008 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
7009 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
7010 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
7011 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
7012 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
7013 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
7014 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
7015 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
7016
7017 @node Print Settings
7018 @section Print Settings
7019
7020 @cindex format options
7021 @cindex print settings
7022 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
7023 and symbols are printed.
7024
7025 @noindent
7026 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
7027
7028 @table @code
7029 @kindex set print
7030 @item set print address
7031 @itemx set print address on
7032 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
7033 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
7034 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
7035 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
7036 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
7037 @code{set print address on}:
7038
7039 @smallexample
7040 @group
7041 (@value{GDBP}) f
7042 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
7043 at input.c:530
7044 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
7045 @end group
7046 @end smallexample
7047
7048 @item set print address off
7049 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
7050 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
7051
7052 @smallexample
7053 @group
7054 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
7055 (@value{GDBP}) f
7056 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
7057 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
7058 @end group
7059 @end smallexample
7060
7061 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
7062 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
7063 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
7064 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
7065
7066 @kindex show print
7067 @item show print address
7068 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
7069 @end table
7070
7071 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
7072 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
7073 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
7074 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
7075 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
7076 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
7077 it prints a symbolic address:
7078
7079 @table @code
7080 @item set print symbol-filename on
7081 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
7082 @cindex symbol, source file and line
7083 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
7084 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
7085
7086 @item set print symbol-filename off
7087 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
7088 default.
7089
7090 @item show print symbol-filename
7091 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
7092 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
7093 @end table
7094
7095 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
7096 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
7097 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
7098
7099 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
7100 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
7101
7102 @table @code
7103 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
7104 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
7105 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
7106 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
7107 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
7108 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
7109
7110 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
7111 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
7112 symbolic address.
7113 @end table
7114
7115 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
7116 @cindex pointer, finding referent
7117 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
7118 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
7119 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
7120 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
7121 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
7122 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
7123
7124 @smallexample
7125 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
7126 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
7127 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
7128 @end smallexample
7129
7130 @quotation
7131 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
7132 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
7133 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
7134 @end quotation
7135
7136 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
7137
7138 @table @code
7139 @item set print array
7140 @itemx set print array on
7141 @cindex pretty print arrays
7142 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
7143 but uses more space. The default is off.
7144
7145 @item set print array off
7146 Return to compressed format for arrays.
7147
7148 @item show print array
7149 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
7150 arrays.
7151
7152 @cindex print array indexes
7153 @item set print array-indexes
7154 @itemx set print array-indexes on
7155 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
7156 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
7157 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
7158
7159 @item set print array-indexes off
7160 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
7161
7162 @item show print array-indexes
7163 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
7164 arrays.
7165
7166 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
7167 @cindex number of array elements to print
7168 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
7169 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
7170 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
7171 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
7172 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
7173 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
7174 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
7175
7176 @item show print elements
7177 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
7178 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
7179
7180 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
7181 @kindex set print frame-arguments
7182 @cindex printing frame argument values
7183 @cindex print all frame argument values
7184 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
7185 @cindex do not print frame argument values
7186 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
7187 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
7188 values are:
7189
7190 @table @code
7191 @item all
7192 The values of all arguments are printed.
7193
7194 @item scalars
7195 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
7196 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
7197 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
7198 only scalar arguments are shown:
7199
7200 @smallexample
7201 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
7202 at frame-args.c:23
7203 @end smallexample
7204
7205 @item none
7206 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
7207 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
7208
7209 @smallexample
7210 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
7211 at frame-args.c:23
7212 @end smallexample
7213 @end table
7214
7215 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
7216 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
7217 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
7218 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
7219 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
7220 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
7221 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
7222 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
7223 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
7224 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
7225
7226 @item show print frame-arguments
7227 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
7228
7229 @item set print repeats
7230 @cindex repeated array elements
7231 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
7232 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
7233 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
7234 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
7235 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
7236 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
7237 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
7238
7239 @item show print repeats
7240 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
7241 elements.
7242
7243 @item set print null-stop
7244 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
7245 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
7246 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
7247 contain only short strings.
7248 The default is off.
7249
7250 @item show print null-stop
7251 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
7252 @sc{null} character.
7253
7254 @item set print pretty on
7255 @cindex print structures in indented form
7256 @cindex indentation in structure display
7257 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
7258 per line, like this:
7259
7260 @smallexample
7261 @group
7262 $1 = @{
7263 next = 0x0,
7264 flags = @{
7265 sweet = 1,
7266 sour = 1
7267 @},
7268 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
7269 @}
7270 @end group
7271 @end smallexample
7272
7273 @item set print pretty off
7274 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
7275
7276 @smallexample
7277 @group
7278 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
7279 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
7280 @end group
7281 @end smallexample
7282
7283 @noindent
7284 This is the default format.
7285
7286 @item show print pretty
7287 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
7288
7289 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
7290 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
7291 @cindex octal escapes in strings
7292 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
7293 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
7294 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
7295 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
7296 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
7297
7298 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
7299 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
7300 international character sets, and is the default.
7301
7302 @item show print sevenbit-strings
7303 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
7304
7305 @item set print union on
7306 @cindex unions in structures, printing
7307 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
7308 and other unions. This is the default setting.
7309
7310 @item set print union off
7311 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
7312 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
7313 instead.
7314
7315 @item show print union
7316 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
7317 structures and other unions.
7318
7319 For example, given the declarations
7320
7321 @smallexample
7322 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
7323 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
7324 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
7325 Bug_forms;
7326
7327 struct thing @{
7328 Species it;
7329 union @{
7330 Tree_forms tree;
7331 Bug_forms bug;
7332 @} form;
7333 @};
7334
7335 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
7336 @end smallexample
7337
7338 @noindent
7339 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
7340
7341 @smallexample
7342 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
7343 @end smallexample
7344
7345 @noindent
7346 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
7347
7348 @smallexample
7349 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
7350 @end smallexample
7351
7352 @noindent
7353 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
7354 and in Pascal.
7355 @end table
7356
7357 @need 1000
7358 @noindent
7359 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
7360
7361 @table @code
7362 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
7363 @item set print demangle
7364 @itemx set print demangle on
7365 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
7366 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
7367 linkage. The default is on.
7368
7369 @item show print demangle
7370 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
7371
7372 @item set print asm-demangle
7373 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
7374 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
7375 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
7376 The default is off.
7377
7378 @item show print asm-demangle
7379 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
7380 or demangled form.
7381
7382 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
7383 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
7384 @kindex set demangle-style
7385 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
7386 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
7387 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
7388
7389 @table @code
7390 @item auto
7391 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
7392
7393 @item gnu
7394 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
7395 This is the default.
7396
7397 @item hp
7398 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
7399
7400 @item lucid
7401 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
7402
7403 @item arm
7404 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
7405 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
7406 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
7407 require further enhancement to permit that.
7408
7409 @end table
7410 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
7411
7412 @item show demangle-style
7413 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
7414
7415 @item set print object
7416 @itemx set print object on
7417 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
7418 @cindex display derived types
7419 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
7420 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
7421 the virtual function table.
7422
7423 @item set print object off
7424 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
7425 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
7426
7427 @item show print object
7428 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
7429
7430 @item set print static-members
7431 @itemx set print static-members on
7432 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
7433 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
7434
7435 @item set print static-members off
7436 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
7437
7438 @item show print static-members
7439 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
7440
7441 @item set print pascal_static-members
7442 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
7443 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
7444 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
7445 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
7446
7447 @item set print pascal_static-members off
7448 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
7449
7450 @item show print pascal_static-members
7451 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
7452
7453 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
7454 @item set print vtbl
7455 @itemx set print vtbl on
7456 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
7457 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
7458 @cindex VTBL display
7459 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
7460 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
7461 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
7462
7463 @item set print vtbl off
7464 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
7465
7466 @item show print vtbl
7467 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
7468 @end table
7469
7470 @node Value History
7471 @section Value History
7472
7473 @cindex value history
7474 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
7475 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
7476 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
7477 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
7478 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
7479 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
7480 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
7481 symbol table.
7482
7483 @cindex @code{$}
7484 @cindex @code{$$}
7485 @cindex history number
7486 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
7487 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
7488 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
7489 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
7490 history number.
7491
7492 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
7493 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
7494 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
7495 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
7496 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
7497 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
7498 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
7499
7500 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
7501 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
7502
7503 @smallexample
7504 p *$
7505 @end smallexample
7506
7507 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
7508 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
7509
7510 @smallexample
7511 p *$.next
7512 @end smallexample
7513
7514 @noindent
7515 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
7516 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
7517
7518 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
7519 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
7520
7521 @smallexample
7522 print x
7523 set x=5
7524 @end smallexample
7525
7526 @noindent
7527 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
7528 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
7529
7530 @table @code
7531 @kindex show values
7532 @item show values
7533 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
7534 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
7535 values} does not change the history.
7536
7537 @item show values @var{n}
7538 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
7539
7540 @item show values +
7541 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
7542 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
7543 @end table
7544
7545 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
7546 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
7547
7548 @node Convenience Vars
7549 @section Convenience Variables
7550
7551 @cindex convenience variables
7552 @cindex user-defined variables
7553 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
7554 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
7555 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
7556 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
7557 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
7558
7559 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
7560 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
7561 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
7562 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
7563 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
7564
7565 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
7566 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
7567 For example:
7568
7569 @smallexample
7570 set $foo = *object_ptr
7571 @end smallexample
7572
7573 @noindent
7574 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
7575 @code{object_ptr}.
7576
7577 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
7578 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
7579 value with another assignment at any time.
7580
7581 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
7582 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
7583 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
7584 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
7585
7586 @table @code
7587 @kindex show convenience
7588 @cindex show all user variables
7589 @item show convenience
7590 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
7591 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
7592
7593 @kindex init-if-undefined
7594 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
7595 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
7596 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
7597 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
7598 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
7599 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
7600 override default values used in a command script.
7601
7602 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
7603 any side-effects do not occur.
7604 @end table
7605
7606 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
7607 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
7608 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
7609
7610 @smallexample
7611 set $i = 0
7612 print bar[$i++]->contents
7613 @end smallexample
7614
7615 @noindent
7616 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
7617
7618 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
7619 values likely to be useful.
7620
7621 @table @code
7622 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
7623 @item $_
7624 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
7625 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
7626 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
7627 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
7628 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
7629 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
7630 to the type of @code{$__}.
7631
7632 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
7633 @item $__
7634 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
7635 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
7636 to match the format in which the data was printed.
7637
7638 @item $_exitcode
7639 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
7640 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
7641 the program being debugged terminates.
7642
7643 @item $_siginfo
7644 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
7645 The variable @code{$_siginfo} is bound to extra signal information
7646 inspection (@pxref{extra signal information}).
7647 @end table
7648
7649 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
7650 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
7651 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
7652
7653 @cindex convenience functions
7654 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
7655 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
7656 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
7657 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
7658 @value{GDBN}.
7659
7660 @table @code
7661 @item help function
7662 @kindex help function
7663 @cindex show all convenience functions
7664 Print a list of all convenience functions.
7665 @end table
7666
7667 @node Registers
7668 @section Registers
7669
7670 @cindex registers
7671 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
7672 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
7673 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
7674 your machine.
7675
7676 @table @code
7677 @kindex info registers
7678 @item info registers
7679 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
7680 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
7681
7682 @kindex info all-registers
7683 @cindex floating point registers
7684 @item info all-registers
7685 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
7686 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
7687
7688 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
7689 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
7690 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
7691 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
7692 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
7693 @end table
7694
7695 @cindex stack pointer register
7696 @cindex program counter register
7697 @cindex process status register
7698 @cindex frame pointer register
7699 @cindex standard registers
7700 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
7701 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
7702 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
7703 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
7704 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
7705 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
7706 register that contains the processor status. For example,
7707 you could print the program counter in hex with
7708
7709 @smallexample
7710 p/x $pc
7711 @end smallexample
7712
7713 @noindent
7714 or print the instruction to be executed next with
7715
7716 @smallexample
7717 x/i $pc
7718 @end smallexample
7719
7720 @noindent
7721 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
7722 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
7723 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
7724 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
7725 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
7726 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
7727 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
7728
7729 @smallexample
7730 set $sp += 4
7731 @end smallexample
7732
7733 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
7734 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
7735 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
7736 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
7737 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
7738 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
7739 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
7740
7741 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
7742 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
7743 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
7744 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
7745 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
7746 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
7747 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
7748
7749 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
7750 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
7751 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
7752 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
7753 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
7754 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
7755 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
7756 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
7757 prints the data in both formats.
7758
7759 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
7760 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
7761 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
7762 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
7763 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
7764 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
7765 registers in @code{struct} notation:
7766
7767 @smallexample
7768 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
7769 $1 = @{
7770 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
7771 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
7772 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
7773 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
7774 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
7775 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
7776 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
7777 @}
7778 @end smallexample
7779
7780 @noindent
7781 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
7782 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
7783 value to a @code{struct} member:
7784
7785 @smallexample
7786 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
7787 @end smallexample
7788
7789 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
7790 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
7791 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
7792 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
7793 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
7794 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
7795
7796 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
7797 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
7798 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
7799 frame makes no difference.
7800
7801 @node Floating Point Hardware
7802 @section Floating Point Hardware
7803 @cindex floating point
7804
7805 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
7806 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
7807
7808 @table @code
7809 @kindex info float
7810 @item info float
7811 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
7812 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
7813 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
7814 the ARM and x86 machines.
7815 @end table
7816
7817 @node Vector Unit
7818 @section Vector Unit
7819 @cindex vector unit
7820
7821 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
7822 more information about the status of the vector unit.
7823
7824 @table @code
7825 @kindex info vector
7826 @item info vector
7827 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
7828 layout vary depending on the hardware.
7829 @end table
7830
7831 @node OS Information
7832 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
7833 @cindex OS information
7834
7835 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
7836 you debug your program.
7837
7838 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
7839 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
7840 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
7841 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
7842 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
7843 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
7844 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
7845 structure.
7846
7847 @table @code
7848 @item info udot
7849 @kindex info udot
7850 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
7851 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
7852 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
7853 the @code{examine} command.
7854 @end table
7855
7856 @cindex auxiliary vector
7857 @cindex vector, auxiliary
7858 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
7859 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
7860 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
7861 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
7862 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
7863 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
7864 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
7865 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
7866 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
7867 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
7868 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
7869
7870 @table @code
7871 @kindex info auxv
7872 @item info auxv
7873 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
7874 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
7875 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
7876 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
7877 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
7878 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
7879 an unrecognized tag.
7880 @end table
7881
7882 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating-system-specific information
7883 and display it to user, without interpretation. For remote targets,
7884 this functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
7885 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
7886
7887 @table @code
7888 @kindex info os processes
7889 @item info os processes
7890 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
7891 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, and
7892 the command corresponding to the process.
7893 @end table
7894
7895 @node Memory Region Attributes
7896 @section Memory Region Attributes
7897 @cindex memory region attributes
7898
7899 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
7900 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
7901 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
7902 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
7903 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
7904 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
7905 user can override the fetched regions.
7906
7907 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
7908 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
7909 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
7910 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
7911 all memory.
7912
7913 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
7914 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
7915
7916 @table @code
7917 @kindex mem
7918 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
7919 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
7920 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
7921 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
7922 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
7923 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
7924
7925 @item mem auto
7926 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
7927 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
7928
7929 @kindex delete mem
7930 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7931 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
7932 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
7933
7934 @kindex disable mem
7935 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7936 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7937 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
7938 It may be enabled again later.
7939
7940 @kindex enable mem
7941 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7942 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7943
7944 @kindex info mem
7945 @item info mem
7946 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
7947 for each region:
7948
7949 @table @emph
7950 @item Memory Region Number
7951 @item Enabled or Disabled.
7952 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
7953 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
7954
7955 @item Lo Address
7956 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
7957
7958 @item Hi Address
7959 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
7960
7961 @item Attributes
7962 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
7963 @end table
7964 @end table
7965
7966
7967 @subsection Attributes
7968
7969 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
7970 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
7971 write accesses to a memory region.
7972
7973 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
7974 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
7975 etc.@: from accessing memory.
7976
7977 @table @code
7978 @item ro
7979 Memory is read only.
7980 @item wo
7981 Memory is write only.
7982 @item rw
7983 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
7984 @end table
7985
7986 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
7987 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
7988 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
7989 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
7990 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
7991
7992 @table @code
7993 @item 8
7994 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
7995 @item 16
7996 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
7997 @item 32
7998 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
7999 @item 64
8000 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
8001 @end table
8002
8003 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
8004 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
8005 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
8006 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
8007 @c
8008 @c @table @code
8009 @c @item hwbreak
8010 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
8011 @c @item swbreak (default)
8012 @c @end table
8013
8014 @subsubsection Data Cache
8015 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
8016 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
8017 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
8018 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
8019 registers.
8020
8021 @table @code
8022 @item cache
8023 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
8024 @item nocache
8025 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
8026 @end table
8027
8028 @subsection Memory Access Checking
8029 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
8030 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
8031 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
8032 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
8033
8034 @table @code
8035 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
8036 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
8037 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
8038 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
8039 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
8040 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
8041 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
8042 The default value is @code{on}.
8043 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
8044 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
8045 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
8046 @end table
8047
8048
8049 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
8050 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
8051 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
8052 @c
8053 @c @table @code
8054 @c @item verify
8055 @c @item noverify (default)
8056 @c @end table
8057
8058 @node Dump/Restore Files
8059 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
8060 @cindex dump/restore files
8061 @cindex append data to a file
8062 @cindex dump data to a file
8063 @cindex restore data from a file
8064
8065 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
8066 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
8067 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
8068 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
8069 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
8070 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
8071 files.
8072
8073 @table @code
8074
8075 @kindex dump
8076 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
8077 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
8078 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
8079 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
8080
8081 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
8082 @table @code
8083 @item binary
8084 Raw binary form.
8085 @item ihex
8086 Intel hex format.
8087 @item srec
8088 Motorola S-record format.
8089 @item tekhex
8090 Tektronix Hex format.
8091 @end table
8092
8093 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
8094 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
8095 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
8096 form.
8097
8098 @kindex append
8099 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
8100 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
8101 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
8102 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
8103 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
8104
8105 @kindex restore
8106 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
8107 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
8108 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
8109 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
8110 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
8111
8112 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
8113 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
8114 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
8115 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
8116 from that location.
8117
8118 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
8119 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
8120 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
8121 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
8122
8123 @end table
8124
8125 @node Core File Generation
8126 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
8127 @cindex dump core from inferior
8128
8129 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
8130 image of a running process and its process status (register values
8131 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
8132 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
8133 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
8134 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
8135 the post-mortem debugging mode.
8136
8137 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
8138 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
8139 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
8140
8141 @table @code
8142 @kindex gcore
8143 @kindex generate-core-file
8144 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
8145 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
8146 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
8147 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
8148 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
8149 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
8150
8151 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
8152 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
8153 @end table
8154
8155 @node Character Sets
8156 @section Character Sets
8157 @cindex character sets
8158 @cindex charset
8159 @cindex translating between character sets
8160 @cindex host character set
8161 @cindex target character set
8162
8163 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
8164 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
8165 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
8166 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
8167 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
8168 @dfn{target character set}.
8169
8170 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
8171 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
8172 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
8173 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
8174 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
8175 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
8176 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
8177 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
8178 character and string literals in expressions.
8179
8180 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
8181 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
8182 target-charset} command, described below.
8183
8184 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
8185 support:
8186
8187 @table @code
8188 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
8189 @kindex set target-charset
8190 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
8191 list of supported target character sets, type
8192 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
8193
8194 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
8195 @kindex set host-charset
8196 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
8197
8198 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
8199 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
8200 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
8201 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
8202 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
8203
8204 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
8205 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
8206 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
8207
8208 @item set charset @var{charset}
8209 @kindex set charset
8210 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
8211 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
8212 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
8213 for both host and target.
8214
8215 @item show charset
8216 @kindex show charset
8217 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
8218
8219 @item show host-charset
8220 @kindex show host-charset
8221 Show the name of the current host character set.
8222
8223 @item show target-charset
8224 @kindex show target-charset
8225 Show the name of the current target character set.
8226
8227 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
8228 @kindex set target-wide-charset
8229 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
8230 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
8231 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
8232 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
8233
8234 @item show target-wide-charset
8235 @kindex show target-wide-charset
8236 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
8237 @end table
8238
8239 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
8240 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
8241 @file{charset-test.c}:
8242
8243 @smallexample
8244 #include <stdio.h>
8245
8246 char ascii_hello[]
8247 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
8248 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
8249 char ibm1047_hello[]
8250 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
8251 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
8252
8253 main ()
8254 @{
8255 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8256 @}
8257 @end smallexample
8258
8259 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
8260 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
8261 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
8262
8263 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
8264
8265 @smallexample
8266 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
8267 $ gdb -nw charset-test
8268 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
8269 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
8270 @dots{}
8271 (@value{GDBP})
8272 @end smallexample
8273
8274 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
8275 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
8276 strings:
8277
8278 @smallexample
8279 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
8280 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
8281 (@value{GDBP})
8282 @end smallexample
8283
8284 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
8285 initial character set:
8286 @smallexample
8287 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
8288 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
8289 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
8290 (@value{GDBP})
8291 @end smallexample
8292
8293 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
8294 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
8295 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
8296 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
8297 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
8298
8299 @smallexample
8300 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
8301 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
8302 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
8303 $2 = 72 'H'
8304 (@value{GDBP})
8305 @end smallexample
8306
8307 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
8308 literals you use in expressions:
8309
8310 @smallexample
8311 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
8312 $3 = 43 '+'
8313 (@value{GDBP})
8314 @end smallexample
8315
8316 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
8317 character.
8318
8319 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
8320 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
8321 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
8322
8323 @smallexample
8324 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
8325 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
8326 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
8327 $5 = 200 '\310'
8328 (@value{GDBP})
8329 @end smallexample
8330
8331 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
8332 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
8333
8334 @smallexample
8335 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
8336 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
8337 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
8338 @end smallexample
8339
8340 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
8341 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
8342 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
8343 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
8344 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
8345
8346 @smallexample
8347 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
8348 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
8349 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
8350 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
8351 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
8352 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
8353 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
8354 $7 = 72 '\110'
8355 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
8356 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
8357 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
8358 $9 = 200 'H'
8359 (@value{GDBP})
8360 @end smallexample
8361
8362 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
8363 string literals you use in expressions:
8364
8365 @smallexample
8366 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
8367 $10 = 78 '+'
8368 (@value{GDBP})
8369 @end smallexample
8370
8371 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
8372 character.
8373
8374 @node Caching Remote Data
8375 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
8376 @cindex caching data of remote targets
8377
8378 @value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
8379 remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
8380 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
8381 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
8382 @value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
8383 registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
8384 volatile registers are in use.
8385
8386 @table @code
8387 @kindex set remotecache
8388 @item set remotecache on
8389 @itemx set remotecache off
8390 Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
8391 caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
8392
8393 @kindex show remotecache
8394 @item show remotecache
8395 Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
8396
8397 @kindex info dcache
8398 @item info dcache
8399 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
8400 information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
8401 each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
8402 state (invalid, dirty, valid). This command is useful for debugging
8403 the data cache operation.
8404 @end table
8405
8406 @node Searching Memory
8407 @section Search Memory
8408 @cindex searching memory
8409
8410 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
8411 @code{find} command.
8412
8413 @table @code
8414 @kindex find
8415 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
8416 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
8417 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
8418 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
8419 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
8420 @end table
8421
8422 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
8423 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
8424
8425 @table @r
8426 @item @var{s}, search query size
8427 The size of each search query value.
8428
8429 @table @code
8430 @item b
8431 bytes
8432 @item h
8433 halfwords (two bytes)
8434 @item w
8435 words (four bytes)
8436 @item g
8437 giant words (eight bytes)
8438 @end table
8439
8440 All values are interpreted in the current language.
8441 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
8442 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
8443
8444 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
8445 value's type in the current language.
8446 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
8447 pattern as a mixture of types.
8448 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
8449 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
8450 which is typically four bytes.
8451
8452 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
8453 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
8454 @end table
8455
8456 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
8457 (@code{"}).
8458 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
8459 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
8460
8461 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
8462 number of matches found.
8463
8464 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
8465 @samp{$_}.
8466 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
8467
8468 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
8469
8470 @smallexample
8471 void
8472 hello ()
8473 @{
8474 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
8475 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
8476 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
8477 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
8478 printf ("%s\n", hello);
8479 @}
8480 @end smallexample
8481
8482 @noindent
8483 you get during debugging:
8484
8485 @smallexample
8486 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
8487 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
8488 1 pattern found
8489 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
8490 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
8491 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
8492 2 patterns found
8493 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
8494 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
8495 1 pattern found
8496 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
8497 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
8498 1 pattern found
8499 (gdb) print $numfound
8500 $1 = 1
8501 (gdb) print $_
8502 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
8503 @end smallexample
8504
8505 @node Macros
8506 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
8507
8508 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
8509 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
8510 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
8511 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
8512 where it was defined.
8513
8514 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
8515 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
8516 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
8517 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
8518
8519 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
8520 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
8521 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
8522 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
8523 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
8524 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
8525 see @ref{List}.
8526
8527 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
8528 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
8529 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
8530
8531 @table @code
8532
8533 @kindex macro expand
8534 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
8535 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
8536 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
8537 @item macro expand @var{expression}
8538 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
8539 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
8540 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
8541 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
8542 it can be any string of tokens.
8543
8544 @kindex macro exp1
8545 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
8546 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
8547 @cindex expand macro once
8548 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
8549 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
8550 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
8551 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
8552 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
8553 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
8554 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
8555 can be any string of tokens.
8556
8557 @kindex info macro
8558 @cindex macro definition, showing
8559 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
8560 @item info macro @var{macro}
8561 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
8562 source location or compiler command-line where that definition was established.
8563
8564 @kindex macro define
8565 @cindex user-defined macros
8566 @cindex defining macros interactively
8567 @cindex macros, user-defined
8568 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
8569 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
8570 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
8571 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
8572 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
8573 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
8574 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
8575 @var{arglist}.
8576
8577 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
8578 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
8579 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
8580 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
8581 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
8582
8583 @kindex macro undef
8584 @item macro undef @var{macro}
8585 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
8586 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
8587 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
8588 in the program being debugged.
8589
8590 @kindex macro list
8591 @item macro list
8592 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
8593 @end table
8594
8595 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
8596 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
8597 show our source files:
8598
8599 @smallexample
8600 $ cat sample.c
8601 #include <stdio.h>
8602 #include "sample.h"
8603
8604 #define M 42
8605 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
8606
8607 main ()
8608 @{
8609 #define N 28
8610 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8611 #undef N
8612 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
8613 #define N 1729
8614 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
8615 @}
8616 $ cat sample.h
8617 #define Q <
8618 $
8619 @end smallexample
8620
8621 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
8622 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
8623 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
8624 information.
8625
8626 @smallexample
8627 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
8628 $
8629 @end smallexample
8630
8631 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
8632
8633 @smallexample
8634 $ gdb -nw sample
8635 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
8636 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
8637 GDB is free software, @dots{}
8638 (@value{GDBP})
8639 @end smallexample
8640
8641 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
8642 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
8643 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
8644
8645 @smallexample
8646 (@value{GDBP}) list main
8647 3
8648 4 #define M 42
8649 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
8650 6
8651 7 main ()
8652 8 @{
8653 9 #define N 28
8654 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8655 11 #undef N
8656 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
8657 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
8658 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
8659 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
8660 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
8661 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
8662 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
8663 #define Q <
8664 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
8665 expands to: (42 + 1)
8666 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
8667 expands to: once (M + 1)
8668 (@value{GDBP})
8669 @end smallexample
8670
8671 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
8672 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
8673 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
8674 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
8675
8676 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
8677 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
8678
8679 @smallexample
8680 (@value{GDBP}) break main
8681 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
8682 (@value{GDBP}) run
8683 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
8684
8685 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
8686 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8687 (@value{GDBP})
8688 @end smallexample
8689
8690 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
8691
8692 @smallexample
8693 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
8694 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
8695 #define N 28
8696 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
8697 expands to: 28 < 42
8698 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
8699 $1 = 1
8700 (@value{GDBP})
8701 @end smallexample
8702
8703 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
8704 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
8705 thereof) in force at each point:
8706
8707 @smallexample
8708 (@value{GDBP}) next
8709 Hello, world!
8710 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
8711 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
8712 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
8713 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
8714 (@value{GDBP}) next
8715 We're so creative.
8716 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
8717 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
8718 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
8719 #define N 1729
8720 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
8721 expands to: 1729 < 42
8722 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
8723 $2 = 0
8724 (@value{GDBP})
8725 @end smallexample
8726
8727 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
8728 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
8729 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
8730 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
8731
8732 @smallexample
8733 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
8734 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
8735 -D__STDC__=1
8736 (@value{GDBP})
8737 @end smallexample
8738
8739
8740 @node Tracepoints
8741 @chapter Tracepoints
8742 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
8743 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
8744
8745 @cindex tracepoints
8746 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
8747 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
8748 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
8749 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
8750 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
8751 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
8752 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
8753
8754 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
8755 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
8756 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
8757 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
8758 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
8759 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
8760 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
8761 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
8762 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
8763 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
8764 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
8765
8766 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
8767 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
8768 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
8769 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
8770 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
8771 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
8772 Packets}.
8773
8774 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
8775
8776 @menu
8777 * Set Tracepoints::
8778 * Analyze Collected Data::
8779 * Tracepoint Variables::
8780 @end menu
8781
8782 @node Set Tracepoints
8783 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
8784
8785 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
8786 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
8787 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
8788 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
8789 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
8790 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
8791 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
8792
8793 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
8794 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
8795 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
8796 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
8797 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
8798 tracepoint was hit.
8799
8800 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Conditional
8801 expressions and ignore counts on tracepoints have no effect, and
8802 tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN} commands when they are
8803 hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific either.
8804
8805 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
8806 conditions and actions.
8807
8808 @menu
8809 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
8810 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
8811 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
8812 * Tracepoint Actions::
8813 * Listing Tracepoints::
8814 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
8815 @end menu
8816
8817 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
8818 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
8819
8820 @table @code
8821 @cindex set tracepoint
8822 @kindex trace
8823 @item trace @var{location}
8824 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
8825 Its argument @var{location} can be a source line, a function name, or
8826 an address in the target program. @xref{Specify Location}. The
8827 @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the
8828 target program where the debugger will briefly stop, collect some
8829 data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or
8830 changing its actions doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
8831 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
8832 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts.
8833
8834 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
8835
8836 @smallexample
8837 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
8838
8839 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
8840
8841 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
8842
8843 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
8844
8845 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
8846 @end smallexample
8847
8848 @noindent
8849 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
8850
8851 @vindex $tpnum
8852 @cindex last tracepoint number
8853 @cindex recent tracepoint number
8854 @cindex tracepoint number
8855 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
8856 of the most recently set tracepoint.
8857
8858 @kindex delete tracepoint
8859 @cindex tracepoint deletion
8860 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8861 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
8862 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
8863 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
8864
8865 Examples:
8866
8867 @smallexample
8868 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
8869
8870 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
8871 @end smallexample
8872
8873 @noindent
8874 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
8875 @end table
8876
8877 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
8878 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
8879
8880 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
8881
8882 @table @code
8883 @kindex disable tracepoint
8884 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8885 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
8886 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
8887 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
8888 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
8889
8890 @kindex enable tracepoint
8891 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8892 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
8893 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
8894 run.
8895 @end table
8896
8897 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
8898 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
8899
8900 @table @code
8901 @kindex passcount
8902 @cindex tracepoint pass count
8903 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
8904 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
8905 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
8906 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
8907 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
8908 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
8909 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
8910 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
8911 user.
8912
8913 Examples:
8914
8915 @smallexample
8916 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
8917 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
8918
8919 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
8920 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
8921 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
8922 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
8923 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
8924 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
8925 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
8926 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
8927 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
8928 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
8929 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
8930 @end smallexample
8931 @end table
8932
8933 @node Tracepoint Actions
8934 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
8935
8936 @table @code
8937 @kindex actions
8938 @cindex tracepoint actions
8939 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8940 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
8941 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
8942 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
8943 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
8944 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
8945 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
8946 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
8947 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
8948 @code{while-stepping}.
8949
8950 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
8951 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
8952 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
8953
8954 @smallexample
8955 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
8956
8957 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
8958
8959 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
8960 @end smallexample
8961
8962 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
8963 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
8964 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
8965 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
8966 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
8967 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
8968 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
8969 @code{end} command.
8970
8971 @smallexample
8972 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
8973 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8974 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
8975 > collect bar,baz
8976 > collect $regs
8977 > while-stepping 12
8978 > collect $fp, $sp
8979 > end
8980 end
8981 @end smallexample
8982
8983 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
8984 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
8985 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
8986 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
8987 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
8988 special arguments are supported:
8989
8990 @table @code
8991 @item $regs
8992 collect all registers
8993
8994 @item $args
8995 collect all function arguments
8996
8997 @item $locals
8998 collect all local variables.
8999 @end table
9000
9001 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
9002 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
9003 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
9004
9005 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
9006 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
9007
9008 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
9009 @item while-stepping @var{n}
9010 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
9011 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
9012 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
9013 its own @code{end} command):
9014
9015 @smallexample
9016 > while-stepping 12
9017 > collect $regs, myglobal
9018 > end
9019 >
9020 @end smallexample
9021
9022 @noindent
9023 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
9024 @code{stepping}.
9025 @end table
9026
9027 @node Listing Tracepoints
9028 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
9029
9030 @table @code
9031 @kindex info tracepoints
9032 @kindex info tp
9033 @cindex information about tracepoints
9034 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
9035 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
9036 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
9037 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
9038 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
9039 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
9040
9041 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
9042 tracing:
9043
9044 @itemize @bullet
9045 @item
9046 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
9047 @item
9048 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
9049 @item
9050 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command. The actions
9051 are prefixed with an @samp{A} so as to distinguish them from commands.
9052 @end itemize
9053
9054 @smallexample
9055 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
9056 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
9057 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
9058 pass count 1200
9059 step count 20
9060 A while-stepping 20
9061 A collect globfoo, $regs
9062 A end
9063 A collect globfoo2
9064 A end
9065 (@value{GDBP})
9066 @end smallexample
9067
9068 @noindent
9069 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
9070 @end table
9071
9072 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
9073 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
9074
9075 @table @code
9076 @kindex tstart
9077 @cindex start a new trace experiment
9078 @cindex collected data discarded
9079 @item tstart
9080 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
9081 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
9082 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
9083 experiment.
9084
9085 @kindex tstop
9086 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
9087 @item tstop
9088 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
9089 stops collecting data.
9090
9091 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
9092 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
9093 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
9094
9095 @kindex tstatus
9096 @cindex status of trace data collection
9097 @cindex trace experiment, status of
9098 @item tstatus
9099 This command displays the status of the current trace data
9100 collection.
9101 @end table
9102
9103 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
9104
9105 @smallexample
9106 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
9107 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
9108 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
9109 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
9110 > while-stepping 11
9111 > collect $regs
9112 > end
9113 > end
9114 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
9115 [time passes @dots{}]
9116 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
9117 @end smallexample
9118
9119
9120 @node Analyze Collected Data
9121 @section Using the Collected Data
9122
9123 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
9124 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
9125 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
9126 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
9127 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
9128 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
9129 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
9130 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
9131 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
9132 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
9133 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
9134 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
9135 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
9136 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
9137 the buffer will fail.
9138
9139 @menu
9140 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
9141 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
9142 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
9143 @end menu
9144
9145 @node tfind
9146 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
9147
9148 @kindex tfind
9149 @cindex select trace snapshot
9150 @cindex find trace snapshot
9151 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
9152 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
9153 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
9154 snapshot is selected.
9155
9156 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
9157
9158 @table @code
9159 @item tfind start
9160 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
9161 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
9162
9163 @item tfind none
9164 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
9165
9166 @item tfind end
9167 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
9168
9169 @item tfind
9170 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
9171
9172 @item tfind -
9173 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
9174 retracing earlier steps.
9175
9176 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
9177 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
9178 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
9179 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
9180 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
9181
9182 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
9183 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
9184 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
9185 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
9186 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
9187
9188 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
9189 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
9190 addresses.
9191
9192 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
9193 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
9194 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
9195
9196 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
9197 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
9198 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
9199 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
9200 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
9201 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
9202 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
9203 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
9204 @end table
9205
9206 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
9207 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
9208 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
9209 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
9210 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
9211 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
9212 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
9213 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
9214 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
9215 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
9216 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
9217 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
9218 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
9219 tracepoint as the current one.
9220
9221 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
9222 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
9223 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
9224 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
9225 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
9226
9227 @smallexample
9228 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
9229 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
9230 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
9231 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
9232 > tfind
9233 > end
9234
9235 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
9236 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
9237 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
9238 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
9239 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
9240 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
9241 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
9242 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
9243 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
9244 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
9245 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
9246 @end smallexample
9247
9248 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
9249 the buffer:
9250
9251 @smallexample
9252 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
9253 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
9254 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
9255 > tfind line
9256 > end
9257
9258 Frame 0, X = 1
9259 Frame 7, X = 2
9260 Frame 13, X = 255
9261 @end smallexample
9262
9263 @node tdump
9264 @subsection @code{tdump}
9265 @kindex tdump
9266 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
9267 @cindex tracepoint data, display
9268
9269 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
9270 the current trace snapshot.
9271
9272 @smallexample
9273 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
9274 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
9275 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
9276 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
9277 > end
9278
9279 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
9280
9281 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
9282 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
9283 at gdb_test.c:444
9284 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
9285
9286 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
9287 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
9288 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
9289 d1 0x18 24
9290 d2 0x80 128
9291 d3 0x33 51
9292 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
9293 d5 0x22 34
9294 d6 0xe0 224
9295 d7 0x380035 3670069
9296 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
9297 a1 0x3000668 50333288
9298 a2 0x100 256
9299 a3 0x322000 3284992
9300 a4 0x3000698 50333336
9301 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
9302 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
9303 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
9304 ps 0x0 0
9305 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
9306 fpcontrol 0x0 0
9307 fpstatus 0x0 0
9308 fpiaddr 0x0 0
9309 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
9310 p1 = (void *) 0x11
9311 p2 = (void *) 0x22
9312 p3 = (void *) 0x33
9313 p4 = (void *) 0x44
9314 p5 = (void *) 0x55
9315 p6 = (void *) 0x66
9316 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
9317
9318 (@value{GDBP})
9319 @end smallexample
9320
9321 @node save-tracepoints
9322 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
9323 @kindex save-tracepoints
9324 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
9325
9326 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
9327 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
9328 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
9329 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
9330 Files}).
9331
9332 @node Tracepoint Variables
9333 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
9334 @cindex tracepoint variables
9335 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
9336
9337 @table @code
9338 @vindex $trace_frame
9339 @item (int) $trace_frame
9340 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
9341 snapshot is selected.
9342
9343 @vindex $tracepoint
9344 @item (int) $tracepoint
9345 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
9346
9347 @vindex $trace_line
9348 @item (int) $trace_line
9349 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
9350
9351 @vindex $trace_file
9352 @item (char []) $trace_file
9353 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
9354
9355 @vindex $trace_func
9356 @item (char []) $trace_func
9357 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
9358 @end table
9359
9360 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
9361 use @code{output} instead.
9362
9363 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
9364 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
9365 data.
9366
9367 @smallexample
9368 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
9369
9370 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
9371 > output $trace_file
9372 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
9373 > tfind
9374 > end
9375 @end smallexample
9376
9377 @node Overlays
9378 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
9379 @cindex overlays
9380
9381 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
9382 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
9383 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
9384 use overlays.
9385
9386 @menu
9387 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
9388 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
9389 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
9390 mapped by asking the inferior.
9391 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
9392 @end menu
9393
9394 @node How Overlays Work
9395 @section How Overlays Work
9396 @cindex mapped overlays
9397 @cindex unmapped overlays
9398 @cindex load address, overlay's
9399 @cindex mapped address
9400 @cindex overlay area
9401
9402 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
9403 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
9404 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
9405 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
9406 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
9407
9408 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
9409 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
9410 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
9411 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
9412 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
9413 largest overlay as well.
9414
9415 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
9416 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
9417 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
9418 there.
9419
9420 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
9421 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
9422 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
9423
9424 @smallexample
9425 @group
9426 Data Instruction Larger
9427 Address Space Address Space Address Space
9428 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
9429 | | | | | |
9430 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
9431 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
9432 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
9433 | and heap | | | | | |
9434 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
9435 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
9436 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
9437 | | | | | |
9438 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
9439 address | | | | | |
9440 | overlay | <-' | | |
9441 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
9442 | | <---. | | load address
9443 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
9444 | | | |
9445 +-----------+ | |
9446 +-----------+
9447 | |
9448 +-----------+
9449
9450 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
9451 @end group
9452 @end smallexample
9453
9454 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
9455 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
9456 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
9457 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
9458 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
9459 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
9460 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
9461 program and the overlay area.
9462
9463 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
9464 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
9465 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
9466 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
9467 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
9468 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
9469 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
9470
9471 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
9472 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
9473 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
9474
9475 @itemize @bullet
9476
9477 @item
9478 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
9479 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
9480 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
9481 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
9482
9483 @item
9484 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
9485 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
9486 your program's performance.
9487
9488 @item
9489 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
9490 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
9491 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
9492 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
9493 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
9494 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
9495 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
9496
9497 @item
9498 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
9499 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
9500 instruction and data spaces.
9501
9502 @end itemize
9503
9504 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
9505 improved in many ways:
9506
9507 @itemize @bullet
9508
9509 @item
9510 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
9511 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
9512 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
9513 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
9514 area in the usual way.
9515
9516 @item
9517 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
9518 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
9519
9520 @item
9521 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
9522 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
9523 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
9524 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
9525 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
9526 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
9527 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
9528
9529 @end itemize
9530
9531
9532 @node Overlay Commands
9533 @section Overlay Commands
9534
9535 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
9536 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
9537 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
9538 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
9539 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
9540 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
9541
9542 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
9543 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
9544
9545 @table @code
9546 @item overlay off
9547 @kindex overlay
9548 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
9549 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
9550 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
9551 overlay support is disabled.
9552
9553 @item overlay manual
9554 @cindex manual overlay debugging
9555 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
9556 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
9557 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
9558 commands described below.
9559
9560 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
9561 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
9562 @cindex map an overlay
9563 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
9564 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
9565 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
9566 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
9567 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
9568 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
9569
9570 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
9571 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
9572 @cindex unmap an overlay
9573 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
9574 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
9575 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
9576 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
9577
9578 @item overlay auto
9579 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
9580 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
9581 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
9582 Overlay Debugging}.
9583
9584 @item overlay load-target
9585 @itemx overlay load
9586 @cindex reloading the overlay table
9587 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
9588 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
9589 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
9590 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
9591 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
9592
9593 @item overlay list-overlays
9594 @itemx overlay list
9595 @cindex listing mapped overlays
9596 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
9597 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
9598
9599 @end table
9600
9601 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
9602 of the function the address falls in:
9603
9604 @smallexample
9605 (@value{GDBP}) print main
9606 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
9607 @end smallexample
9608 @noindent
9609 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
9610 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
9611 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
9612 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
9613
9614 @smallexample
9615 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
9616 No sections are mapped.
9617 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
9618 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
9619 @end smallexample
9620 @noindent
9621 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
9622 name normally:
9623
9624 @smallexample
9625 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
9626 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
9627 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
9628 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
9629 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
9630 @end smallexample
9631
9632 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
9633 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
9634 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
9635 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
9636 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
9637
9638 @itemize @bullet
9639 @item
9640 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
9641 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
9642 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
9643 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
9644 @item
9645 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
9646 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
9647 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
9648 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
9649 breakpoints properly.
9650 @end itemize
9651
9652
9653 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
9654 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
9655 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
9656
9657 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
9658 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
9659 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
9660 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
9661 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
9662 current state of the overlays.
9663
9664 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
9665 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
9666
9667 @table @asis
9668
9669 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
9670 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
9671
9672 @smallexample
9673 struct
9674 @{
9675 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
9676 unsigned long vma;
9677
9678 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
9679 unsigned long size;
9680
9681 /* The overlay's load address. */
9682 unsigned long lma;
9683
9684 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
9685 zero otherwise. */
9686 unsigned long mapped;
9687 @}
9688 @end smallexample
9689
9690 @item @code{_novlys}:
9691 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
9692 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
9693
9694 @end table
9695
9696 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
9697 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
9698 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
9699 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
9700 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
9701 currently mapped.
9702
9703 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
9704 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
9705 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
9706 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
9707 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
9708 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
9709 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
9710 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
9711 are not being executed.
9712
9713 @node Overlay Sample Program
9714 @section Overlay Sample Program
9715 @cindex overlay example program
9716
9717 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
9718 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
9719 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
9720 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
9721 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
9722 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
9723 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
9724
9725 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
9726 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
9727 suite. The program consists of the following files from
9728 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
9729
9730 @table @file
9731 @item overlays.c
9732 The main program file.
9733 @item ovlymgr.c
9734 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
9735 @item foo.c
9736 @itemx bar.c
9737 @itemx baz.c
9738 @itemx grbx.c
9739 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
9740 @item d10v.ld
9741 @itemx m32r.ld
9742 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
9743 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
9744 @end table
9745
9746 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
9747 cross-compiler like this:
9748
9749 @smallexample
9750 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
9751 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
9752 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
9753 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
9754 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
9755 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
9756 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
9757 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
9758 @end smallexample
9759
9760 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
9761 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
9762 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
9763
9764
9765 @node Languages
9766 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
9767 @cindex languages
9768
9769 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
9770 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
9771 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
9772 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
9773 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
9774 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
9775
9776 @cindex working language
9777 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
9778 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
9779 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
9780 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
9781 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
9782 language}.
9783
9784 @menu
9785 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
9786 * Show:: Displaying the language
9787 * Checks:: Type and range checks
9788 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
9789 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
9790 @end menu
9791
9792 @node Setting
9793 @section Switching Between Source Languages
9794
9795 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
9796 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
9797 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
9798 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
9799 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
9800 are printed, etc.
9801
9802 In addition to the working language, every source file that
9803 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
9804 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
9805 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
9806 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
9807 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
9808 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
9809 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
9810 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
9811 Displaying the Language}.
9812
9813 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
9814 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
9815 another language. In that case, make the
9816 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
9817 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
9818 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
9819
9820 @menu
9821 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
9822 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
9823 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
9824 @end menu
9825
9826 @node Filenames
9827 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
9828
9829 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
9830 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
9831
9832 @table @file
9833 @item .ada
9834 @itemx .ads
9835 @itemx .adb
9836 @itemx .a
9837 Ada source file.
9838
9839 @item .c
9840 C source file
9841
9842 @item .C
9843 @itemx .cc
9844 @itemx .cp
9845 @itemx .cpp
9846 @itemx .cxx
9847 @itemx .c++
9848 C@t{++} source file
9849
9850 @item .m
9851 Objective-C source file
9852
9853 @item .f
9854 @itemx .F
9855 Fortran source file
9856
9857 @item .mod
9858 Modula-2 source file
9859
9860 @item .s
9861 @itemx .S
9862 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
9863 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
9864 @end table
9865
9866 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
9867 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
9868
9869 @node Manually
9870 @subsection Setting the Working Language
9871
9872 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
9873 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
9874 your program.
9875
9876 @kindex set language
9877 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
9878 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
9879 a language, such as
9880 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
9881 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
9882
9883 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
9884 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
9885 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
9886 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
9887 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
9888 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
9889 command such as:
9890
9891 @smallexample
9892 print a = b + c
9893 @end smallexample
9894
9895 @noindent
9896 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
9897 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
9898 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
9899 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
9900
9901 @node Automatically
9902 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
9903
9904 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
9905 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
9906 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
9907 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
9908 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
9909 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
9910 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
9911 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
9912 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
9913
9914 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
9915 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
9916 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
9917 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
9918 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
9919
9920 @node Show
9921 @section Displaying the Language
9922
9923 The following commands help you find out which language is the
9924 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
9925
9926 @table @code
9927 @item show language
9928 @kindex show language
9929 Display the current working language. This is the
9930 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
9931 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
9932
9933 @item info frame
9934 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
9935 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
9936 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
9937 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
9938 information listed here.
9939
9940 @item info source
9941 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
9942 Display the source language of this source file.
9943 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
9944 information listed here.
9945 @end table
9946
9947 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
9948 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
9949 with a language explicitly:
9950
9951 @table @code
9952 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
9953 @kindex set extension-language
9954 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
9955 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
9956
9957 @item info extensions
9958 @kindex info extensions
9959 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
9960 @end table
9961
9962 @node Checks
9963 @section Type and Range Checking
9964
9965 @quotation
9966 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
9967 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
9968 section documents the intended facilities.
9969 @end quotation
9970 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
9971
9972 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
9973 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
9974 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
9975 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
9976 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
9977 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
9978 errors when your program is running.
9979
9980 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
9981 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
9982 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
9983 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
9984 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
9985 automatically based on your program's source language.
9986 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
9987 settings of supported languages.
9988
9989 @menu
9990 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
9991 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
9992 @end menu
9993
9994 @cindex type checking
9995 @cindex checks, type
9996 @node Type Checking
9997 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
9998
9999 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
10000 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
10001 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
10002 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
10003
10004 @smallexample
10005 1 + 2 @result{} 3
10006 @exdent but
10007 @error{} 1 + 2.3
10008 @end smallexample
10009
10010 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
10011 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
10012
10013 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
10014 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
10015 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
10016 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
10017 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
10018 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
10019 also issues a warning.
10020
10021 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
10022 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
10023 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
10024 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
10025 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
10026 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
10027
10028 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
10029 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
10030 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
10031 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
10032 operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
10033 details on specific languages.
10034
10035 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
10036
10037 @kindex set check type
10038 @kindex show check type
10039 @table @code
10040 @item set check type auto
10041 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
10042 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
10043 each language.
10044
10045 @item set check type on
10046 @itemx set check type off
10047 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
10048 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
10049 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
10050 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
10051 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
10052
10053 @item set check type warn
10054 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
10055 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
10056 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
10057 numbers and structures.
10058
10059 @item show type
10060 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
10061 is setting it automatically.
10062 @end table
10063
10064 @cindex range checking
10065 @cindex checks, range
10066 @node Range Checking
10067 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
10068
10069 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
10070 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
10071 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
10072 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
10073 not exceed the bounds of the array.
10074
10075 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
10076 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
10077 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
10078 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
10079
10080 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
10081 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
10082 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
10083 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
10084 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
10085 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
10086
10087 @smallexample
10088 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
10089 @end smallexample
10090
10091 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
10092 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
10093 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
10094
10095 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
10096
10097 @kindex set check range
10098 @kindex show check range
10099 @table @code
10100 @item set check range auto
10101 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
10102 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
10103 each language.
10104
10105 @item set check range on
10106 @itemx set check range off
10107 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
10108 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
10109 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
10110 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
10111
10112 @item set check range warn
10113 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
10114 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
10115 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
10116 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
10117 systems).
10118
10119 @item show range
10120 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
10121 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
10122 @end table
10123
10124 @node Supported Languages
10125 @section Supported Languages
10126
10127 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
10128 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
10129 @c This is false ...
10130 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
10131 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
10132 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
10133 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
10134 language.
10135
10136 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
10137 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
10138 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
10139 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
10140 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
10141 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
10142 language reference or tutorial.
10143
10144 @menu
10145 * C:: C and C@t{++}
10146 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
10147 * Fortran:: Fortran
10148 * Pascal:: Pascal
10149 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
10150 * Ada:: Ada
10151 @end menu
10152
10153 @node C
10154 @subsection C and C@t{++}
10155
10156 @cindex C and C@t{++}
10157 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
10158
10159 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
10160 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
10161 together.
10162
10163 @cindex C@t{++}
10164 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
10165 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
10166 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
10167 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
10168 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
10169 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
10170 compiler (@code{aCC}).
10171
10172 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
10173 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
10174 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
10175 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
10176 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
10177 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
10178
10179 @menu
10180 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
10181 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
10182 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
10183 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
10184 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
10185 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
10186 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
10187 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
10188 @end menu
10189
10190 @node C Operators
10191 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
10192
10193 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
10194
10195 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
10196 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
10197 often defined on groups of types.
10198
10199 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
10200
10201 @itemize @bullet
10202
10203 @item
10204 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
10205 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
10206
10207 @item
10208 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
10209 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
10210
10211 @item
10212 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
10213
10214 @item
10215 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
10216
10217 @end itemize
10218
10219 @noindent
10220 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
10221 in order of increasing precedence:
10222
10223 @table @code
10224 @item ,
10225 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
10226 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
10227 expression being the last expression evaluated.
10228
10229 @item =
10230 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
10231 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
10232
10233 @item @var{op}=
10234 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
10235 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
10236 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
10237 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
10238 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
10239
10240 @item ?:
10241 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
10242 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
10243 integral type.
10244
10245 @item ||
10246 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
10247
10248 @item &&
10249 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
10250
10251 @item |
10252 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
10253
10254 @item ^
10255 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
10256
10257 @item &
10258 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
10259
10260 @item ==@r{, }!=
10261 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
10262 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
10263
10264 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
10265 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
10266 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
10267 and non-zero for true.
10268
10269 @item <<@r{, }>>
10270 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
10271
10272 @item @@
10273 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
10274
10275 @item +@r{, }-
10276 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
10277 pointer types.
10278
10279 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
10280 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
10281 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
10282 integral types.
10283
10284 @item ++@r{, }--
10285 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
10286 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
10287 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
10288 operation takes place.
10289
10290 @item *
10291 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
10292 @code{++}.
10293
10294 @item &
10295 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
10296
10297 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
10298 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
10299 to examine the address
10300 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
10301 stored.
10302
10303 @item -
10304 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
10305 precedence as @code{++}.
10306
10307 @item !
10308 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
10309 @code{++}.
10310
10311 @item ~
10312 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
10313 @code{++}.
10314
10315
10316 @item .@r{, }->
10317 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
10318 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
10319 pointer based on the stored type information.
10320 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
10321
10322 @item .*@r{, }->*
10323 Dereferences of pointers to members.
10324
10325 @item []
10326 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
10327 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
10328
10329 @item ()
10330 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
10331
10332 @item ::
10333 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
10334 and @code{class} types.
10335
10336 @item ::
10337 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
10338 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
10339 above.
10340 @end table
10341
10342 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
10343 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
10344 predefined meaning.
10345
10346 @node C Constants
10347 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
10348
10349 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
10350
10351 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
10352 following ways:
10353
10354 @itemize @bullet
10355 @item
10356 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
10357 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
10358 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
10359 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
10360 @code{long} value.
10361
10362 @item
10363 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
10364 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
10365 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
10366 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
10367 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
10368 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
10369 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
10370 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
10371 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
10372 constant.
10373
10374 @item
10375 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
10376 integral equivalents.
10377
10378 @item
10379 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
10380 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
10381 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
10382 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
10383 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
10384 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
10385 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
10386 @samp{\n} for newline.
10387
10388 @item
10389 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
10390 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
10391 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
10392 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
10393 characters.
10394
10395 @item
10396 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
10397 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
10398
10399 @item
10400 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
10401 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
10402 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
10403 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
10404 @end itemize
10405
10406 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
10407 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
10408
10409 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
10410 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
10411
10412 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
10413 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
10414 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
10415 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
10416 @quotation
10417 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
10418 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
10419 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
10420 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
10421 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
10422 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
10423 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
10424 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
10425 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
10426 C@t{++} code.
10427 @end quotation
10428
10429 @enumerate
10430
10431 @cindex member functions
10432 @item
10433 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
10434
10435 @smallexample
10436 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
10437 @end smallexample
10438
10439 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
10440 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
10441 @item
10442 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
10443 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
10444 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
10445 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
10446
10447 @cindex call overloaded functions
10448 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
10449 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
10450 @item
10451 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
10452 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
10453 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
10454 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
10455 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
10456 default arguments.
10457
10458 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
10459 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
10460 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
10461 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
10462 number of function arguments.
10463
10464 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
10465 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
10466 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
10467
10468 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
10469 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
10470 @smallexample
10471 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
10472 @end smallexample
10473
10474 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
10475 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
10476
10477 @cindex reference declarations
10478 @item
10479 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
10480 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
10481 dereferenced.
10482
10483 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
10484 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
10485 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
10486 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
10487 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
10488
10489 @item
10490 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
10491 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
10492 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
10493 necessary, for example in an expression like
10494 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
10495 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
10496 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
10497 @end enumerate
10498
10499 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
10500 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
10501 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
10502 invoking user-defined operators.
10503
10504 @node C Defaults
10505 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
10506
10507 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
10508
10509 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
10510 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
10511 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
10512 selects the working language.
10513
10514 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
10515 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
10516 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
10517 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
10518 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
10519 for further details.
10520
10521 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
10522 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
10523 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
10524
10525 @node C Checks
10526 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
10527
10528 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
10529
10530 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
10531 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
10532 considers two variables type equivalent if:
10533
10534 @itemize @bullet
10535 @item
10536 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
10537 enumerated tag.
10538
10539 @item
10540 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
10541 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
10542
10543 @ignore
10544 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
10545 @c FIXME--beers?
10546 @item
10547 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
10548 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
10549 compilers.)
10550 @end ignore
10551 @end itemize
10552
10553 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
10554 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
10555 that is not itself an array.
10556
10557 @node Debugging C
10558 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
10559
10560 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
10561 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
10562 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
10563 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
10564
10565 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
10566 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
10567 ,Expressions}.
10568
10569 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
10570 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
10571
10572 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
10573
10574 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
10575 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
10576
10577 @table @code
10578 @cindex break in overloaded functions
10579 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
10580 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
10581 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
10582 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
10583 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
10584
10585 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
10586 @item rbreak @var{regex}
10587 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
10588 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
10589 classes.
10590 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
10591
10592 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
10593 @item catch throw
10594 @itemx catch catch
10595 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
10596 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
10597
10598 @cindex inheritance
10599 @item ptype @var{typename}
10600 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
10601 @var{typename}.
10602 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
10603
10604 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
10605 @item set print demangle
10606 @itemx show print demangle
10607 @itemx set print asm-demangle
10608 @itemx show print asm-demangle
10609 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
10610 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
10611 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
10612
10613 @item set print object
10614 @itemx show print object
10615 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
10616 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
10617
10618 @item set print vtbl
10619 @itemx show print vtbl
10620 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
10621 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
10622 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10623 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10624
10625 @kindex set overload-resolution
10626 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
10627 @item set overload-resolution on
10628 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
10629 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
10630 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
10631 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
10632 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
10633 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
10634
10635 @item set overload-resolution off
10636 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
10637 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
10638 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
10639 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
10640 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
10641 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
10642 argument types.
10643
10644 @kindex show overload-resolution
10645 @item show overload-resolution
10646 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
10647
10648 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
10649 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
10650 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
10651 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
10652 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
10653 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
10654 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
10655 @end table
10656
10657 @node Decimal Floating Point
10658 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
10659 @cindex decimal floating point format
10660
10661 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
10662 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
10663 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
10664 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
10665
10666 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
10667 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
10668 PowerPC. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the configured
10669 target.
10670
10671 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
10672 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
10673 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
10674
10675 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
10676 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
10677 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
10678
10679 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
10680 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers. See
10681 @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
10682
10683 @node Objective-C
10684 @subsection Objective-C
10685
10686 @cindex Objective-C
10687 This section provides information about some commands and command
10688 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
10689 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
10690 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
10691
10692 @menu
10693 * Method Names in Commands::
10694 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
10695 @end menu
10696
10697 @node Method Names in Commands
10698 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
10699
10700 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
10701 names as line specifications:
10702
10703 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
10704 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
10705 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
10706 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
10707 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
10708 @itemize
10709 @item @code{clear}
10710 @item @code{break}
10711 @item @code{info line}
10712 @item @code{jump}
10713 @item @code{list}
10714 @end itemize
10715
10716 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
10717
10718 @smallexample
10719 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
10720 @end smallexample
10721
10722 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
10723 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
10724 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
10725 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
10726 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
10727 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
10728 debugged, enter:
10729
10730 @smallexample
10731 break -[Fruit create]
10732 @end smallexample
10733
10734 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
10735 enter:
10736
10737 @smallexample
10738 list +[NSText initialize]
10739 @end smallexample
10740
10741 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
10742 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
10743 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
10744 is also possible to specify just a method name:
10745
10746 @smallexample
10747 break create
10748 @end smallexample
10749
10750 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
10751 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
10752 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
10753 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
10754 none apply.
10755
10756 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
10757 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
10758
10759 @smallexample
10760 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
10761 @end smallexample
10762
10763 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
10764 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
10765 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
10766 @kindex print-object
10767 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
10768
10769 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
10770
10771 @smallexample
10772 print -[@var{object} hash]
10773 @end smallexample
10774
10775 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
10776 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
10777 @noindent
10778 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
10779 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
10780 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
10781 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
10782 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
10783 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
10784
10785 @node Fortran
10786 @subsection Fortran
10787 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
10788
10789 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
10790 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
10791
10792 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
10793 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
10794 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
10795 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
10796 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
10797 underscore.
10798
10799 @menu
10800 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
10801 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
10802 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
10803 @end menu
10804
10805 @node Fortran Operators
10806 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
10807
10808 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
10809
10810 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
10811 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
10812 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
10813
10814 @table @code
10815 @item **
10816 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
10817 of the second one.
10818
10819 @item :
10820 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
10821 represent a section of array.
10822
10823 @item %
10824 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
10825 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
10826 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
10827 union type.
10828 @end table
10829
10830 @node Fortran Defaults
10831 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
10832
10833 @cindex Fortran Defaults
10834
10835 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
10836 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
10837 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
10838 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
10839
10840 @node Special Fortran Commands
10841 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
10842
10843 @cindex Special Fortran commands
10844
10845 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
10846 such as displaying common blocks.
10847
10848 @table @code
10849 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
10850 @kindex info common
10851 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
10852 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
10853 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
10854 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
10855 printed.
10856 @end table
10857
10858 @node Pascal
10859 @subsection Pascal
10860
10861 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
10862 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
10863 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
10864 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
10865 syntax.
10866
10867 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
10868 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
10869 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
10870
10871 @node Modula-2
10872 @subsection Modula-2
10873
10874 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
10875
10876 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
10877 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
10878 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
10879 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
10880 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
10881 table.
10882
10883 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
10884 @menu
10885 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
10886 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
10887 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
10888 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
10889 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
10890 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
10891 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
10892 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10893 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10894 @end menu
10895
10896 @node M2 Operators
10897 @subsubsection Operators
10898 @cindex Modula-2 operators
10899
10900 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
10901 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
10902 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
10903 following definitions hold:
10904
10905 @itemize @bullet
10906
10907 @item
10908 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
10909 their subranges.
10910
10911 @item
10912 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
10913
10914 @item
10915 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
10916
10917 @item
10918 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
10919 @var{type}}.
10920
10921 @item
10922 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
10923
10924 @item
10925 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
10926
10927 @item
10928 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
10929 @end itemize
10930
10931 @noindent
10932 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
10933 increasing precedence:
10934
10935 @table @code
10936 @item ,
10937 Function argument or array index separator.
10938
10939 @item :=
10940 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
10941 @var{value}.
10942
10943 @item <@r{, }>
10944 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
10945 types.
10946
10947 @item <=@r{, }>=
10948 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
10949 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
10950 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
10951
10952 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
10953 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
10954 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
10955 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
10956 comment character.
10957
10958 @item IN
10959 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
10960 Same precedence as @code{<}.
10961
10962 @item OR
10963 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
10964
10965 @item AND@r{, }&
10966 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
10967
10968 @item @@
10969 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
10970
10971 @item +@r{, }-
10972 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
10973 and difference on set types.
10974
10975 @item *
10976 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
10977 on set types.
10978
10979 @item /
10980 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
10981 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
10982
10983 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
10984 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
10985 precedence as @code{*}.
10986
10987 @item -
10988 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
10989
10990 @item ^
10991 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
10992
10993 @item NOT
10994 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
10995 @code{^}.
10996
10997 @item .
10998 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
10999 precedence as @code{^}.
11000
11001 @item []
11002 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
11003
11004 @item ()
11005 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
11006 as @code{^}.
11007
11008 @item ::@r{, }.
11009 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
11010 @end table
11011
11012 @quotation
11013 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
11014 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
11015 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
11016 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
11017 @end quotation
11018
11019
11020 @node Built-In Func/Proc
11021 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
11022 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
11023
11024 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
11025 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
11026
11027 @table @var
11028
11029 @item a
11030 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
11031
11032 @item c
11033 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
11034
11035 @item i
11036 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
11037
11038 @item m
11039 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
11040 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
11041 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
11042
11043 @item n
11044 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
11045
11046 @item r
11047 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
11048
11049 @item t
11050 represents a type.
11051
11052 @item v
11053 represents a variable.
11054
11055 @item x
11056 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
11057 explanation of the function for details.
11058 @end table
11059
11060 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
11061
11062 @table @code
11063 @item ABS(@var{n})
11064 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
11065
11066 @item CAP(@var{c})
11067 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
11068 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
11069
11070 @item CHR(@var{i})
11071 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
11072
11073 @item DEC(@var{v})
11074 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
11075
11076 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
11077 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
11078 new value.
11079
11080 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
11081 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
11082 set.
11083
11084 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
11085 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
11086
11087 @item HIGH(@var{a})
11088 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
11089
11090 @item INC(@var{v})
11091 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
11092
11093 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
11094 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
11095 new value.
11096
11097 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
11098 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
11099 there. Returns the new set.
11100
11101 @item MAX(@var{t})
11102 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
11103
11104 @item MIN(@var{t})
11105 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
11106
11107 @item ODD(@var{i})
11108 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
11109
11110 @item ORD(@var{x})
11111 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
11112 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
11113 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
11114 integral, character and enumerated types.
11115
11116 @item SIZE(@var{x})
11117 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
11118
11119 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
11120 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
11121
11122 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
11123 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
11124
11125 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
11126 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
11127 @end table
11128
11129 @quotation
11130 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
11131 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
11132 an error.
11133 @end quotation
11134
11135 @cindex Modula-2 constants
11136 @node M2 Constants
11137 @subsubsection Constants
11138
11139 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
11140 ways:
11141
11142 @itemize @bullet
11143
11144 @item
11145 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
11146 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
11147 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
11148 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
11149
11150 @item
11151 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
11152 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
11153 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
11154 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
11155 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
11156 digits.
11157
11158 @item
11159 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
11160 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
11161 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
11162 followed by a @samp{C}.
11163
11164 @item
11165 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
11166 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
11167 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
11168 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
11169 sequences.
11170
11171 @item
11172 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
11173
11174 @item
11175 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
11176 @code{FALSE}.
11177
11178 @item
11179 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
11180
11181 @item
11182 Set constants are not yet supported.
11183 @end itemize
11184
11185 @node M2 Types
11186 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
11187 @cindex Modula-2 types
11188
11189 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
11190 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
11191 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
11192 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
11193 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
11194 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
11195
11196 The first example contains the following section of code:
11197
11198 @smallexample
11199 VAR
11200 s: SET OF CHAR ;
11201 r: [20..40] ;
11202 @end smallexample
11203
11204 @noindent
11205 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
11206 @code{r} and @code{s}.
11207
11208 @smallexample
11209 (@value{GDBP}) print s
11210 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
11211 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11212 SET OF CHAR
11213 (@value{GDBP}) print r
11214 21
11215 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
11216 [20..40]
11217 @end smallexample
11218
11219 @noindent
11220 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
11221
11222 @smallexample
11223 VAR
11224 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
11225 @end smallexample
11226
11227 @noindent
11228 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
11229
11230 @smallexample
11231 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11232 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
11233 @end smallexample
11234
11235 @noindent
11236 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
11237 expressions using the debugger.
11238
11239 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
11240 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
11241
11242 @smallexample
11243 VAR
11244 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
11245 @end smallexample
11246
11247 @smallexample
11248 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11249 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
11250 @end smallexample
11251
11252 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
11253 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
11254 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
11255 above.
11256
11257 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
11258
11259 @smallexample
11260 TYPE
11261 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
11262 t = [blue..yellow] ;
11263 VAR
11264 s: t ;
11265 BEGIN
11266 s := blue ;
11267 @end smallexample
11268
11269 @noindent
11270 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
11271 and value of a variable.
11272
11273 @smallexample
11274 (@value{GDBP}) print s
11275 $1 = blue
11276 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
11277 type = [blue..yellow]
11278 @end smallexample
11279
11280 @noindent
11281 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
11282 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
11283 their @code{C} counterparts.
11284
11285 @smallexample
11286 VAR
11287 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
11288 BEGIN
11289 s[1] := 1 ;
11290 @end smallexample
11291
11292 @smallexample
11293 (@value{GDBP}) print s
11294 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
11295 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11296 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
11297 @end smallexample
11298
11299 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
11300 pointer types as shown in this example:
11301
11302 @smallexample
11303 VAR
11304 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
11305 BEGIN
11306 NEW(s) ;
11307 s^[1] := 1 ;
11308 @end smallexample
11309
11310 @noindent
11311 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
11312
11313 @smallexample
11314 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11315 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
11316 @end smallexample
11317
11318 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
11319 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
11320 types:
11321
11322 @smallexample
11323 TYPE
11324 foo = RECORD
11325 f1: CARDINAL ;
11326 f2: CHAR ;
11327 f3: myarray ;
11328 END ;
11329
11330 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
11331 myrange = [-2..2] ;
11332 VAR
11333 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
11334 @end smallexample
11335
11336 @noindent
11337 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
11338 below.
11339
11340 @smallexample
11341 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11342 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
11343 f1 : CARDINAL;
11344 f2 : CHAR;
11345 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
11346 END
11347 @end smallexample
11348
11349 @node M2 Defaults
11350 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
11351 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
11352
11353 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
11354 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
11355 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
11356 selected the working language.
11357
11358 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
11359 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
11360 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
11361 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
11362
11363 @node Deviations
11364 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
11365 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
11366
11367 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
11368 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
11369
11370 @itemize @bullet
11371 @item
11372 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
11373 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
11374 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
11375 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
11376 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
11377 returned a pointer.)
11378
11379 @item
11380 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
11381 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
11382 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
11383 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
11384
11385 @item
11386 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
11387 argument.
11388
11389 @item
11390 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
11391 @end itemize
11392
11393 @node M2 Checks
11394 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
11395 @cindex Modula-2 checks
11396
11397 @quotation
11398 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
11399 range checking.
11400 @end quotation
11401 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
11402
11403 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
11404
11405 @itemize @bullet
11406 @item
11407 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
11408 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
11409
11410 @item
11411 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
11412 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
11413 @end itemize
11414
11415 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
11416 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
11417
11418 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
11419 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
11420
11421 @node M2 Scope
11422 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
11423 @cindex scope
11424 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
11425 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
11426 @ifinfo
11427 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
11428 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
11429 @end ifinfo
11430 @ifnotinfo
11431 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
11432 @end ifnotinfo
11433
11434 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
11435 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
11436 similar syntax:
11437
11438 @smallexample
11439
11440 @var{module} . @var{id}
11441 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
11442 @end smallexample
11443
11444 @noindent
11445 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
11446 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
11447 identifier within your program, except another module.
11448
11449 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
11450 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
11451 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
11452 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
11453
11454 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
11455 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
11456 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
11457 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
11458 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
11459 @var{module}.
11460
11461 @node GDB/M2
11462 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
11463
11464 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
11465 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
11466 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
11467 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
11468 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
11469 analogue in Modula-2.
11470
11471 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
11472 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
11473 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
11474 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
11475 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
11476 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
11477
11478 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
11479 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
11480 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
11481
11482 @node Ada
11483 @subsection Ada
11484 @cindex Ada
11485
11486 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
11487 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
11488 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
11489 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
11490 to be difficult.
11491
11492
11493 @cindex expressions in Ada
11494 @menu
11495 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
11496 and semantics supported by Ada mode
11497 in @value{GDBN}.
11498 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
11499 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
11500 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
11501 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
11502 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
11503 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
11504 @end menu
11505
11506 @node Ada Mode Intro
11507 @subsubsection Introduction
11508 @cindex Ada mode, general
11509
11510 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
11511 syntax, with some extensions.
11512 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
11513
11514 @itemize @bullet
11515 @item
11516 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
11517 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
11518 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
11519 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
11520
11521 @item
11522 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
11523 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
11524
11525 @item
11526 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
11527 @end itemize
11528
11529 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
11530 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
11531 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
11532 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
11533 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
11534
11535 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
11536 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
11537 was translated from an Ada source file.
11538
11539 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
11540 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
11541 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
11542 middle (to allow based literals).
11543
11544 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
11545 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
11546 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
11547 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
11548 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
11549 functions to procedures elsewhere.
11550
11551 @node Omissions from Ada
11552 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
11553 @cindex Ada, omissions from
11554
11555 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
11556
11557 @itemize @bullet
11558 @item
11559 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
11560
11561 @itemize @minus
11562 @item
11563 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
11564 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
11565
11566 @item
11567 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
11568
11569 @item
11570 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
11571
11572 @item
11573 @t{'Tag}.
11574
11575 @item
11576 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
11577 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
11578
11579 @item
11580 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
11581 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
11582
11583 @item
11584 @t{'Address}.
11585 @end itemize
11586
11587 @item
11588 The names in
11589 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
11590 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
11591 not currently available.
11592
11593 @item
11594 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
11595 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
11596 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
11597 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
11598 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
11599 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
11600 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
11601 indeterminate values.
11602
11603 @item
11604 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
11605 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
11606 are not implemented.
11607
11608 @item
11609 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
11610 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
11611 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
11612 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
11613 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
11614
11615 @smallexample
11616 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
11617 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
11618 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
11619 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
11620 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
11621 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
11622 @end smallexample
11623
11624 Changing a
11625 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
11626 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
11627 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
11628 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
11629 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
11630 declared to have a type such as:
11631
11632 @smallexample
11633 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
11634 Id : Integer;
11635 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
11636 end record;
11637 @end smallexample
11638
11639 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
11640 assignments:
11641
11642 @smallexample
11643 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
11644 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
11645 @end smallexample
11646
11647 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
11648 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
11649 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
11650 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
11651 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
11652 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
11653 redundant component associations, although which component values are
11654 assigned in such cases is not defined.
11655
11656 @item
11657 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
11658
11659 @item
11660 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
11661 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
11662 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
11663 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
11664 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
11665 the proper resolution.
11666
11667 @item
11668 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
11669
11670 @item
11671 Entry calls are not implemented.
11672
11673 @item
11674 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
11675 formats are not supported.
11676
11677 @item
11678 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
11679
11680 @item
11681 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
11682 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
11683 context.
11684 Should your program
11685 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
11686 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
11687 @end itemize
11688
11689 @node Additions to Ada
11690 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
11691 @cindex Ada, deviations from
11692
11693 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
11694 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
11695
11696 @itemize @bullet
11697 @item
11698 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
11699 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
11700 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
11701 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
11702 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
11703 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
11704 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
11705 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
11706
11707 @item
11708 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
11709 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
11710 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
11711
11712 @item
11713 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
11714 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
11715
11716 @item
11717 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
11718 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
11719 @end itemize
11720
11721 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
11722 additions specific to Ada:
11723
11724 @itemize @bullet
11725 @item
11726 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
11727 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
11728
11729 @smallexample
11730 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
11731 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
11732 @end smallexample
11733
11734 @item
11735 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
11736 the value of its right-hand operand.
11737 This allows, for example,
11738 complex conditional breaks:
11739
11740 @smallexample
11741 (@value{GDBP}) break f
11742 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
11743 @end smallexample
11744
11745 @item
11746 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
11747 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
11748 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
11749 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
11750 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
11751 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
11752 in strings. For example,
11753 @smallexample
11754 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
11755 @end smallexample
11756 @noindent
11757 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
11758 after each period.
11759
11760 @item
11761 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
11762 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
11763 to write
11764
11765 @smallexample
11766 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
11767 @end smallexample
11768
11769 @item
11770 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
11771 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
11772 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
11773 of 3 might print as
11774
11775 @smallexample
11776 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
11777 @end smallexample
11778
11779 @noindent
11780 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
11781 clause.
11782
11783 @item
11784 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
11785 multi-character subsequence of
11786 their names (an exact match gets preference).
11787 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
11788 in place of @t{a'length}.
11789
11790 @item
11791 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
11792 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
11793 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
11794 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
11795 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
11796 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
11797 For example,
11798 @smallexample
11799 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
11800 @end smallexample
11801
11802 @item
11803 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
11804 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
11805 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
11806 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
11807 object.
11808
11809 @end itemize
11810
11811 @node Stopping Before Main Program
11812 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
11813
11814 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
11815 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
11816 before reaching the main procedure.
11817 As defined in the Ada Reference
11818 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
11819 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
11820 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
11821 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
11822
11823 @node Ada Tasks
11824 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
11825 @cindex Ada, tasking
11826
11827 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
11828 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
11829
11830 @table @code
11831 @kindex info tasks
11832 @item info tasks
11833 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
11834
11835
11836 @smallexample
11837 @iftex
11838 @leftskip=0.5cm
11839 @end iftex
11840 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
11841 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
11842 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
11843 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
11844 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
11845 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
11846
11847 @end smallexample
11848
11849 @noindent
11850 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
11851 task currently being inspected.
11852
11853 @table @asis
11854 @item ID
11855 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
11856
11857 @item TID
11858 The Ada task ID.
11859
11860 @item P-ID
11861 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
11862
11863 @item Pri
11864 The base priority of the task.
11865
11866 @item State
11867 Current state of the task.
11868
11869 @table @code
11870 @item Unactivated
11871 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
11872 executing.
11873
11874 @item Runnable
11875 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
11876 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
11877
11878 @item Terminated
11879 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
11880 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
11881 terminated themselves.
11882
11883 @item Child Activation Wait
11884 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
11885
11886 @item Accept Statement
11887 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
11888
11889 @item Waiting on entry call
11890 The task is waiting on an entry call.
11891
11892 @item Async Select Wait
11893 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
11894 select statement.
11895
11896 @item Delay Sleep
11897 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
11898 alternative open.
11899
11900 @item Child Termination Wait
11901 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
11902 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
11903 waiting on a terminate Phase.
11904
11905 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
11906 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
11907 finish terminating.
11908
11909 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
11910 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
11911 @end table
11912
11913 @item Name
11914 Name of the task in the program.
11915
11916 @end table
11917
11918 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
11919 @item info task @var{taskno}
11920 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
11921 the following example:
11922 @smallexample
11923 @iftex
11924 @leftskip=0.5cm
11925 @end iftex
11926 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
11927 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
11928 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
11929 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
11930 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
11931 Ada Task: 0x807c468
11932 Name: task_1
11933 Thread: 0x807f378
11934 Parent: 1 (main_task)
11935 Base Priority: 15
11936 State: Runnable
11937 @end smallexample
11938
11939 @item task
11940 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
11941 @cindex current Ada task ID
11942 This command prints the ID of the current task.
11943
11944 @smallexample
11945 @iftex
11946 @leftskip=0.5cm
11947 @end iftex
11948 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
11949 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
11950 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
11951 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
11952 (@value{GDBP}) task
11953 [Current task is 2]
11954 @end smallexample
11955
11956 @item task @var{taskno}
11957 @cindex Ada task switching
11958 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
11959 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
11960 from the current task to the given task.
11961
11962 @smallexample
11963 @iftex
11964 @leftskip=0.5cm
11965 @end iftex
11966 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
11967 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
11968 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
11969 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
11970 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
11971 [Switching to task 1]
11972 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
11973 (@value{GDBP}) bt
11974 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
11975 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
11976 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
11977 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
11978 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
11979 @end smallexample
11980
11981 @item break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno}
11982 @itemx break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
11983 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
11984 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
11985 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
11986 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
11987 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}).
11988 @var{linespec} specifies source lines, as described
11989 in @ref{Specify Location}.
11990
11991 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
11992 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
11993 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. @var{taskno} is one of the
11994 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
11995 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
11996
11997 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
11998 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
11999 program.
12000
12001 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
12002 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
12003 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
12004
12005 For example,
12006
12007 @smallexample
12008 @iftex
12009 @leftskip=0.5cm
12010 @end iftex
12011 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
12012 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
12013 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
12014 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
12015 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
12016 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
12017 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
12018 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
12019 (@value{GDBP}) cont
12020 Continuing.
12021 task # 1 running
12022 task # 2 running
12023
12024 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
12025 15 flush;
12026 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
12027 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
12028 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
12029 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
12030 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
12031 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
12032 @end smallexample
12033 @end table
12034
12035 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
12036 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
12037 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
12038
12039 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
12040 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
12041 the platform being used.
12042 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
12043 switching is not supported. On Tru64, however, task switching will work
12044 as usual.
12045
12046 On certain platforms, including Tru64, the debugger needs to perform some
12047 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
12048 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
12049 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
12050 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
12051 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
12052
12053 @node Ada Glitches
12054 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
12055 @cindex Ada, problems
12056
12057 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
12058 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
12059 @value{GDBN},
12060 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
12061 and the GNU Ada compiler.
12062
12063 @itemize @bullet
12064 @item
12065 Currently, the debugger
12066 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
12067 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
12068 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
12069 to get it printed properly.
12070
12071 @item
12072 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
12073 storage are invisible to the debugger.
12074
12075 @item
12076 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
12077 argument lists are treated as positional).
12078
12079 @item
12080 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
12081
12082 @item
12083 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
12084 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
12085 the host machine.
12086
12087 @item
12088 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
12089 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
12090 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
12091 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
12092 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
12093 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
12094 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
12095 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
12096 you can usually resolve the confusion
12097 by qualifying the problematic names with package
12098 @code{Standard} explicitly.
12099 @end itemize
12100
12101 @node Unsupported Languages
12102 @section Unsupported Languages
12103
12104 @cindex unsupported languages
12105 @cindex minimal language
12106 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
12107 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
12108 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
12109 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
12110 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
12111 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
12112
12113 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
12114 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
12115 language.
12116
12117 @node Symbols
12118 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
12119
12120 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
12121 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
12122 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
12123 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
12124 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
12125 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
12126 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
12127
12128 @cindex symbol names
12129 @cindex names of symbols
12130 @cindex quoting names
12131 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
12132 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
12133 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
12134 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
12135 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
12136 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
12137 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
12138 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
12139
12140 @smallexample
12141 p 'foo.c'::x
12142 @end smallexample
12143
12144 @noindent
12145 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
12146
12147 @table @code
12148 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
12149 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
12150 @kindex set case-sensitive
12151 @item set case-sensitive on
12152 @itemx set case-sensitive off
12153 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
12154 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
12155 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
12156 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
12157 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
12158 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
12159 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
12160 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
12161 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
12162 case-insensitive matches.
12163
12164 @kindex show case-sensitive
12165 @item show case-sensitive
12166 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
12167 lookups.
12168
12169 @kindex info address
12170 @cindex address of a symbol
12171 @item info address @var{symbol}
12172 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
12173 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
12174 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
12175 is always stored.
12176
12177 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
12178 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
12179 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
12180
12181 @kindex info symbol
12182 @cindex symbol from address
12183 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
12184 @item info symbol @var{addr}
12185 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
12186 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
12187 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
12188
12189 @smallexample
12190 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
12191 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
12192 @end smallexample
12193
12194 @noindent
12195 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
12196 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
12197
12198 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
12199 library containing the symbol is also printed:
12200
12201 @smallexample
12202 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
12203 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
12204 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
12205 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
12206 @end smallexample
12207
12208 @kindex whatis
12209 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
12210 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
12211 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
12212 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
12213 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
12214 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
12215 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
12216 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
12217 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
12218 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
12219 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
12220
12221 @kindex ptype
12222 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
12223 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
12224 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
12225 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
12226
12227 For example, for this variable declaration:
12228
12229 @smallexample
12230 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
12231 @end smallexample
12232
12233 @noindent
12234 the two commands give this output:
12235
12236 @smallexample
12237 @group
12238 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
12239 type = struct complex
12240 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
12241 type = struct complex @{
12242 double real;
12243 double imag;
12244 @}
12245 @end group
12246 @end smallexample
12247
12248 @noindent
12249 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
12250 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
12251
12252 @cindex incomplete type
12253 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
12254 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
12255 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
12256 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
12257 given these declarations:
12258
12259 @smallexample
12260 struct foo;
12261 struct foo *fooptr;
12262 @end smallexample
12263
12264 @noindent
12265 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
12266
12267 @smallexample
12268 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
12269 $1 = <incomplete type>
12270 @end smallexample
12271
12272 @noindent
12273 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
12274 completely specified.
12275
12276 @kindex info types
12277 @item info types @var{regexp}
12278 @itemx info types
12279 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
12280 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
12281 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
12282 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
12283 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
12284 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
12285 name is @code{value}.
12286
12287 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
12288 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
12289 lists all source files where a type is defined.
12290
12291 @kindex info scope
12292 @cindex local variables
12293 @item info scope @var{location}
12294 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
12295 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
12296 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
12297 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
12298 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
12299
12300 @smallexample
12301 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
12302 Scope for command_line_handler:
12303 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
12304 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
12305 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
12306 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
12307 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
12308 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
12309 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
12310 @end smallexample
12311
12312 @noindent
12313 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
12314 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
12315 collect}.
12316
12317 @kindex info source
12318 @item info source
12319 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
12320 the function containing the current point of execution:
12321 @itemize @bullet
12322 @item
12323 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
12324 @item
12325 the directory it was compiled in,
12326 @item
12327 its length, in lines,
12328 @item
12329 which programming language it is written in,
12330 @item
12331 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
12332 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
12333 @item
12334 whether the debugging information includes information about
12335 preprocessor macros.
12336 @end itemize
12337
12338
12339 @kindex info sources
12340 @item info sources
12341 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
12342 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
12343 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
12344
12345 @kindex info functions
12346 @item info functions
12347 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
12348
12349 @item info functions @var{regexp}
12350 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
12351 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
12352 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
12353 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
12354 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
12355 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
12356 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
12357
12358 @kindex info variables
12359 @item info variables
12360 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
12361 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
12362
12363 @item info variables @var{regexp}
12364 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
12365 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
12366 @var{regexp}.
12367
12368 @kindex info classes
12369 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
12370 @item info classes
12371 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
12372 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
12373 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
12374 expression.
12375
12376 @kindex info selectors
12377 @item info selectors
12378 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
12379 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
12380 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
12381 expression.
12382
12383 @ignore
12384 This was never implemented.
12385 @kindex info methods
12386 @item info methods
12387 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
12388 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
12389 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
12390 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
12391 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
12392 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
12393 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
12394 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
12395 @end ignore
12396
12397 @cindex reloading symbols
12398 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
12399 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
12400 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
12401 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
12402 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
12403
12404 @table @code
12405 @kindex set symbol-reloading
12406 @item set symbol-reloading on
12407 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
12408 object file with a particular name is seen again.
12409
12410 @item set symbol-reloading off
12411 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
12412 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
12413 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
12414 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
12415 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
12416 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
12417 name.
12418
12419 @kindex show symbol-reloading
12420 @item show symbol-reloading
12421 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
12422 @end table
12423
12424 @cindex opaque data types
12425 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
12426 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
12427 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
12428 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
12429 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
12430 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
12431 another source file. The default is on.
12432
12433 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
12434 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
12435
12436 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
12437 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
12438 is printed as follows:
12439 @smallexample
12440 @{<no data fields>@}
12441 @end smallexample
12442
12443 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
12444 @item show opaque-type-resolution
12445 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
12446
12447 @kindex set print symbol-loading
12448 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
12449 @item set print symbol-loading
12450 @itemx set print symbol-loading on
12451 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
12452 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to enable or
12453 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbols.
12454 By default, these messages will be printed, and normally this is what
12455 you want. Disabling these messages is useful when debugging applications
12456 with lots of shared libraries where the quantity of output can be more
12457 annoying than useful.
12458
12459 @kindex show print symbol-loading
12460 @item show print symbol-loading
12461 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} loads symbols.
12462
12463 @kindex maint print symbols
12464 @cindex symbol dump
12465 @kindex maint print psymbols
12466 @cindex partial symbol dump
12467 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
12468 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
12469 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
12470 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
12471 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
12472 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
12473 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
12474 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
12475 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
12476 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
12477 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
12478 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
12479 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
12480 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
12481 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
12482 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
12483 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
12484
12485 @kindex maint info symtabs
12486 @kindex maint info psymtabs
12487 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
12488 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
12489 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
12490 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
12491 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
12492 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
12493
12494 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
12495 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
12496 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
12497 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
12498 structure in more detail. For example:
12499
12500 @smallexample
12501 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
12502 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
12503 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
12504 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
12505 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
12506 readin no
12507 fullname (null)
12508 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
12509 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
12510 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
12511 dependencies (none)
12512 @}
12513 @}
12514 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
12515 (@value{GDBP})
12516 @end smallexample
12517 @noindent
12518 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
12519 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
12520 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
12521 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
12522 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
12523
12524 @smallexample
12525 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
12526 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
12527 line 1574.
12528 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
12529 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
12530 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
12531 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
12532 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
12533 dirname (null)
12534 fullname (null)
12535 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
12536 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
12537 debugformat DWARF 2
12538 @}
12539 @}
12540 (@value{GDBP})
12541 @end smallexample
12542 @end table
12543
12544
12545 @node Altering
12546 @chapter Altering Execution
12547
12548 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
12549 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
12550 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
12551 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
12552 program.
12553
12554 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
12555 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
12556 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
12557
12558 @menu
12559 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
12560 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
12561 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
12562 * Returning:: Returning from a function
12563 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
12564 * Patching:: Patching your program
12565 @end menu
12566
12567 @node Assignment
12568 @section Assignment to Variables
12569
12570 @cindex assignment
12571 @cindex setting variables
12572 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
12573 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
12574
12575 @smallexample
12576 print x=4
12577 @end smallexample
12578
12579 @noindent
12580 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
12581 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
12582 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
12583 information on operators in supported languages.
12584
12585 @kindex set variable
12586 @cindex variables, setting
12587 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
12588 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
12589 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
12590 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
12591 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
12592
12593 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
12594 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
12595 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
12596 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
12597 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
12598 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
12599 command @code{set width}:
12600
12601 @smallexample
12602 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
12603 type = double
12604 (@value{GDBP}) p width
12605 $4 = 13
12606 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
12607 Invalid syntax in expression.
12608 @end smallexample
12609
12610 @noindent
12611 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
12612 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
12613
12614 @smallexample
12615 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
12616 @end smallexample
12617
12618 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
12619 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
12620 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
12621 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
12622 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
12623 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
12624
12625 @smallexample
12626 @group
12627 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
12628 type = double
12629 (@value{GDBP}) p g
12630 $1 = 1
12631 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
12632 (@value{GDBP}) p g
12633 $2 = 1
12634 (@value{GDBP}) r
12635 The program being debugged has been started already.
12636 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
12637 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
12638 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
12639 Invalid bfd target.
12640 (@value{GDBP}) show g
12641 The current BFD target is "=4".
12642 @end group
12643 @end smallexample
12644
12645 @noindent
12646 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
12647 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
12648 @code{g}, use
12649
12650 @smallexample
12651 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
12652 @end smallexample
12653
12654 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
12655 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
12656 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
12657 same length or shorter.
12658 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
12659 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
12660
12661 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
12662 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
12663 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
12664 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
12665 and representation in memory), and
12666
12667 @smallexample
12668 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
12669 @end smallexample
12670
12671 @noindent
12672 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
12673
12674 @node Jumping
12675 @section Continuing at a Different Address
12676
12677 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
12678 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
12679 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
12680
12681 @table @code
12682 @kindex jump
12683 @item jump @var{linespec}
12684 @itemx jump @var{location}
12685 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
12686 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
12687 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
12688 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
12689 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
12690 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
12691
12692 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
12693 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
12694 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
12695 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
12696 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
12697 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
12698 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
12699 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
12700 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
12701 @end table
12702
12703 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
12704 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
12705 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
12706 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
12707 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
12708 example,
12709
12710 @smallexample
12711 set $pc = 0x485
12712 @end smallexample
12713
12714 @noindent
12715 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
12716 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
12717 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
12718
12719 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
12720 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
12721 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
12722 detail.
12723
12724 @c @group
12725 @node Signaling
12726 @section Giving your Program a Signal
12727 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
12728
12729 @table @code
12730 @kindex signal
12731 @item signal @var{signal}
12732 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
12733 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
12734 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
12735 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
12736
12737 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
12738 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
12739 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
12740 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
12741 signal.
12742
12743 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
12744 after executing the command.
12745 @end table
12746 @c @end group
12747
12748 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
12749 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
12750 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
12751 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
12752 passes the signal directly to your program.
12753
12754
12755 @node Returning
12756 @section Returning from a Function
12757
12758 @table @code
12759 @cindex returning from a function
12760 @kindex return
12761 @item return
12762 @itemx return @var{expression}
12763 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
12764 command. If you give an
12765 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
12766 value.
12767 @end table
12768
12769 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
12770 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
12771 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
12772 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
12773
12774 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
12775 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
12776 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
12777 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
12778 of functions.
12779
12780 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
12781 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
12782 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
12783 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
12784 selected stack frame returns naturally.
12785
12786 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
12787 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
12788 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
12789 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
12790 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
12791 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
12792 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
12793 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
12794 assignment into the right register(s).
12795
12796 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
12797 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
12798 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
12799 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
12800 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
12801 into a @code{long long int}:
12802
12803 @smallexample
12804 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
12805 29 return 31;
12806 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
12807 Make func return now? (y or n) y
12808 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
12809 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
12810 (@value{GDBP})
12811 @end smallexample
12812
12813 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
12814 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
12815 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
12816 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
12817 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
12818 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
12819 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
12820 an appropriate cast explicitly:
12821
12822 @smallexample
12823 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
12824 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
12825 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
12826 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
12827 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
12828 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
12829 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
12830 (@value{GDBP})
12831 @end smallexample
12832
12833 @node Calling
12834 @section Calling Program Functions
12835
12836 @table @code
12837 @cindex calling functions
12838 @cindex inferior functions, calling
12839 @item print @var{expr}
12840 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
12841 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
12842 debugged.
12843
12844 @kindex call
12845 @item call @var{expr}
12846 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
12847 returned values.
12848
12849 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
12850 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
12851 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
12852 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
12853 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
12854 value history.
12855 @end table
12856
12857 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
12858 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
12859 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
12860 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
12861
12862 @table @code
12863 @item set unwindonsignal
12864 @kindex set unwindonsignal
12865 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
12866 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
12867 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
12868 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
12869 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
12870 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
12871 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
12872 received.
12873
12874 @item show unwindonsignal
12875 @kindex show unwindonsignal
12876 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
12877 @value{GDBN}.
12878 @end table
12879
12880 @cindex weak alias functions
12881 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
12882 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
12883 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
12884 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
12885 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
12886 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
12887 function instead.
12888
12889 @node Patching
12890 @section Patching Programs
12891
12892 @cindex patching binaries
12893 @cindex writing into executables
12894 @cindex writing into corefiles
12895
12896 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
12897 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
12898 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
12899 patching your program's binary.
12900
12901 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
12902 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
12903 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
12904 repairs.
12905
12906 @table @code
12907 @kindex set write
12908 @item set write on
12909 @itemx set write off
12910 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
12911 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
12912 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
12913
12914 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
12915 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
12916 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
12917
12918 @item show write
12919 @kindex show write
12920 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
12921 as well as reading.
12922 @end table
12923
12924 @node GDB Files
12925 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
12926
12927 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
12928 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
12929 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
12930 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
12931
12932 @menu
12933 * Files:: Commands to specify files
12934 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
12935 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
12936 * Data Files:: GDB data files
12937 @end menu
12938
12939 @node Files
12940 @section Commands to Specify Files
12941
12942 @cindex symbol table
12943 @cindex core dump file
12944
12945 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
12946 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
12947 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
12948 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
12949
12950 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
12951 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
12952 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
12953 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
12954 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
12955 new files are useful.
12956
12957 @table @code
12958 @cindex executable file
12959 @kindex file
12960 @item file @var{filename}
12961 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
12962 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
12963 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
12964 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
12965 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
12966 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
12967 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
12968 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
12969
12970 @cindex unlinked object files
12971 @cindex patching object files
12972 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
12973 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
12974 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
12975 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
12976 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
12977 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
12978 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
12979 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
12980
12981 @item file
12982 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
12983 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
12984
12985 @kindex exec-file
12986 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
12987 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
12988 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
12989 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
12990 discard information on the executable file.
12991
12992 @kindex symbol-file
12993 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
12994 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
12995 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
12996 table and program to run from the same file.
12997
12998 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
12999 program's symbol table.
13000
13001 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
13002 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
13003 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
13004 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
13005 @value{GDBN}.
13006
13007 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
13008 executing it once.
13009
13010 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
13011 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
13012 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
13013 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
13014 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
13015 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
13016 optimized code.
13017
13018 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
13019 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
13020 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
13021 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
13022 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
13023
13024 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
13025 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
13026 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
13027 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
13028 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
13029 Warnings and Messages}.)
13030
13031 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
13032 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
13033 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
13034 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
13035 in stabs format.
13036
13037 @kindex readnow
13038 @cindex reading symbols immediately
13039 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
13040 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
13041 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
13042 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
13043 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
13044 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
13045 entire symbol table available.
13046
13047 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
13048 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
13049 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
13050 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
13051 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
13052 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
13053 @c files.
13054
13055 @kindex core-file
13056 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
13057 @itemx core
13058 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
13059 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
13060 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
13061 executable file itself for other parts.
13062
13063 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
13064 to be used.
13065
13066 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
13067 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
13068 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
13069 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
13070 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
13071
13072 @kindex add-symbol-file
13073 @cindex dynamic linking
13074 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
13075 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
13076 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
13077 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
13078 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
13079 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
13080 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
13081 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
13082 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
13083 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
13084 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
13085 @var{address} as an expression.
13086
13087 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
13088 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
13089 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
13090 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
13091 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
13092
13093 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
13094 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
13095 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
13096 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
13097 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
13098 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
13099 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
13100 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
13101 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
13102
13103 @itemize @bullet
13104 @item
13105 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
13106 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
13107 @item
13108 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
13109 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
13110 @item
13111 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
13112 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
13113 @end itemize
13114
13115 @noindent
13116 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
13117 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
13118 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
13119 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
13120 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
13121 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
13122 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
13123 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
13124 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
13125 way.
13126
13127 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
13128
13129 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
13130 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
13131 @cindex load symbols from memory
13132 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
13133 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
13134 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
13135 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
13136 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
13137 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
13138 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
13139 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
13140 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
13141
13142 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
13143 @kindex assf
13144 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
13145 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
13146 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
13147 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
13148 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
13149 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
13150 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
13151 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
13152 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
13153 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
13154
13155 @kindex section
13156 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
13157 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
13158 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
13159 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
13160 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
13161 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
13162 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
13163 their addresses.
13164
13165 @kindex info files
13166 @kindex info target
13167 @item info files
13168 @itemx info target
13169 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
13170 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
13171 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
13172 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
13173 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
13174 current ones.
13175
13176 @kindex maint info sections
13177 @item maint info sections
13178 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
13179 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
13180 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
13181 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
13182 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
13183 may be arbitrarily combined):
13184
13185 @table @code
13186 @item ALLOBJ
13187 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
13188 @item @var{sections}
13189 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
13190 @item @var{section-flags}
13191 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
13192 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
13193 @table @code
13194 @item ALLOC
13195 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
13196 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
13197 @item LOAD
13198 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
13199 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
13200 @item RELOC
13201 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
13202 @item READONLY
13203 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
13204 @item CODE
13205 Section contains executable code only.
13206 @item DATA
13207 Section contains data only (no executable code).
13208 @item ROM
13209 Section will reside in ROM.
13210 @item CONSTRUCTOR
13211 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
13212 @item HAS_CONTENTS
13213 Section is not empty.
13214 @item NEVER_LOAD
13215 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
13216 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
13217 A notification to the linker that the section contains
13218 COFF shared library information.
13219 @item IS_COMMON
13220 Section contains common symbols.
13221 @end table
13222 @end table
13223 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
13224 @cindex read-only sections
13225 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
13226 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
13227 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
13228 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
13229 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
13230 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
13231 enhancement to debugging performance.
13232
13233 The default is off.
13234
13235 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
13236 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
13237 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
13238 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
13239
13240 @item show trust-readonly-sections
13241 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
13242 @end table
13243
13244 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
13245 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
13246 name and remembers it that way.
13247
13248 @cindex shared libraries
13249 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
13250 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
13251 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
13252
13253 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
13254 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
13255
13256 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
13257 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
13258 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
13259 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
13260 debugging a core file).
13261
13262 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
13263 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
13264
13265 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
13266 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
13267 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
13268
13269 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
13270 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
13271 particularly large or there are many of them.
13272
13273 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
13274 commands:
13275
13276 @table @code
13277 @kindex set auto-solib-add
13278 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
13279 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
13280 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
13281 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
13282 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
13283 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
13284 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
13285
13286 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
13287 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
13288 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
13289 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
13290 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
13291 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
13292 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
13293 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
13294 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
13295
13296 @kindex show auto-solib-add
13297 @item show auto-solib-add
13298 Display the current autoloading mode.
13299 @end table
13300
13301 @cindex load shared library
13302 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
13303 command:
13304
13305 @table @code
13306 @kindex info sharedlibrary
13307 @kindex info share
13308 @item info share
13309 @itemx info sharedlibrary
13310 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
13311
13312 @kindex sharedlibrary
13313 @kindex share
13314 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
13315 @itemx share @var{regex}
13316 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
13317 Unix regular expression.
13318 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
13319 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
13320 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
13321 loaded.
13322
13323 @item nosharedlibrary
13324 @kindex nosharedlibrary
13325 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
13326 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
13327 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
13328 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
13329 discarded.
13330 @end table
13331
13332 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
13333 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
13334 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
13335
13336 @table @code
13337 @item set stop-on-solib-events
13338 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
13339 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
13340 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
13341 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
13342 shared library.
13343
13344 @item show stop-on-solib-events
13345 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
13346 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
13347 library events happen.
13348 @end table
13349
13350 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
13351 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
13352 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
13353 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
13354 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
13355 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
13356 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
13357 not.
13358
13359 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
13360 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
13361 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
13362 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
13363 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
13364
13365 @table @code
13366 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
13367 @cindex system root, alternate
13368 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
13369 @kindex set sysroot
13370 @item set sysroot @var{path}
13371 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
13372 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
13373 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
13374 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
13375 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
13376 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
13377 under @var{path}.
13378
13379 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{remote:}, @value{GDBN} will
13380 retrieve the target libraries from the remote system. This is only
13381 supported when using a remote target that supports the @code{remote get}
13382 command (@pxref{File Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}).
13383 The part of @var{path} following the initial @file{remote:}
13384 (if present) is used as system root prefix on the remote file system.
13385 @footnote{If you want to specify a local system root using a directory
13386 that happens to be named @file{remote:}, you need to use some equivalent
13387 variant of the name like @file{./remote:}.}
13388
13389 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
13390 sysroot}.
13391
13392 @cindex default system root
13393 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
13394 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
13395 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
13396 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
13397 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
13398 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
13399 location.
13400
13401 @kindex show sysroot
13402 @item show sysroot
13403 Display the current shared library prefix.
13404
13405 @kindex set solib-search-path
13406 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
13407 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
13408 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
13409 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
13410 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
13411 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
13412 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
13413 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
13414 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
13415 of shared library symbols.
13416
13417 @kindex show solib-search-path
13418 @item show solib-search-path
13419 Display the current shared library search path.
13420 @end table
13421
13422
13423 @node Separate Debug Files
13424 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
13425 @cindex separate debugging information files
13426 @cindex debugging information in separate files
13427 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
13428 @cindex debugging information directory, global
13429 @cindex global debugging information directory
13430 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
13431 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
13432
13433 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
13434 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
13435 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
13436 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
13437 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
13438 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
13439 install only when they need to debug a problem.
13440
13441 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
13442 file:
13443
13444 @itemize @bullet
13445 @item
13446 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
13447 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
13448 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
13449 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
13450 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
13451 debug link specifies a CRC32 checksum for the debug file, which
13452 @value{GDBN} uses to validate that the executable and the debug file
13453 came from the same build.
13454
13455 @item
13456 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
13457 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
13458 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
13459 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
13460 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
13461 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
13462 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
13463 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
13464 below.
13465 @end itemize
13466
13467 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
13468 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
13469
13470 @itemize @bullet
13471 @item
13472 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
13473 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
13474 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under the global debug
13475 directory, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
13476 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
13477
13478 @item
13479 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
13480 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of the global debug directory for a file
13481 named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
13482 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
13483 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
13484 hex characters, not 10.)
13485 @end itemize
13486
13487 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
13488 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
13489 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
13490 @code{abcdef1234}. If the global debug directory is
13491 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
13492 debug information files, in the indicated order:
13493
13494 @itemize @minus
13495 @item
13496 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
13497 @item
13498 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
13499 @item
13500 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
13501 @item
13502 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
13503 @end itemize
13504
13505 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
13506 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
13507
13508 @table @code
13509
13510 @kindex set debug-file-directory
13511 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
13512 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
13513 information files to @var{directory}.
13514
13515 @kindex show debug-file-directory
13516 @item show debug-file-directory
13517 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
13518 information files.
13519
13520 @end table
13521
13522 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
13523 @cindex debug link sections
13524 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
13525 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
13526
13527 @itemize
13528 @item
13529 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
13530 a zero byte,
13531 @item
13532 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
13533 boundary within the section, and
13534 @item
13535 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
13536 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
13537 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
13538 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
13539 @end itemize
13540
13541 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
13542 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
13543 described above.
13544
13545 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
13546 @cindex build ID sections
13547 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
13548 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
13549 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
13550 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
13551 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
13552 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
13553 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
13554 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
13555 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
13556
13557 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
13558 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
13559 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
13560 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
13561 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
13562 in an ordinary executable.
13563
13564 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
13565 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
13566 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
13567 following commands:
13568
13569 @smallexample
13570 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
13571 @kbd{strip -g foo}
13572 @end smallexample
13573
13574 @noindent
13575 These commands remove the debugging
13576 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
13577 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
13578 two files:
13579
13580 @itemize @bullet
13581 @item
13582 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
13583 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
13584
13585 @smallexample
13586 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
13587 @end smallexample
13588
13589 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
13590 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
13591 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
13592 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
13593
13594 @item
13595 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
13596 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
13597 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
13598 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
13599 @end itemize
13600
13601 @noindent
13602
13603 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's for the debug
13604 link (different polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the
13605 simplest way to describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}
13606 sections is to give the complete code for a function that computes it:
13607
13608 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
13609 @smallexample
13610 unsigned long
13611 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
13612 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
13613 @{
13614 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
13615 @{
13616 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
13617 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
13618 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
13619 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
13620 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
13621 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
13622 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
13623 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
13624 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
13625 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
13626 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
13627 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
13628 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
13629 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
13630 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
13631 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
13632 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
13633 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
13634 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
13635 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
13636 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
13637 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
13638 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
13639 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
13640 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
13641 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
13642 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
13643 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
13644 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
13645 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
13646 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
13647 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
13648 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
13649 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
13650 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
13651 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
13652 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
13653 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
13654 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
13655 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
13656 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
13657 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
13658 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
13659 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
13660 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
13661 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
13662 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
13663 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
13664 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
13665 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
13666 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
13667 0x2d02ef8d
13668 @};
13669 unsigned char *end;
13670
13671 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
13672 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
13673 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
13674 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
13675 @}
13676 @end smallexample
13677
13678 @noindent
13679 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
13680
13681
13682 @node Symbol Errors
13683 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
13684
13685 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
13686 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
13687 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
13688 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
13689 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
13690 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
13691 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
13692 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
13693 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
13694 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
13695 Messages}).
13696
13697 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
13698
13699 @table @code
13700 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
13701
13702 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
13703 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
13704 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
13705 in its outer scope blocks.
13706
13707 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
13708 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
13709 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
13710 function.
13711
13712 @item block at @var{address} out of order
13713
13714 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
13715 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
13716 do so.
13717
13718 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
13719 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
13720 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
13721 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
13722 Messages}.)
13723
13724 @item bad block start address patched
13725
13726 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
13727 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
13728 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
13729
13730 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
13731 starting on the previous source line.
13732
13733 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
13734
13735 @cindex foo
13736 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
13737 larger than the size of the string table.
13738
13739 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
13740 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
13741 with this name.
13742
13743 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
13744
13745 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
13746 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
13747 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
13748
13749 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
13750 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
13751 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
13752 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
13753 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
13754 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
13755
13756 @item stub type has NULL name
13757
13758 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
13759
13760 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
13761 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
13762 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
13763 it.
13764
13765 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
13766
13767 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
13768
13769 @end table
13770
13771 @node Data Files
13772 @section GDB Data Files
13773
13774 @cindex prefix for data files
13775 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
13776 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
13777
13778 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
13779 is currently using.
13780
13781 @table @code
13782 @kindex set data-directory
13783 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
13784 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
13785 to @var{directory}.
13786
13787 @kindex show data-directory
13788 @item show data-directory
13789 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
13790 @end table
13791
13792 @cindex default data directory
13793 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
13794 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
13795 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
13796 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
13797 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
13798 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
13799 location.
13800
13801 @node Targets
13802 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
13803
13804 @cindex debugging target
13805 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
13806
13807 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
13808 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
13809 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
13810 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
13811 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
13812 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
13813 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
13814 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
13815
13816 @cindex target architecture
13817 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
13818 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
13819 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
13820 command.
13821
13822 @table @code
13823 @kindex set architecture
13824 @kindex show architecture
13825 @item set architecture @var{arch}
13826 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
13827 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
13828 supported architectures.
13829
13830 @item show architecture
13831 Show the current target architecture.
13832
13833 @item set processor
13834 @itemx processor
13835 @kindex set processor
13836 @kindex show processor
13837 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
13838 and @code{show architecture}.
13839 @end table
13840
13841 @menu
13842 * Active Targets:: Active targets
13843 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
13844 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
13845 @end menu
13846
13847 @node Active Targets
13848 @section Active Targets
13849
13850 @cindex stacking targets
13851 @cindex active targets
13852 @cindex multiple targets
13853
13854 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
13855 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
13856 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
13857 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
13858 a core file.
13859
13860 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
13861 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
13862 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
13863 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
13864 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
13865 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
13866 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
13867 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
13868 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
13869
13870 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
13871 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
13872 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
13873 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
13874 process target is active.
13875
13876 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
13877 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify
13878 Files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
13879 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
13880 Process}).
13881
13882 @node Target Commands
13883 @section Commands for Managing Targets
13884
13885 @table @code
13886 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
13887 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
13888 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
13889 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
13890 protocol of the target machine.
13891
13892 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
13893 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
13894 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
13895
13896 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
13897 after executing the command.
13898
13899 @kindex help target
13900 @item help target
13901 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
13902 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
13903 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
13904
13905 @item help target @var{name}
13906 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
13907 select it.
13908
13909 @kindex set gnutarget
13910 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
13911 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
13912 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
13913 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
13914 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
13915 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
13916
13917 @quotation
13918 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
13919 you must know the actual BFD name.
13920 @end quotation
13921
13922 @noindent
13923 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
13924
13925 @kindex show gnutarget
13926 @item show gnutarget
13927 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
13928 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
13929 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
13930 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
13931 @end table
13932
13933 @cindex common targets
13934 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
13935 configuration):
13936
13937 @table @code
13938 @kindex target
13939 @item target exec @var{program}
13940 @cindex executable file target
13941 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
13942 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
13943
13944 @item target core @var{filename}
13945 @cindex core dump file target
13946 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
13947 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
13948
13949 @item target remote @var{medium}
13950 @cindex remote target
13951 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
13952 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
13953 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
13954
13955 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
13956 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
13957
13958 @smallexample
13959 target remote /dev/ttya
13960 @end smallexample
13961
13962 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
13963 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
13964 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
13965 clobbered by the download.
13966
13967 @item target sim
13968 @cindex built-in simulator target
13969 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
13970 In general,
13971 @smallexample
13972 target sim
13973 load
13974 run
13975 @end smallexample
13976 @noindent
13977 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
13978 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
13979 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
13980 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
13981 Processors}.
13982
13983 @end table
13984
13985 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
13986
13987 @table @code
13988
13989 @item target nrom @var{dev}
13990 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
13991 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
13992
13993 @end table
13994
13995 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
13996 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
13997
13998 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
13999 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
14000 various aspects of this process.
14001
14002 @table @code
14003
14004 @item set hash
14005 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
14006 @cindex hash mark while downloading
14007 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
14008 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
14009 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
14010 monitor.
14011
14012 @item show hash
14013 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
14014 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
14015
14016 @item set debug monitor
14017 @kindex set debug monitor
14018 @cindex display remote monitor communications
14019 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
14020 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
14021
14022 @item show debug monitor
14023 @kindex show debug monitor
14024 Show the current status of displaying communications between
14025 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
14026 @end table
14027
14028 @table @code
14029
14030 @kindex load @var{filename}
14031 @item load @var{filename}
14032 @anchor{load}
14033 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
14034 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
14035 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
14036 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
14037 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
14038 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
14039
14040 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
14041 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
14042 target is @dots{}}''
14043
14044 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
14045 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
14046 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
14047 specifies a fixed address.
14048 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
14049
14050 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
14051 load programs into flash memory.
14052
14053 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
14054 @end table
14055
14056 @node Byte Order
14057 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
14058
14059 @cindex choosing target byte order
14060 @cindex target byte order
14061
14062 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
14063 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
14064 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
14065 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
14066 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
14067 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
14068
14069 @table @code
14070 @kindex set endian
14071 @item set endian big
14072 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
14073
14074 @item set endian little
14075 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
14076
14077 @item set endian auto
14078 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
14079 executable.
14080
14081 @item show endian
14082 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
14083
14084 @end table
14085
14086 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
14087 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
14088 target system.
14089
14090
14091 @node Remote Debugging
14092 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
14093 @cindex remote debugging
14094
14095 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
14096 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
14097 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
14098 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
14099 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
14100
14101 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
14102 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
14103 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
14104 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
14105 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
14106 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
14107
14108 Other remote targets may be available in your
14109 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
14110
14111 @menu
14112 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
14113 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
14114 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
14115 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
14116 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
14117 @end menu
14118
14119 @node Connecting
14120 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
14121
14122 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
14123 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
14124 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
14125 program as the first argument.
14126
14127 @cindex @code{target remote}
14128 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
14129 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
14130 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
14131 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
14132 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
14133 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
14134
14135 @table @code
14136
14137 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
14138 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
14139 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
14140 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
14141
14142 @smallexample
14143 target remote /dev/ttyb
14144 @end smallexample
14145
14146 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
14147 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
14148 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
14149 @code{target} command.
14150
14151 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
14152 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
14153 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
14154 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
14155 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
14156 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
14157 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
14158 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
14159 target.
14160
14161 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
14162 @code{manyfarms}:
14163
14164 @smallexample
14165 target remote manyfarms:2828
14166 @end smallexample
14167
14168 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
14169 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
14170 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
14171 port 1234 on your local machine:
14172
14173 @smallexample
14174 target remote :1234
14175 @end smallexample
14176 @noindent
14177
14178 Note that the colon is still required here.
14179
14180 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
14181 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
14182 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
14183 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
14184
14185 @smallexample
14186 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
14187 @end smallexample
14188
14189 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
14190 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
14191 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
14192 cause havoc with your debugging session.
14193
14194 @item target remote | @var{command}
14195 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
14196 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
14197 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
14198 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
14199 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
14200 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
14201 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
14202 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
14203
14204 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
14205 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
14206 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
14207
14208 @end table
14209
14210 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
14211 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
14212 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
14213 need to use @kbd{run}.
14214
14215 @cindex interrupting remote programs
14216 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
14217 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
14218 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
14219 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
14220 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
14221 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
14222
14223 @smallexample
14224 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
14225 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
14226 @end smallexample
14227
14228 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
14229 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
14230 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
14231 goes back to waiting.
14232
14233 @table @code
14234 @kindex detach (remote)
14235 @item detach
14236 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
14237 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
14238 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
14239 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
14240 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
14241
14242 @kindex disconnect
14243 @item disconnect
14244 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
14245 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
14246 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
14247 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
14248 another target.
14249
14250 @cindex send command to remote monitor
14251 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
14252 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
14253 @kindex monitor
14254 @item monitor @var{cmd}
14255 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
14256 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
14257 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
14258 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
14259 and implement.
14260 @end table
14261
14262 @node File Transfer
14263 @section Sending files to a remote system
14264 @cindex remote target, file transfer
14265 @cindex file transfer
14266 @cindex sending files to remote systems
14267
14268 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
14269 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
14270 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
14271 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
14272 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
14273 the only way to upload or download files.
14274
14275 Not all remote targets support these commands.
14276
14277 @table @code
14278 @kindex remote put
14279 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
14280 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
14281 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
14282
14283 @kindex remote get
14284 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
14285 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
14286 on the host system.
14287
14288 @kindex remote delete
14289 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
14290 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
14291
14292 @end table
14293
14294 @node Server
14295 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
14296
14297 @kindex gdbserver
14298 @cindex remote connection without stubs
14299 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
14300 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
14301 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
14302
14303 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
14304 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
14305 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
14306 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
14307 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
14308 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
14309 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
14310 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
14311 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
14312 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
14313 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
14314 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
14315 choice for debugging.
14316
14317 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
14318 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
14319 protocol.
14320
14321 @quotation
14322 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
14323 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
14324 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
14325 target system with the same privileges as the user running
14326 @code{gdbserver}.
14327 @end quotation
14328
14329 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
14330 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
14331
14332 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
14333 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
14334 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
14335 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
14336 system does all the symbol handling.
14337
14338 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
14339 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
14340 syntax is:
14341
14342 @smallexample
14343 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
14344 @end smallexample
14345
14346 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
14347 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
14348 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
14349 @file{/dev/com1}:
14350
14351 @smallexample
14352 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
14353 @end smallexample
14354
14355 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
14356 with it.
14357
14358 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
14359
14360 @smallexample
14361 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
14362 @end smallexample
14363
14364 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
14365 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
14366 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
14367 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
14368 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
14369 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
14370 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
14371 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
14372 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
14373 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
14374 @code{target remote} command.
14375
14376 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
14377
14378 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
14379 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
14380
14381 @smallexample
14382 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
14383 @end smallexample
14384
14385 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
14386 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
14387
14388 @pindex pidof
14389 @cindex attach to a program by name
14390 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
14391 @code{pidof} utility:
14392
14393 @smallexample
14394 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
14395 @end smallexample
14396
14397 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
14398 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
14399 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
14400
14401 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
14402 @cindex gdbserver, multiple processes
14403 @cindex multiple processes with gdbserver
14404
14405 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
14406 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
14407 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
14408 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
14409
14410 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
14411 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
14412 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
14413 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
14414 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
14415 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
14416 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
14417 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
14418 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
14419
14420 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
14421 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
14422 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
14423 the program you want to debug.
14424
14425 @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit in multi-process mode.
14426 You can terminate it by using @code{monitor exit}
14427 (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
14428
14429 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
14430
14431 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
14432 status information about the debugging process. The
14433 @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
14434 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
14435 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
14436
14437 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
14438 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
14439 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
14440 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
14441
14442 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
14443 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
14444 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
14445 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
14446
14447 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
14448 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
14449 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
14450 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
14451
14452 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
14453 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
14454 environment:
14455
14456 @smallexample
14457 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
14458 @end smallexample
14459
14460 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
14461
14462 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
14463
14464 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
14465 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
14466 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
14467 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
14468
14469 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
14470 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
14471 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
14472 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
14473 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
14474 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
14475 programs.
14476
14477 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
14478 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
14479 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
14480 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
14481 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
14482 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
14483 already on the target.
14484
14485 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
14486 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
14487 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
14488
14489 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
14490 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
14491 Here are the available commands.
14492
14493 @table @code
14494 @item monitor help
14495 List the available monitor commands.
14496
14497 @item monitor set debug 0
14498 @itemx monitor set debug 1
14499 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
14500
14501 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
14502 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
14503 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
14504 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
14505
14506 @item monitor exit
14507 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
14508 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
14509 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
14510 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
14511 of a multi-process mode debug session.
14512
14513 @end table
14514
14515 @node Remote Configuration
14516 @section Remote Configuration
14517
14518 @kindex set remote
14519 @kindex show remote
14520 This section documents the configuration options available when
14521 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
14522 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
14523 system-call-allowed}.
14524
14525 @table @code
14526 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
14527 @cindex address size for remote targets
14528 @cindex bits in remote address
14529 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
14530 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
14531 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
14532 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
14533
14534 @item show remoteaddresssize
14535 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
14536
14537 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
14538 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
14539 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
14540 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
14541 remote targets.
14542
14543 @item show remotebaud
14544 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
14545
14546 @item set remotebreak
14547 @cindex interrupt remote programs
14548 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
14549 @anchor{set remotebreak}
14550 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
14551 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
14552 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
14553 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
14554 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
14555
14556 @item show remotebreak
14557 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
14558 interrupt the remote program.
14559
14560 @item set remoteflow on
14561 @itemx set remoteflow off
14562 @kindex set remoteflow
14563 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
14564 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
14565
14566 @item show remoteflow
14567 @kindex show remoteflow
14568 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
14569
14570 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
14571 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
14572 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
14573 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
14574 @code{ascii}.
14575
14576 @item show remotelogbase
14577 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
14578 protocol.
14579
14580 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
14581 @cindex record serial communications on file
14582 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
14583 default is not to record at all.
14584
14585 @item show remotelogfile.
14586 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
14587 serial communications.
14588
14589 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
14590 @cindex timeout for serial communications
14591 @cindex remote timeout
14592 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
14593 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
14594
14595 @item show remotetimeout
14596 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
14597 responses.
14598
14599 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
14600 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
14601 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
14602 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
14603 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
14604 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
14605 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
14606 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
14607
14608 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
14609 @itemx show remote exec-file
14610 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
14611 @cindex executable file, for remote target
14612 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
14613 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
14614 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
14615 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
14616
14617 @kindex set tcp
14618 @kindex show tcp
14619 @item set tcp auto-retry on
14620 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
14621 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
14622 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
14623 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
14624 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
14625 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
14626 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
14627 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
14628
14629 @item set tcp auto-retry off
14630 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
14631
14632 @item show tcp auto-retry
14633 Show the current auto-retry setting.
14634
14635 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
14636 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
14637 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
14638 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
14639 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
14640 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
14641 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
14642 value.
14643
14644 @item show tcp connect-timeout
14645 Show the current connection timeout setting.
14646 @end table
14647
14648 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
14649 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
14650 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
14651 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
14652 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
14653 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
14654 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
14655 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
14656 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
14657
14658 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
14659 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
14660 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
14661 @value{GDBN} developers.
14662
14663 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
14664 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
14665 are:
14666
14667 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
14668 @item Command Name
14669 @tab Remote Packet
14670 @tab Related Features
14671
14672 @item @code{fetch-register}
14673 @tab @code{p}
14674 @tab @code{info registers}
14675
14676 @item @code{set-register}
14677 @tab @code{P}
14678 @tab @code{set}
14679
14680 @item @code{binary-download}
14681 @tab @code{X}
14682 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
14683
14684 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
14685 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
14686 @tab @code{info auxv}
14687
14688 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
14689 @tab @code{qSymbol}
14690 @tab Detecting multiple threads
14691
14692 @item @code{attach}
14693 @tab @code{vAttach}
14694 @tab @code{attach}
14695
14696 @item @code{verbose-resume}
14697 @tab @code{vCont}
14698 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
14699
14700 @item @code{run}
14701 @tab @code{vRun}
14702 @tab @code{run}
14703
14704 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
14705 @tab @code{Z0}
14706 @tab @code{break}
14707
14708 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
14709 @tab @code{Z1}
14710 @tab @code{hbreak}
14711
14712 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
14713 @tab @code{Z2}
14714 @tab @code{watch}
14715
14716 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
14717 @tab @code{Z3}
14718 @tab @code{rwatch}
14719
14720 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
14721 @tab @code{Z4}
14722 @tab @code{awatch}
14723
14724 @item @code{target-features}
14725 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
14726 @tab @code{set architecture}
14727
14728 @item @code{library-info}
14729 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
14730 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
14731
14732 @item @code{memory-map}
14733 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
14734 @tab @code{info mem}
14735
14736 @item @code{read-spu-object}
14737 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
14738 @tab @code{info spu}
14739
14740 @item @code{write-spu-object}
14741 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
14742 @tab @code{info spu}
14743
14744 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
14745 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
14746 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
14747
14748 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
14749 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
14750 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
14751
14752 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
14753 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
14754 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
14755
14756 @item @code{search-memory}
14757 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
14758 @tab @code{find}
14759
14760 @item @code{supported-packets}
14761 @tab @code{qSupported}
14762 @tab Remote communications parameters
14763
14764 @item @code{pass-signals}
14765 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
14766 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
14767
14768 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
14769 @tab @code{vFile:close}
14770 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
14771
14772 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
14773 @tab @code{vFile:open}
14774 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
14775
14776 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
14777 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
14778 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
14779
14780 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
14781 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
14782 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
14783
14784 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
14785 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
14786 @tab @code{remote delete}
14787
14788 @item @code{noack-packet}
14789 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
14790 @tab Packet acknowledgment
14791
14792 @item @code{osdata}
14793 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
14794 @tab @code{info os}
14795
14796 @item @code{query-attached}
14797 @tab @code{qAttached}
14798 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
14799 @end multitable
14800
14801 @node Remote Stub
14802 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
14803
14804 @cindex debugging stub, example
14805 @cindex remote stub, example
14806 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
14807 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
14808 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
14809 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
14810 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
14811 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
14812 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
14813 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
14814
14815 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
14816 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
14817 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
14818 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
14819 program, you need:
14820
14821 @enumerate
14822 @item
14823 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
14824 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
14825 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
14826
14827 @item
14828 A C subroutine library to support your program's
14829 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
14830
14831 @item
14832 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
14833 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
14834 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
14835 documentation.
14836 @end enumerate
14837
14838 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
14839 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
14840 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
14841
14842 @table @emph
14843 @item On the host,
14844 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
14845 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
14846 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
14847
14848 @item On the target,
14849 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
14850 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
14851 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
14852
14853 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
14854 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
14855 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
14856 @end table
14857
14858 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
14859 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
14860 @sc{sparc} boards.
14861
14862 @cindex remote serial stub list
14863 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
14864
14865 @table @code
14866
14867 @item i386-stub.c
14868 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
14869 @cindex Intel
14870 @cindex i386
14871 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
14872
14873 @item m68k-stub.c
14874 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
14875 @cindex Motorola 680x0
14876 @cindex m680x0
14877 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
14878
14879 @item sh-stub.c
14880 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
14881 @cindex Renesas
14882 @cindex SH
14883 For Renesas SH architectures.
14884
14885 @item sparc-stub.c
14886 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
14887 @cindex Sparc
14888 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
14889
14890 @item sparcl-stub.c
14891 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
14892 @cindex Fujitsu
14893 @cindex SparcLite
14894 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
14895
14896 @end table
14897
14898 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
14899 recently added stubs.
14900
14901 @menu
14902 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
14903 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
14904 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
14905 @end menu
14906
14907 @node Stub Contents
14908 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
14909
14910 @cindex remote serial stub
14911 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
14912 subroutines:
14913
14914 @table @code
14915 @item set_debug_traps
14916 @findex set_debug_traps
14917 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
14918 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
14919 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
14920 beginning of your program.
14921
14922 @item handle_exception
14923 @findex handle_exception
14924 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
14925 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
14926 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
14927 run when a trap is triggered.
14928
14929 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
14930 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
14931 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
14932 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
14933 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
14934 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
14935 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
14936 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
14937 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
14938 machine.
14939
14940 @item breakpoint
14941 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
14942 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
14943 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
14944 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
14945 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
14946 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
14947 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
14948 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
14949 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
14950 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
14951 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
14952
14953 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
14954 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
14955 start of your debugging session.
14956 @end table
14957
14958 @node Bootstrapping
14959 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
14960
14961 @cindex remote stub, support routines
14962 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
14963 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
14964 debugging target machine.
14965
14966 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
14967 serial port.
14968
14969 @table @code
14970 @item int getDebugChar()
14971 @findex getDebugChar
14972 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
14973 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
14974 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
14975
14976 @item void putDebugChar(int)
14977 @findex putDebugChar
14978 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
14979 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
14980 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
14981 @end table
14982
14983 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
14984 @cindex interrupting remote targets
14985 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
14986 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
14987 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
14988 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
14989 remote system to stop.
14990
14991 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
14992 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
14993 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
14994 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
14995
14996 Other routines you need to supply are:
14997
14998 @table @code
14999 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
15000 @findex exceptionHandler
15001 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
15002 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
15003 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
15004 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
15005 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
15006 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
15007 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
15008 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
15009 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
15010 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
15011 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
15012 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
15013 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
15014
15015 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
15016 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
15017 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
15018 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
15019 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
15020
15021 @item void flush_i_cache()
15022 @findex flush_i_cache
15023 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
15024 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
15025 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
15026
15027 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
15028 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
15029 @end table
15030
15031 @noindent
15032 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
15033
15034 @table @code
15035 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
15036 @findex memset
15037 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
15038 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
15039 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
15040 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
15041 @end table
15042
15043 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
15044 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
15045 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
15046 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
15047
15048
15049 @node Debug Session
15050 @subsection Putting it All Together
15051
15052 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
15053 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
15054 steps.
15055
15056 @enumerate
15057 @item
15058 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
15059 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
15060 @display
15061 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
15062 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
15063 @end display
15064
15065 @item
15066 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
15067
15068 @smallexample
15069 set_debug_traps();
15070 breakpoint();
15071 @end smallexample
15072
15073 @item
15074 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
15075 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
15076
15077 @smallexample
15078 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
15079 @end smallexample
15080
15081 @noindent
15082 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
15083 function in your program, that function is called when
15084 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
15085 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
15086 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
15087
15088 @item
15089 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
15090 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
15091
15092 @item
15093 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
15094 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
15095
15096 @item
15097 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
15098 @c document that. FIXME.
15099 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
15100 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
15101
15102 @item
15103 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
15104 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
15105
15106 @end enumerate
15107
15108 @node Configurations
15109 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
15110
15111 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
15112 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
15113 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
15114
15115 There are three major categories of configurations: native
15116 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
15117 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
15118 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
15119 are quite different from each other.
15120
15121 @menu
15122 * Native::
15123 * Embedded OS::
15124 * Embedded Processors::
15125 * Architectures::
15126 @end menu
15127
15128 @node Native
15129 @section Native
15130
15131 This section describes details specific to particular native
15132 configurations.
15133
15134 @menu
15135 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
15136 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
15137 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
15138 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
15139 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
15140 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
15141 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
15142 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
15143 @end menu
15144
15145 @node HP-UX
15146 @subsection HP-UX
15147
15148 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
15149 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
15150 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
15151
15152
15153 @node BSD libkvm Interface
15154 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
15155
15156 @cindex libkvm
15157 @cindex kernel memory image
15158 @cindex kernel crash dump
15159
15160 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
15161 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
15162 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
15163 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
15164 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
15165 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
15166 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
15167 @code{kvm} target:
15168
15169 @smallexample
15170 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
15171 @end smallexample
15172
15173 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
15174 argument:
15175
15176 @smallexample
15177 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
15178 @end smallexample
15179
15180 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
15181 available:
15182
15183 @table @code
15184 @kindex kvm
15185 @item kvm pcb
15186 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
15187
15188 @item kvm proc
15189 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
15190 modern FreeBSD systems.
15191 @end table
15192
15193 @node SVR4 Process Information
15194 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
15195 @cindex /proc
15196 @cindex examine process image
15197 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
15198
15199 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
15200 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
15201 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
15202 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
15203 proc} is available to report information about the process running
15204 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
15205 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
15206 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
15207 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
15208
15209 @table @code
15210 @kindex info proc
15211 @cindex process ID
15212 @item info proc
15213 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
15214 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
15215 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
15216 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
15217 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
15218 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
15219 executable file's absolute file name.
15220
15221 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
15222 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
15223 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
15224 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
15225 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
15226 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
15227
15228 @item info proc mappings
15229 @cindex memory address space mappings
15230 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
15231 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
15232 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
15233 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
15234 memory access rights to that range.
15235
15236 @item info proc stat
15237 @itemx info proc status
15238 @cindex process detailed status information
15239 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
15240 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
15241 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
15242 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
15243 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
15244 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
15245 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
15246
15247 @item info proc all
15248 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
15249 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
15250
15251 @ignore
15252 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
15253 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
15254 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
15255 @kindex info proc times
15256 @item info proc times
15257 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
15258 its children.
15259
15260 @kindex info proc id
15261 @item info proc id
15262 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
15263 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
15264 @end ignore
15265
15266 @item set procfs-trace
15267 @kindex set procfs-trace
15268 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
15269 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
15270
15271 @item show procfs-trace
15272 @kindex show procfs-trace
15273 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
15274
15275 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
15276 @kindex set procfs-file
15277 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
15278 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
15279 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
15280 standard output.
15281
15282 @item show procfs-file
15283 @kindex show procfs-file
15284 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
15285
15286 @item proc-trace-entry
15287 @itemx proc-trace-exit
15288 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
15289 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
15290 @kindex proc-trace-entry
15291 @kindex proc-trace-exit
15292 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
15293 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
15294 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
15295 from the @code{syscall} interface.
15296
15297 @item info pidlist
15298 @kindex info pidlist
15299 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
15300 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
15301 processes and all the threads within each process.
15302
15303 @item info meminfo
15304 @kindex info meminfo
15305 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
15306 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
15307 @end table
15308
15309 @node DJGPP Native
15310 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
15311 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
15312 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
15313 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
15314
15315 @cindex DPMI
15316 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
15317 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
15318 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
15319 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
15320
15321 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
15322 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
15323 subsection describes those commands.
15324
15325 @table @code
15326 @kindex info dos
15327 @item info dos
15328 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
15329 information about the target system and important OS structures.
15330
15331 @kindex sysinfo
15332 @cindex MS-DOS system info
15333 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
15334 @item info dos sysinfo
15335 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
15336 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
15337 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
15338
15339 @cindex GDT
15340 @cindex LDT
15341 @cindex IDT
15342 @cindex segment descriptor tables
15343 @cindex descriptor tables display
15344 @item info dos gdt
15345 @itemx info dos ldt
15346 @itemx info dos idt
15347 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
15348 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
15349 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
15350 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
15351 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
15352 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
15353 rights.
15354
15355 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
15356 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
15357 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
15358 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
15359 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
15360
15361 @cindex garbled pointers
15362 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
15363 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
15364 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
15365 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
15366 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
15367 debugged program's data segment:
15368
15369 @smallexample
15370 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
15371 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
15372 @end smallexample
15373
15374 @noindent
15375 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
15376 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
15377
15378 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
15379 @item info dos pde
15380 @itemx info dos pte
15381 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
15382 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
15383 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
15384 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
15385 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
15386 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
15387 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
15388 that is currently in use.
15389
15390 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
15391 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
15392 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
15393 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
15394 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
15395 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
15396 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
15397
15398 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
15399 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
15400 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
15401 controller.
15402
15403 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
15404
15405 @cindex physical address from linear address
15406 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
15407 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
15408 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
15409 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
15410 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
15411 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
15412 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
15413
15414 @smallexample
15415 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
15416 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
15417 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
15418 @end smallexample
15419
15420 @noindent
15421 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
15422 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
15423 attributes of that page.
15424
15425 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
15426 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
15427 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
15428 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
15429 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
15430 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
15431
15432 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
15433 transfer buffer:
15434
15435 @smallexample
15436 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
15437 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
15438 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
15439 @end smallexample
15440
15441 @noindent
15442 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
15443 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
15444 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
15445 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
15446 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
15447
15448 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
15449 @end table
15450
15451 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
15452 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
15453 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
15454 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
15455
15456 @table @code
15457 @kindex set com1base
15458 @kindex set com1irq
15459 @kindex set com2base
15460 @kindex set com2irq
15461 @kindex set com3base
15462 @kindex set com3irq
15463 @kindex set com4base
15464 @kindex set com4irq
15465 @item set com1base @var{addr}
15466 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
15467 port.
15468
15469 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
15470 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
15471 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
15472
15473 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
15474 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
15475 other 3 COM ports.
15476
15477 @kindex show com1base
15478 @kindex show com1irq
15479 @kindex show com2base
15480 @kindex show com2irq
15481 @kindex show com3base
15482 @kindex show com3irq
15483 @kindex show com4base
15484 @kindex show com4irq
15485 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
15486 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
15487 lines used by the COM ports.
15488
15489 @item info serial
15490 @kindex info serial
15491 @cindex DOS serial port status
15492 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
15493 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
15494 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
15495 counts of various errors encountered so far.
15496 @end table
15497
15498
15499 @node Cygwin Native
15500 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
15501 @cindex MS Windows debugging
15502 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
15503 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
15504
15505 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
15506 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
15507 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this section.
15508 Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is described in
15509 @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
15510
15511 @table @code
15512 @kindex info w32
15513 @item info w32
15514 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
15515 information about the target system and important OS structures.
15516
15517 @item info w32 selector
15518 This command displays information returned by
15519 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
15520 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
15521 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
15522 Without argument, this command displays information
15523 about the six segment registers.
15524
15525 @kindex info dll
15526 @item info dll
15527 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
15528
15529 @kindex dll-symbols
15530 @item dll-symbols
15531 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
15532 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
15533
15534 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
15535 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
15536 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
15537 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
15538 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
15539 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
15540 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
15541 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
15542 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
15543 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
15544 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
15545
15546 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
15547 @item show cygwin-exceptions
15548 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
15549 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
15550
15551 @kindex set new-console
15552 @item set new-console @var{mode}
15553 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
15554 be started in a new console on next start.
15555 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
15556 be started in the same console as the debugger.
15557
15558 @kindex show new-console
15559 @item show new-console
15560 Displays whether a new console is used
15561 when the debuggee is started.
15562
15563 @kindex set new-group
15564 @item set new-group @var{mode}
15565 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
15566 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
15567 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
15568 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
15569
15570 @kindex show new-group
15571 @item show new-group
15572 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
15573
15574 @kindex set debugevents
15575 @item set debugevents
15576 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
15577 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
15578 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
15579 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
15580 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
15581
15582 @kindex set debugexec
15583 @item set debugexec
15584 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
15585 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
15586
15587 @kindex set debugexceptions
15588 @item set debugexceptions
15589 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
15590 debuggee seen by the debugger.
15591
15592 @kindex set debugmemory
15593 @item set debugmemory
15594 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
15595 and writes by the debugger.
15596
15597 @kindex set shell
15598 @item set shell
15599 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
15600 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
15601
15602 @kindex show shell
15603 @item show shell
15604 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
15605
15606 @end table
15607
15608 @menu
15609 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
15610 @end menu
15611
15612 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
15613 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
15614 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
15615 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
15616
15617 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
15618 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
15619 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
15620 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
15621 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
15622 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
15623 ``minimal symbols''.
15624
15625 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
15626 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
15627 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
15628 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
15629 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
15630 see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
15631 @code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
15632 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
15633 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
15634 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
15635
15636 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
15637
15638 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
15639 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
15640 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
15641 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
15642 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
15643 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
15644 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
15645 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
15646 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
15647
15648 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
15649 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
15650 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
15651 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
15652 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
15653 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
15654
15655 @smallexample
15656 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
15657 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
15658
15659 Non-debugging symbols:
15660 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
15661 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
15662 @end smallexample
15663
15664 @smallexample
15665 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
15666 All functions matching regular expression "!":
15667
15668 Non-debugging symbols:
15669 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
15670 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
15671 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
15672 [etc...]
15673 @end smallexample
15674
15675 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
15676
15677 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
15678 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
15679 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
15680 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
15681 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
15682 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
15683 a function within a DLL without a running program.
15684
15685 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
15686 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
15687 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
15688 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
15689 problem:
15690
15691 @smallexample
15692 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
15693 $1 = 268572168
15694 @end smallexample
15695
15696 @smallexample
15697 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
15698 0x10021610: "\230y\""
15699 @end smallexample
15700
15701 And two possible solutions:
15702
15703 @smallexample
15704 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
15705 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
15706 @end smallexample
15707
15708 @smallexample
15709 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
15710 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
15711 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
15712 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
15713 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
15714 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
15715 @end smallexample
15716
15717 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
15718 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
15719 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
15720 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
15721 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
15722
15723 @smallexample
15724 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
15725 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
15726 @end smallexample
15727
15728 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
15729 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
15730 safe.
15731
15732 @node Hurd Native
15733 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
15734 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
15735
15736 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
15737 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
15738
15739 @table @code
15740 @item set signals
15741 @itemx set sigs
15742 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
15743 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
15744 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
15745 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
15746 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
15747 @code{signals}.
15748
15749 @item show signals
15750 @itemx show sigs
15751 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
15752 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
15753 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
15754
15755 @item set signal-thread
15756 @itemx set sigthread
15757 @kindex set signal-thread
15758 @kindex set sigthread
15759 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
15760 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
15761 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
15762 signal-thread}.
15763
15764 @item show signal-thread
15765 @itemx show sigthread
15766 @kindex show signal-thread
15767 @kindex show sigthread
15768 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
15769 delivered a signal.
15770
15771 @item set stopped
15772 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
15773 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
15774 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
15775 continued by delivering a signal to it.
15776
15777 @item show stopped
15778 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
15779 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
15780 stopped.
15781
15782 @item set exceptions
15783 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
15784 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
15785 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
15786 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
15787 trapping on.
15788
15789 @item show exceptions
15790 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
15791 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
15792
15793 @item set task pause
15794 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
15795 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
15796 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
15797 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
15798 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
15799 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
15800 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
15801 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
15802 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
15803
15804 @item show task pause
15805 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
15806 Show the current state of task suspension.
15807
15808 @item set task detach-suspend-count
15809 @cindex task suspend count
15810 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15811 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
15812 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
15813
15814 @item show task detach-suspend-count
15815 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
15816
15817 @item set task exception-port
15818 @itemx set task excp
15819 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15820 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
15821 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
15822 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
15823
15824 @item set noninvasive
15825 @cindex noninvasive task options
15826 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
15827 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
15828 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
15829 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
15830
15831 @item info send-rights
15832 @itemx info receive-rights
15833 @itemx info port-rights
15834 @itemx info port-sets
15835 @itemx info dead-names
15836 @itemx info ports
15837 @itemx info psets
15838 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15839 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15840 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15841 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15842 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15843 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
15844 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
15845 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
15846 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
15847
15848 @item set thread pause
15849 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
15850 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15851 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
15852 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
15853 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
15854 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
15855 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
15856 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
15857 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
15858 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
15859 only the current thread.
15860
15861 @item show thread pause
15862 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
15863 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
15864
15865 @item set thread run
15866 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
15867
15868 @item show thread run
15869 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
15870
15871 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
15872 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15873 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15874 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
15875 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
15876 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
15877 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
15878
15879 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
15880 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
15881 detaching.
15882
15883 @item set thread exception-port
15884 @itemx set thread excp
15885 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
15886 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
15887 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
15888
15889 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
15890 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
15891 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
15892 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
15893
15894 @item set thread default
15895 @itemx show thread default
15896 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15897 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
15898 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
15899 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
15900 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
15901 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
15902 the non-default commands.
15903 @end table
15904
15905
15906 @node Neutrino
15907 @subsection QNX Neutrino
15908 @cindex QNX Neutrino
15909
15910 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
15911 Neutrino target:
15912
15913 @table @code
15914 @item set debug nto-debug
15915 @kindex set debug nto-debug
15916 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
15917 Neutrino support.
15918
15919 @item show debug nto-debug
15920 @kindex show debug nto-debug
15921 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
15922 @end table
15923
15924 @node Darwin
15925 @subsection Darwin
15926 @cindex Darwin
15927
15928 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
15929
15930 @table @code
15931 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
15932 @kindex set debug darwin
15933 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
15934 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
15935
15936 @item show debug darwin
15937 @kindex show debug darwin
15938 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
15939
15940 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
15941 @kindex set debug mach-o
15942 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
15943 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
15944 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
15945 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
15946 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
15947 usage.
15948
15949 @item show debug mach-o
15950 @kindex show debug mach-o
15951 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
15952
15953 @item set mach-exceptions on
15954 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
15955 @kindex set mach-exceptions
15956 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
15957 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
15958 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
15959 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
15960
15961 @item show mach-exceptions
15962 @kindex show mach-exceptions
15963 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
15964 @end table
15965
15966
15967 @node Embedded OS
15968 @section Embedded Operating Systems
15969
15970 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
15971 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
15972 architectures.
15973
15974 @menu
15975 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
15976 @end menu
15977
15978 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
15979 various real-time operating systems.
15980
15981 @node VxWorks
15982 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
15983
15984 @cindex VxWorks
15985
15986 @table @code
15987
15988 @kindex target vxworks
15989 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
15990 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
15991 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
15992
15993 @end table
15994
15995 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
15996 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
15997
15998 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
15999 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
16000 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
16001 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
16002 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
16003 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
16004 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
16005
16006 @table @code
16007 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
16008 @kindex vxworks-timeout
16009 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
16010 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
16011 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
16012 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
16013 of a thin network line.
16014 @end table
16015
16016 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
16017 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
16018 procedures.
16019
16020 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
16021 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
16022 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
16023 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
16024 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
16025 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
16026 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
16027 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
16028 manual.
16029 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
16030
16031 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
16032 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
16033 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
16034 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
16035
16036 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
16037
16038 @smallexample
16039 (vxgdb)
16040 @end smallexample
16041
16042 @menu
16043 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
16044 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
16045 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
16046 @end menu
16047
16048 @node VxWorks Connection
16049 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
16050
16051 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
16052 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
16053
16054 @smallexample
16055 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
16056 @end smallexample
16057
16058 @need 750
16059 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
16060
16061 @smallexample
16062 Attaching remote machine across net...
16063 Connected to tt.
16064 @end smallexample
16065
16066 @need 1000
16067 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
16068 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
16069 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
16070 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
16071 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
16072
16073 @smallexample
16074 prog.o: No such file or directory.
16075 @end smallexample
16076
16077 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
16078 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
16079 command again.
16080
16081 @node VxWorks Download
16082 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
16083
16084 @cindex download to VxWorks
16085 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
16086 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
16087 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
16088 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
16089 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
16090 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
16091 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
16092 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
16093 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
16094 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
16095 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
16096 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
16097 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
16098 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
16099 program, type this on VxWorks:
16100
16101 @smallexample
16102 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
16103 @end smallexample
16104
16105 @noindent
16106 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
16107
16108 @smallexample
16109 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
16110 (vxgdb) load prog.o
16111 @end smallexample
16112
16113 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
16114
16115 @smallexample
16116 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
16117 @end smallexample
16118
16119 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
16120 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
16121 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
16122 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
16123 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
16124 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
16125 table.)
16126
16127 @node VxWorks Attach
16128 @subsubsection Running Tasks
16129
16130 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
16131 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
16132 follows:
16133
16134 @smallexample
16135 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
16136 @end smallexample
16137
16138 @noindent
16139 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
16140 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
16141 the time of attachment.
16142
16143 @node Embedded Processors
16144 @section Embedded Processors
16145
16146 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
16147 configurations.
16148
16149 @cindex send command to simulator
16150 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
16151 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
16152
16153 @table @code
16154 @item sim @var{command}
16155 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
16156 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
16157 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
16158 acceptable commands.
16159 @end table
16160
16161
16162 @menu
16163 * ARM:: ARM RDI
16164 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
16165 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
16166 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
16167 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
16168 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
16169 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
16170 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
16171 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
16172 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
16173 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
16174 * CRIS:: CRIS
16175 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
16176 @end menu
16177
16178 @node ARM
16179 @subsection ARM
16180 @cindex ARM RDI
16181
16182 @table @code
16183 @kindex target rdi
16184 @item target rdi @var{dev}
16185 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
16186 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
16187 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
16188
16189 @kindex target rdp
16190 @item target rdp @var{dev}
16191 ARM Demon monitor.
16192
16193 @end table
16194
16195 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
16196
16197 @table @code
16198 @item set arm disassembler
16199 @kindex set arm
16200 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
16201 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
16202
16203 @item show arm disassembler
16204 @kindex show arm
16205 Show the current disassembly style.
16206
16207 @item set arm apcs32
16208 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
16209 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
16210
16211 @item show arm apcs32
16212 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
16213
16214 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
16215 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
16216 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
16217
16218 @table @code
16219 @item auto
16220 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
16221 @item softfpa
16222 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
16223 processors.
16224 @item fpa
16225 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
16226 @item softvfp
16227 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
16228 @item vfp
16229 VFP co-processor.
16230 @end table
16231
16232 @item show arm fpu
16233 Show the current type of the FPU.
16234
16235 @item set arm abi
16236 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
16237
16238 @item show arm abi
16239 Show the currently used ABI.
16240
16241 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
16242 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
16243 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
16244 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
16245 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
16246 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
16247 register).
16248
16249 @item show arm fallback-mode
16250 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
16251
16252 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
16253 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
16254 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
16255 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
16256 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
16257
16258 @item show arm force-mode
16259 Show the current forced instruction mode.
16260
16261 @item set debug arm
16262 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
16263 target support subsystem.
16264
16265 @item show debug arm
16266 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
16267 @end table
16268
16269 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
16270 using the RDI interface:
16271
16272 @table @code
16273 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
16274 @kindex rdilogfile
16275 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
16276 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
16277 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
16278 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
16279 @file{rdi.log}.
16280
16281 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
16282 @kindex rdilogenable
16283 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
16284 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
16285 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
16286 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
16287 are logged to a file.
16288
16289 @item set rdiromatzero
16290 @kindex set rdiromatzero
16291 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
16292 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
16293 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
16294 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
16295 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
16296
16297 @item show rdiromatzero
16298 @kindex show rdiromatzero
16299 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
16300
16301 @item set rdiheartbeat
16302 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
16303 @cindex RDI heartbeat
16304 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
16305 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
16306 well as the Angel monitor.
16307
16308 @item show rdiheartbeat
16309 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
16310 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
16311 @end table
16312
16313
16314 @node M32R/D
16315 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
16316
16317 @table @code
16318 @kindex target m32r
16319 @item target m32r @var{dev}
16320 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
16321
16322 @kindex target m32rsdi
16323 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
16324 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
16325 @end table
16326
16327 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
16328
16329 @table @code
16330 @item set download-path @var{path}
16331 @kindex set download-path
16332 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
16333 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
16334
16335 @item show download-path
16336 @kindex show download-path
16337 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
16338
16339 @item set board-address @var{addr}
16340 @kindex set board-address
16341 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
16342 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
16343
16344 @item show board-address
16345 @kindex show board-address
16346 Show the current IP address of the target board.
16347
16348 @item set server-address @var{addr}
16349 @kindex set server-address
16350 @cindex download server address (M32R)
16351 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
16352 host machine.
16353
16354 @item show server-address
16355 @kindex show server-address
16356 Display the IP address of the download server.
16357
16358 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
16359 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
16360 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
16361 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
16362 executable file is uploaded.
16363
16364 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
16365 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
16366 Test the @code{upload} command.
16367 @end table
16368
16369 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
16370
16371 @table @code
16372 @item sdireset
16373 @kindex sdireset
16374 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
16375 This command resets the SDI connection.
16376
16377 @item sdistatus
16378 @kindex sdistatus
16379 This command shows the SDI connection status.
16380
16381 @item debug_chaos
16382 @kindex debug_chaos
16383 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
16384 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
16385
16386 @item use_debug_dma
16387 @kindex use_debug_dma
16388 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
16389
16390 @item use_mon_code
16391 @kindex use_mon_code
16392 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
16393
16394 @item use_ib_break
16395 @kindex use_ib_break
16396 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
16397
16398 @item use_dbt_break
16399 @kindex use_dbt_break
16400 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
16401 @end table
16402
16403 @node M68K
16404 @subsection M68k
16405
16406 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
16407 target command for the following ROM monitor.
16408
16409 @table @code
16410
16411 @kindex target dbug
16412 @item target dbug @var{dev}
16413 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
16414
16415 @end table
16416
16417 @node MIPS Embedded
16418 @subsection MIPS Embedded
16419
16420 @cindex MIPS boards
16421 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
16422 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
16423 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
16424
16425 @need 1000
16426 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
16427
16428 @table @code
16429 @item target mips @var{port}
16430 @kindex target mips @var{port}
16431 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
16432 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
16433 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
16434 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
16435 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
16436 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
16437
16438 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
16439 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
16440 debugger:
16441
16442 @smallexample
16443 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
16444 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
16445 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
16446 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
16447 (@value{GDBP}) run
16448 @end smallexample
16449
16450 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
16451 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
16452 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
16453 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
16454 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
16455
16456 @item target pmon @var{port}
16457 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
16458 PMON ROM monitor.
16459
16460 @item target ddb @var{port}
16461 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
16462 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
16463
16464 @item target lsi @var{port}
16465 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
16466 LSI variant of PMON.
16467
16468 @kindex target r3900
16469 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
16470 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
16471
16472 @kindex target array
16473 @item target array @var{dev}
16474 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
16475
16476 @end table
16477
16478
16479 @noindent
16480 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
16481
16482 @table @code
16483 @item set mipsfpu double
16484 @itemx set mipsfpu single
16485 @itemx set mipsfpu none
16486 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
16487 @itemx show mipsfpu
16488 @kindex set mipsfpu
16489 @kindex show mipsfpu
16490 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
16491 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
16492 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
16493 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
16494 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
16495 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
16496 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
16497 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
16498 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
16499 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
16500 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
16501 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
16502 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
16503
16504 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
16505 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
16506 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
16507
16508 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
16509 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
16510
16511 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
16512 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
16513 @itemx show timeout
16514 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
16515 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
16516 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
16517 @kindex set timeout
16518 @kindex show timeout
16519 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
16520 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
16521 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
16522 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
16523 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
16524 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
16525 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
16526 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
16527 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
16528 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
16529
16530 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
16531 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
16532 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
16533 to run before stopping.
16534
16535 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
16536 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
16537 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
16538 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
16539 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
16540 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
16541
16542 @item show syn-garbage-limit
16543 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
16544 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
16545 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
16546
16547 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
16548 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
16549 @cindex remote monitor prompt
16550 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
16551 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
16552 @table @asis
16553 @item pmon target
16554 @samp{PMON}
16555 @item ddb target
16556 @samp{NEC010}
16557 @item lsi target
16558 @samp{PMON>}
16559 @end table
16560
16561 @item show monitor-prompt
16562 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
16563 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
16564 remote monitor.
16565
16566 @item set monitor-warnings
16567 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
16568 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
16569 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
16570 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
16571 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
16572
16573 @item show monitor-warnings
16574 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
16575 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
16576
16577 @item pmon @var{command}
16578 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
16579 @cindex send PMON command
16580 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
16581 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
16582 @end table
16583
16584 @node OpenRISC 1000
16585 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
16586 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
16587
16588 @cindex or1k boards
16589 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
16590 about platform and commands.
16591
16592 @table @code
16593
16594 @kindex target jtag
16595 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
16596
16597 Connects to remote JTAG server.
16598 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
16599 connected via parallel port to the board.
16600
16601 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
16602
16603 @kindex or1ksim
16604 @item or1ksim @var{command}
16605 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
16606 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
16607
16608 @kindex info or1k spr
16609 @item info or1k spr
16610 Displays spr groups.
16611
16612 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
16613 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
16614 Displays register names in selected group.
16615
16616 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
16617 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
16618 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
16619 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
16620 Shows information about specified spr register.
16621
16622 @kindex spr
16623 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
16624 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
16625 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
16626 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
16627 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
16628 @end table
16629
16630 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
16631 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
16632 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
16633 triggers can be set using:
16634 @table @code
16635 @item $LEA/$LDATA
16636 Load effective address/data
16637 @item $SEA/$SDATA
16638 Store effective address/data
16639 @item $AEA/$ADATA
16640 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
16641 @item $FETCH
16642 Fetch data
16643 @end table
16644
16645 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
16646 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
16647
16648 @code{htrace} commands:
16649 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
16650 @table @code
16651 @kindex hwatch
16652 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
16653 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
16654 or Data. For example:
16655
16656 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
16657
16658 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
16659
16660 @kindex htrace
16661 @item htrace info
16662 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
16663
16664 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
16665 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
16666
16667 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
16668 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
16669
16670 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
16671 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
16672
16673 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
16674 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
16675 triggered.
16676
16677 @item htrace enable
16678 @itemx htrace disable
16679 Enables/disables the HW trace.
16680
16681 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
16682 Clears currently recorded trace data.
16683
16684 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
16685 will be written there.
16686
16687 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
16688 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
16689
16690 @item htrace mode continuous
16691 Set continuous trace mode.
16692
16693 @item htrace mode suspend
16694 Set suspend trace mode.
16695
16696 @end table
16697
16698 @node PowerPC Embedded
16699 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
16700
16701 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
16702
16703 @table @code
16704 @kindex set powerpc
16705 @item set powerpc soft-float
16706 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
16707 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
16708 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
16709 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
16710
16711 @item set powerpc vector-abi
16712 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
16713 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
16714 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
16715 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
16716 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
16717 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
16718 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
16719
16720 @kindex target dink32
16721 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
16722 DINK32 ROM monitor.
16723
16724 @kindex target ppcbug
16725 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
16726 @kindex target ppcbug1
16727 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
16728 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
16729
16730 @kindex target sds
16731 @item target sds @var{dev}
16732 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
16733 @end table
16734
16735 @cindex SDS protocol
16736 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
16737 by @value{GDBN}:
16738
16739 @table @code
16740 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
16741 @kindex set sdstimeout
16742 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
16743 default is 2 seconds.
16744
16745 @item show sdstimeout
16746 @kindex show sdstimeout
16747 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
16748
16749 @item sds @var{command}
16750 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
16751 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
16752 @end table
16753
16754
16755 @node PA
16756 @subsection HP PA Embedded
16757
16758 @table @code
16759
16760 @kindex target op50n
16761 @item target op50n @var{dev}
16762 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
16763
16764 @kindex target w89k
16765 @item target w89k @var{dev}
16766 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
16767
16768 @end table
16769
16770 @node Sparclet
16771 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
16772
16773 @cindex Sparclet
16774
16775 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
16776 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
16777 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
16778 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
16779 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
16780
16781 @table @code
16782 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
16783 @kindex remotetimeout
16784 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
16785 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
16786 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
16787 @end table
16788
16789 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
16790 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
16791 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
16792 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
16793 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
16794
16795 @smallexample
16796 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
16797 @end smallexample
16798
16799 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
16800
16801 @smallexample
16802 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
16803 @end smallexample
16804
16805 @cindex running, on Sparclet
16806 Once you have set
16807 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
16808 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
16809 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
16810
16811 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
16812
16813 @smallexample
16814 (gdbslet)
16815 @end smallexample
16816
16817 @menu
16818 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
16819 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
16820 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
16821 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
16822 @end menu
16823
16824 @node Sparclet File
16825 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
16826
16827 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
16828
16829 @smallexample
16830 (gdbslet) file prog
16831 @end smallexample
16832
16833 @need 1000
16834 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
16835 @value{GDBN} locates
16836 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
16837 path.
16838 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
16839 files will be searched as well.
16840 @value{GDBN} locates
16841 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
16842 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
16843 If it fails
16844 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
16845
16846 @smallexample
16847 prog: No such file or directory.
16848 @end smallexample
16849
16850 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
16851 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
16852 @code{target} command again.
16853
16854 @node Sparclet Connection
16855 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
16856
16857 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
16858 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
16859
16860 @smallexample
16861 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
16862 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
16863 main () at ../prog.c:3
16864 @end smallexample
16865
16866 @need 750
16867 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
16868
16869 @smallexample
16870 Connected to ttya.
16871 @end smallexample
16872
16873 @node Sparclet Download
16874 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
16875
16876 @cindex download to Sparclet
16877 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
16878 you can use the @value{GDBN}
16879 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
16880 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
16881 command.
16882 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
16883 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
16884 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
16885 of each of the file's sections.
16886 For instance, if the program
16887 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
16888 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
16889
16890 @smallexample
16891 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
16892 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
16893 @end smallexample
16894
16895 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
16896 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
16897 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
16898
16899 @node Sparclet Execution
16900 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
16901
16902 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
16903 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
16904 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
16905 manual for the list of commands.
16906
16907 @smallexample
16908 (gdbslet) b main
16909 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
16910 (gdbslet) run
16911 Starting program: prog
16912 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
16913 3 char *symarg = 0;
16914 (gdbslet) step
16915 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
16916 (gdbslet)
16917 @end smallexample
16918
16919 @node Sparclite
16920 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
16921
16922 @table @code
16923
16924 @kindex target sparclite
16925 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
16926 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
16927 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
16928 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
16929 remote protocol.
16930
16931 @end table
16932
16933 @node Z8000
16934 @subsection Zilog Z8000
16935
16936 @cindex Z8000
16937 @cindex simulator, Z8000
16938 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
16939
16940 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
16941 a Z8000 simulator.
16942
16943 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
16944 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
16945 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
16946 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
16947
16948 @table @code
16949 @item target sim @var{args}
16950 @kindex sim
16951 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
16952 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
16953 options, specify them via @var{args}.
16954 @end table
16955
16956 @noindent
16957 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
16958 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
16959 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
16960 to run your program, and so on.
16961
16962 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
16963 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
16964 additional items of information as specially named registers:
16965
16966 @table @code
16967
16968 @item cycles
16969 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
16970
16971 @item insts
16972 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
16973
16974 @item time
16975 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
16976
16977 @end table
16978
16979 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
16980 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
16981 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
16982 simulated clock ticks.
16983
16984 @node AVR
16985 @subsection Atmel AVR
16986 @cindex AVR
16987
16988 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
16989 following AVR-specific commands:
16990
16991 @table @code
16992 @item info io_registers
16993 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
16994 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
16995 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
16996 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
16997 @end table
16998
16999 @node CRIS
17000 @subsection CRIS
17001 @cindex CRIS
17002
17003 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
17004 following CRIS-specific commands:
17005
17006 @table @code
17007 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
17008 @cindex CRIS version
17009 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
17010 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
17011 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
17012
17013 @item show cris-version
17014 Show the current CRIS version.
17015
17016 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
17017 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
17018 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
17019 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
17020 @code{R59}.
17021
17022 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
17023 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
17024
17025 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
17026 @cindex CRIS mode
17027 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
17028 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
17029 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
17030
17031 @item show cris-mode
17032 Show the current CRIS mode.
17033 @end table
17034
17035 @node Super-H
17036 @subsection Renesas Super-H
17037 @cindex Super-H
17038
17039 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
17040 commands:
17041
17042 @table @code
17043 @item regs
17044 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
17045 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
17046
17047 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
17048 @kindex set sh calling-convention
17049 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
17050 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
17051 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
17052 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
17053 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
17054 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
17055 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
17056 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
17057 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
17058 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
17059
17060 @item show sh calling-convention
17061 @kindex show sh calling-convention
17062 Show the current calling convention setting.
17063
17064 @end table
17065
17066
17067 @node Architectures
17068 @section Architectures
17069
17070 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
17071 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
17072
17073 @menu
17074 * i386::
17075 * A29K::
17076 * Alpha::
17077 * MIPS::
17078 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
17079 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
17080 * PowerPC::
17081 @end menu
17082
17083 @node i386
17084 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
17085
17086 @table @code
17087 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
17088 @kindex set struct-convention
17089 @cindex struct return convention
17090 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
17091 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
17092 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
17093 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
17094 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
17095 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
17096 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
17097 be returned in a register.
17098
17099 @item show struct-convention
17100 @kindex show struct-convention
17101 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
17102 from functions.
17103 @end table
17104
17105 @node A29K
17106 @subsection A29K
17107
17108 @table @code
17109
17110 @kindex set rstack_high_address
17111 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
17112 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
17113 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
17114 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
17115 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
17116 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
17117 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
17118 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
17119 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
17120 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
17121 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
17122 hexadecimal.
17123
17124 @kindex show rstack_high_address
17125 @item show rstack_high_address
17126 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
17127 processors.
17128
17129 @end table
17130
17131 @node Alpha
17132 @subsection Alpha
17133
17134 See the following section.
17135
17136 @node MIPS
17137 @subsection MIPS
17138
17139 @cindex stack on Alpha
17140 @cindex stack on MIPS
17141 @cindex Alpha stack
17142 @cindex MIPS stack
17143 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
17144 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
17145 find the beginning of a function.
17146
17147 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
17148 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
17149 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
17150 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
17151 commands:
17152
17153 @table @code
17154 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
17155 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
17156 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
17157 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
17158 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
17159 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
17160 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
17161 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
17162
17163 @item show heuristic-fence-post
17164 Display the current limit.
17165 @end table
17166
17167 @noindent
17168 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
17169 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
17170
17171 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
17172 programs:
17173
17174 @table @code
17175 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
17176 @kindex set mips abi
17177 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
17178 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
17179 values of @var{arg} are:
17180
17181 @table @samp
17182 @item auto
17183 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
17184 default).
17185 @item o32
17186 @item o64
17187 @item n32
17188 @item n64
17189 @item eabi32
17190 @item eabi64
17191 @item auto
17192 @end table
17193
17194 @item show mips abi
17195 @kindex show mips abi
17196 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
17197
17198 @item set mipsfpu
17199 @itemx show mipsfpu
17200 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
17201
17202 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
17203 @kindex set mips mask-address
17204 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
17205 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
17206 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
17207 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
17208 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
17209
17210 @item show mips mask-address
17211 @kindex show mips mask-address
17212 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
17213 not.
17214
17215 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
17216 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
17217 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
17218 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
17219 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
17220 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
17221
17222 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
17223 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
17224 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
17225
17226 @item set debug mips
17227 @kindex set debug mips
17228 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
17229 target code in @value{GDBN}.
17230
17231 @item show debug mips
17232 @kindex show debug mips
17233 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
17234 @end table
17235
17236
17237 @node HPPA
17238 @subsection HPPA
17239 @cindex HPPA support
17240
17241 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
17242 following special commands:
17243
17244 @table @code
17245 @item set debug hppa
17246 @kindex set debug hppa
17247 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
17248 messages are to be displayed.
17249
17250 @item show debug hppa
17251 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
17252
17253 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
17254 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
17255 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
17256 given @var{address}.
17257
17258 @end table
17259
17260
17261 @node SPU
17262 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
17263 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
17264 @cindex SPU
17265
17266 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
17267 it provides the following special commands:
17268
17269 @table @code
17270 @item info spu event
17271 @kindex info spu
17272 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
17273 and pending event status.
17274
17275 @item info spu signal
17276 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
17277 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
17278 notification channels.
17279
17280 @item info spu mailbox
17281 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
17282 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
17283 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
17284
17285 @item info spu dma
17286 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
17287 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
17288 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
17289
17290 @item info spu proxydma
17291 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
17292 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
17293 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
17294
17295 @end table
17296
17297 @node PowerPC
17298 @subsection PowerPC
17299 @cindex PowerPC architecture
17300
17301 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
17302 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
17303 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
17304 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
17305 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
17306
17307 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
17308 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
17309 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
17310
17311 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
17312 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
17313
17314
17315 @node Controlling GDB
17316 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
17317
17318 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
17319 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
17320 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
17321 described here.
17322
17323 @menu
17324 * Prompt:: Prompt
17325 * Editing:: Command editing
17326 * Command History:: Command history
17327 * Screen Size:: Screen size
17328 * Numbers:: Numbers
17329 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
17330 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
17331 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
17332 @end menu
17333
17334 @node Prompt
17335 @section Prompt
17336
17337 @cindex prompt
17338
17339 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
17340 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
17341 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
17342 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
17343 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
17344 which one you are talking to.
17345
17346 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
17347 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
17348 or a prompt that does not.
17349
17350 @table @code
17351 @kindex set prompt
17352 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
17353 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
17354
17355 @kindex show prompt
17356 @item show prompt
17357 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
17358 @end table
17359
17360 @node Editing
17361 @section Command Editing
17362 @cindex readline
17363 @cindex command line editing
17364
17365 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
17366 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
17367 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
17368 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
17369 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
17370 debugging sessions.
17371
17372 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
17373 command @code{set}.
17374
17375 @table @code
17376 @kindex set editing
17377 @cindex editing
17378 @item set editing
17379 @itemx set editing on
17380 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
17381
17382 @item set editing off
17383 Disable command line editing.
17384
17385 @kindex show editing
17386 @item show editing
17387 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
17388 @end table
17389
17390 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
17391 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
17392 encouraged to read that chapter.
17393
17394 @node Command History
17395 @section Command History
17396 @cindex command history
17397
17398 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
17399 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
17400 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
17401 history facility.
17402
17403 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
17404 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
17405 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
17406
17407 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
17408 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
17409 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
17410 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
17411 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
17412 pressed on a line by itself.
17413
17414 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
17415 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
17416 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
17417 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
17418
17419 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
17420 history.
17421
17422 @table @code
17423 @cindex history substitution
17424 @cindex history file
17425 @kindex set history filename
17426 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
17427 @item set history filename @var{fname}
17428 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
17429 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
17430 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
17431 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
17432 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
17433 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
17434 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
17435 is not set.
17436
17437 @cindex save command history
17438 @kindex set history save
17439 @item set history save
17440 @itemx set history save on
17441 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
17442 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
17443
17444 @item set history save off
17445 Stop recording command history in a file.
17446
17447 @cindex history size
17448 @kindex set history size
17449 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
17450 @item set history size @var{size}
17451 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
17452 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
17453 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
17454 @end table
17455
17456 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
17457 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
17458
17459 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
17460 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
17461 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
17462 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
17463 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
17464 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
17465 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
17466 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
17467
17468 The commands to control history expansion are:
17469
17470 @table @code
17471 @item set history expansion on
17472 @itemx set history expansion
17473 @kindex set history expansion
17474 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
17475
17476 @item set history expansion off
17477 Disable history expansion.
17478
17479 @c @group
17480 @kindex show history
17481 @item show history
17482 @itemx show history filename
17483 @itemx show history save
17484 @itemx show history size
17485 @itemx show history expansion
17486 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
17487 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
17488 @c @end group
17489 @end table
17490
17491 @table @code
17492 @kindex show commands
17493 @cindex show last commands
17494 @cindex display command history
17495 @item show commands
17496 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
17497
17498 @item show commands @var{n}
17499 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
17500
17501 @item show commands +
17502 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
17503 @end table
17504
17505 @node Screen Size
17506 @section Screen Size
17507 @cindex size of screen
17508 @cindex pauses in output
17509
17510 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
17511 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
17512 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
17513 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
17514 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
17515 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
17516 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
17517 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
17518
17519 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
17520 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
17521 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
17522 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
17523 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
17524 width} commands:
17525
17526 @table @code
17527 @kindex set height
17528 @kindex set width
17529 @kindex show width
17530 @kindex show height
17531 @item set height @var{lpp}
17532 @itemx show height
17533 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
17534 @itemx show width
17535 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
17536 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
17537 commands display the current settings.
17538
17539 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
17540 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
17541 file or to an editor buffer.
17542
17543 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
17544 from wrapping its output.
17545
17546 @item set pagination on
17547 @itemx set pagination off
17548 @kindex set pagination
17549 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
17550 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
17551
17552 @item show pagination
17553 @kindex show pagination
17554 Show the current pagination mode.
17555 @end table
17556
17557 @node Numbers
17558 @section Numbers
17559 @cindex number representation
17560 @cindex entering numbers
17561
17562 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
17563 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
17564 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
17565 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
17566 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
17567 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
17568 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
17569 both input and output with the commands described below.
17570
17571 @table @code
17572 @kindex set input-radix
17573 @item set input-radix @var{base}
17574 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
17575 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
17576 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
17577 example, any of
17578
17579 @smallexample
17580 set input-radix 012
17581 set input-radix 10.
17582 set input-radix 0xa
17583 @end smallexample
17584
17585 @noindent
17586 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
17587 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
17588 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
17589 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
17590 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
17591 change the radix.
17592
17593 @kindex set output-radix
17594 @item set output-radix @var{base}
17595 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
17596 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
17597 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
17598
17599 @kindex show input-radix
17600 @item show input-radix
17601 Display the current default base for numeric input.
17602
17603 @kindex show output-radix
17604 @item show output-radix
17605 Display the current default base for numeric display.
17606
17607 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
17608 @itemx show radix
17609 @kindex set radix
17610 @kindex show radix
17611 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
17612 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
17613 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
17614 default value of 10.
17615
17616 @end table
17617
17618 @node ABI
17619 @section Configuring the Current ABI
17620
17621 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
17622 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
17623 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
17624 current ABI.
17625
17626 @cindex OS ABI
17627 @kindex set osabi
17628 @kindex show osabi
17629
17630 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
17631 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
17632 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
17633 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
17634 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
17635 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
17636 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
17637 platform provides.
17638
17639 @table @code
17640 @item show osabi
17641 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
17642
17643 @item set osabi
17644 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
17645
17646 @item set osabi @var{abi}
17647 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
17648 @end table
17649
17650 @cindex float promotion
17651
17652 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
17653 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
17654 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
17655 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
17656 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
17657 @code{double} and then passed.
17658
17659 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
17660 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
17661 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
17662
17663 @table @code
17664 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
17665 @item set coerce-float-to-double
17666 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
17667 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
17668 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
17669
17670 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
17671 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
17672 functions.
17673
17674 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
17675 @item show coerce-float-to-double
17676 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
17677 @end table
17678
17679 @kindex set cp-abi
17680 @kindex show cp-abi
17681 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
17682 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
17683 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
17684 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
17685 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
17686 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
17687 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
17688 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
17689 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
17690 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
17691 ``auto''.
17692
17693 @table @code
17694 @item show cp-abi
17695 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
17696
17697 @item set cp-abi
17698 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
17699
17700 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
17701 @itemx set cp-abi auto
17702 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
17703 @end table
17704
17705 @node Messages/Warnings
17706 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
17707
17708 @cindex verbose operation
17709 @cindex optional warnings
17710 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
17711 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
17712 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
17713 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
17714
17715 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
17716 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
17717 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
17718
17719 @table @code
17720 @kindex set verbose
17721 @item set verbose on
17722 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
17723
17724 @item set verbose off
17725 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
17726
17727 @kindex show verbose
17728 @item show verbose
17729 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
17730 @end table
17731
17732 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
17733 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
17734 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
17735 Symbol Files}).
17736
17737 @table @code
17738
17739 @kindex set complaints
17740 @item set complaints @var{limit}
17741 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
17742 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
17743 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
17744 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
17745
17746 @kindex show complaints
17747 @item show complaints
17748 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
17749
17750 @end table
17751
17752 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
17753 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
17754 you try to run a program which is already running:
17755
17756 @smallexample
17757 (@value{GDBP}) run
17758 The program being debugged has been started already.
17759 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
17760 @end smallexample
17761
17762 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
17763 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
17764
17765 @table @code
17766
17767 @kindex set confirm
17768 @cindex flinching
17769 @cindex confirmation
17770 @cindex stupid questions
17771 @item set confirm off
17772 Disables confirmation requests.
17773
17774 @item set confirm on
17775 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
17776
17777 @kindex show confirm
17778 @item show confirm
17779 Displays state of confirmation requests.
17780
17781 @end table
17782
17783 @cindex command tracing
17784 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
17785 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
17786 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
17787 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
17788
17789 @table @code
17790 @kindex set trace-commands
17791 @cindex command scripts, debugging
17792 @item set trace-commands on
17793 Enable command tracing.
17794 @item set trace-commands off
17795 Disable command tracing.
17796 @item show trace-commands
17797 Display the current state of command tracing.
17798 @end table
17799
17800 @node Debugging Output
17801 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
17802 @cindex optional debugging messages
17803
17804 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
17805 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
17806 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
17807 section documents those commands.
17808
17809 @table @code
17810 @kindex set exec-done-display
17811 @item set exec-done-display
17812 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
17813 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
17814 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
17815 @kindex show exec-done-display
17816 @item show exec-done-display
17817 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
17818 notification.
17819 @kindex set debug
17820 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
17821 @cindex architecture debugging info
17822 @item set debug arch
17823 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
17824 @kindex show debug
17825 @item show debug arch
17826 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
17827 @item set debug aix-thread
17828 @cindex AIX threads
17829 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
17830 module.
17831 @item show debug aix-thread
17832 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
17833 @item set debug dwarf2-die
17834 @cindex DWARF2 DIEs
17835 Dump DWARF2 DIEs after they are read in.
17836 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
17837 A value of zero turns off the display.
17838 @item show debug dwarf2-die
17839 Show the current state of DWARF2 DIE debugging.
17840 @item set debug displaced
17841 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
17842 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
17843 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
17844 @item show debug displaced
17845 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
17846 related to displaced stepping.
17847 @item set debug event
17848 @cindex event debugging info
17849 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
17850 default is off.
17851 @item show debug event
17852 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
17853 info.
17854 @item set debug expression
17855 @cindex expression debugging info
17856 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
17857 expression parsing. The default is off.
17858 @item show debug expression
17859 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
17860 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
17861 @item set debug frame
17862 @cindex frame debugging info
17863 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
17864 default is off.
17865 @item show debug frame
17866 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
17867 info.
17868 @item set debug gnu-nat
17869 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
17870 Turns on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
17871 @item show debug gnu-nat
17872 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
17873 @item set debug infrun
17874 @cindex inferior debugging info
17875 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
17876 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
17877 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
17878 @item show debug infrun
17879 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
17880 @item set debug lin-lwp
17881 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
17882 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
17883 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
17884 @item show debug lin-lwp
17885 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
17886 @item set debug lin-lwp-async
17887 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP async debug messages
17888 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
17889 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP async debug support.
17890 @item show debug lin-lwp-async
17891 Show the current state of Linux LWP async debugging messages.
17892 @item set debug observer
17893 @cindex observer debugging info
17894 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
17895 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
17896 @item show debug observer
17897 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
17898 @item set debug overload
17899 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
17900 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
17901 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
17902 is off.
17903 @item show debug overload
17904 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
17905 debugging info.
17906 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
17907 @cindex serial connections, debugging
17908 @cindex debug remote protocol
17909 @cindex remote protocol debugging
17910 @cindex display remote packets
17911 @item set debug remote
17912 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
17913 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
17914 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
17915 @item show debug remote
17916 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
17917 @item set debug serial
17918 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
17919 default is off.
17920 @item show debug serial
17921 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
17922 info.
17923 @item set debug solib-frv
17924 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
17925 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
17926 @item show debug solib-frv
17927 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
17928 messages.
17929 @item set debug target
17930 @cindex target debugging info
17931 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
17932 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
17933 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
17934 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
17935 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
17936 @item show debug target
17937 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
17938 info.
17939 @item set debug timestamp
17940 @cindex timestampping debugging info
17941 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
17942 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
17943 message.
17944 @item show debug timestamp
17945 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
17946 debugging info.
17947 @item set debugvarobj
17948 @cindex variable object debugging info
17949 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
17950 info. The default is off.
17951 @item show debugvarobj
17952 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
17953 debugging info.
17954 @item set debug xml
17955 @cindex XML parser debugging
17956 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
17957 @item show debug xml
17958 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
17959 @end table
17960
17961 @node Extending GDB
17962 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
17963 @cindex extending GDB
17964
17965 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for extension. The first is based
17966 on composition of @value{GDBN} commands, and the second is based on the
17967 Python scripting language.
17968
17969 @menu
17970 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of Commands
17971 * Python:: Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
17972 @end menu
17973
17974 @node Sequences
17975 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
17976
17977 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
17978 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
17979 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
17980 files.
17981
17982 @menu
17983 * Define:: How to define your own commands
17984 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
17985 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
17986 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
17987 @end menu
17988
17989 @node Define
17990 @subsection User-defined Commands
17991
17992 @cindex user-defined command
17993 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
17994 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
17995 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
17996 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
17997 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
17998 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
17999
18000 @smallexample
18001 define adder
18002 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
18003 end
18004 @end smallexample
18005
18006 @noindent
18007 To execute the command use:
18008
18009 @smallexample
18010 adder 1 2 3
18011 @end smallexample
18012
18013 @noindent
18014 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
18015 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
18016 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
18017 functions calls.
18018
18019 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
18020 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
18021 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
18022 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
18023
18024 @smallexample
18025 define adder
18026 if $argc == 2
18027 print $arg0 + $arg1
18028 end
18029 if $argc == 3
18030 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
18031 end
18032 end
18033 @end smallexample
18034
18035 @table @code
18036
18037 @kindex define
18038 @item define @var{commandname}
18039 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
18040 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
18041 @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
18042 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
18043 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
18044 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
18045
18046 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
18047 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
18048 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
18049
18050 @kindex document
18051 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
18052 @item document @var{commandname}
18053 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
18054 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
18055 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
18056 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
18057 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
18058 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
18059
18060 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
18061 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
18062 does not change the documentation.
18063
18064 @kindex dont-repeat
18065 @cindex don't repeat command
18066 @item dont-repeat
18067 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
18068 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
18069 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
18070
18071 @kindex help user-defined
18072 @item help user-defined
18073 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
18074 (if any) for each.
18075
18076 @kindex show user
18077 @item show user
18078 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
18079 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
18080 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
18081 definitions for all user-defined commands.
18082
18083 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
18084 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
18085 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
18086 @item show max-user-call-depth
18087 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
18088 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
18089 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
18090 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
18091 @end table
18092
18093 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
18094 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
18095
18096 When user-defined commands are executed, the
18097 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
18098 stops execution of the user-defined command.
18099
18100 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
18101 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
18102 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
18103 messages when used in a user-defined command.
18104
18105 @node Hooks
18106 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
18107 @cindex command hooks
18108 @cindex hooks, for commands
18109 @cindex hooks, pre-command
18110
18111 @kindex hook
18112 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
18113 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
18114 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
18115 before that command.
18116
18117 @cindex hooks, post-command
18118 @kindex hookpost
18119 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
18120 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
18121 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
18122 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
18123 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
18124
18125 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
18126 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
18127
18128 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
18129 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
18130
18131 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
18132 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
18133 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
18134 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
18135 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
18136
18137 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
18138 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
18139 you could define:
18140
18141 @smallexample
18142 define hook-stop
18143 handle SIGALRM nopass
18144 end
18145
18146 define hook-run
18147 handle SIGALRM pass
18148 end
18149
18150 define hook-continue
18151 handle SIGALRM pass
18152 end
18153 @end smallexample
18154
18155 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
18156 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
18157 you could define:
18158
18159 @smallexample
18160 define hook-echo
18161 echo <<<---
18162 end
18163
18164 define hookpost-echo
18165 echo --->>>\n
18166 end
18167
18168 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
18169 <<<---Hello World--->>>
18170 (@value{GDBP})
18171
18172 @end smallexample
18173
18174 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
18175 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
18176 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
18177 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
18178 @c or not?
18179 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
18180 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
18181 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
18182
18183 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
18184 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
18185 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
18186
18187 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
18188 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
18189
18190 @node Command Files
18191 @subsection Command Files
18192
18193 @cindex command files
18194 @cindex scripting commands
18195 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
18196 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
18197 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
18198 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
18199 terminal.
18200
18201 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
18202 command:
18203
18204 @table @code
18205 @kindex source
18206 @cindex execute commands from a file
18207 @item source [@code{-v}] @var{filename}
18208 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
18209 @end table
18210
18211 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
18212 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
18213 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
18214 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
18215 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
18216
18217 @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} in the current directory and then
18218 on the search path (specified with the @samp{directory} command).
18219
18220 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
18221 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
18222 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
18223
18224 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
18225 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
18226 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
18227 when called from command files.
18228
18229 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
18230 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
18231 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
18232 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
18233 the next command.
18234
18235 @smallexample
18236 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
18237 @end smallexample
18238
18239 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
18240 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
18241 would be directed to @file{log}.
18242
18243 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
18244 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
18245 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
18246 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
18247 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
18248 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
18249 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
18250 conditionally, etc.
18251
18252 @table @code
18253 @kindex if
18254 @kindex else
18255 @item if
18256 @itemx else
18257 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
18258 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
18259 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
18260 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
18261 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
18262 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
18263 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
18264
18265 @kindex while
18266 @item while
18267 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
18268 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
18269 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
18270 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
18271 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
18272 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
18273
18274 @kindex loop_break
18275 @item loop_break
18276 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
18277 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
18278 line.
18279
18280 @kindex loop_continue
18281 @item loop_continue
18282 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
18283 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
18284 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
18285 the controlling expression.
18286
18287 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
18288 @item end
18289 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
18290 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
18291 @end table
18292
18293
18294 @node Output
18295 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
18296
18297 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
18298 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
18299 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
18300 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
18301 want.
18302
18303 @table @code
18304 @kindex echo
18305 @item echo @var{text}
18306 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
18307 @c because it is not in ANSI.
18308 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
18309 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
18310 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
18311 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
18312 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
18313 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
18314 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
18315 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
18316 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
18317
18318 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
18319 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
18320
18321 @smallexample
18322 echo This is some text\n\
18323 which is continued\n\
18324 onto several lines.\n
18325 @end smallexample
18326
18327 produces the same output as
18328
18329 @smallexample
18330 echo This is some text\n
18331 echo which is continued\n
18332 echo onto several lines.\n
18333 @end smallexample
18334
18335 @kindex output
18336 @item output @var{expression}
18337 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
18338 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
18339 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
18340 on expressions.
18341
18342 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
18343 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
18344 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
18345 Formats}, for more information.
18346
18347 @kindex printf
18348 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
18349 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
18350 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
18351 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
18352 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
18353 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
18354 executing the code below:
18355
18356 @smallexample
18357 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
18358 @end smallexample
18359
18360 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
18361 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
18362 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
18363 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
18364 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
18365 printed.
18366
18367 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
18368
18369 @smallexample
18370 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
18371 @end smallexample
18372
18373 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
18374 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
18375 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
18376
18377 @itemize @bullet
18378 @item
18379 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
18380
18381 @item
18382 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
18383 width.
18384
18385 @item
18386 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
18387 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
18388
18389 @item
18390 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
18391 supported.
18392
18393 @item
18394 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
18395
18396 @item
18397 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
18398 @end itemize
18399
18400 @noindent
18401 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
18402 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
18403 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
18404 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
18405
18406 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
18407 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
18408 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
18409 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
18410 supported.
18411
18412 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
18413 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
18414 together with a floating point specifier.
18415 letters:
18416
18417 @itemize @bullet
18418 @item
18419 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
18420
18421 @item
18422 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
18423
18424 @item
18425 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
18426 @end itemize
18427
18428 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
18429 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
18430 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
18431
18432 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
18433 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
18434
18435 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
18436 @smallexample
18437 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
18438 @end smallexample
18439
18440 @end table
18441
18442 @node Python
18443 @section Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
18444 @cindex python scripting
18445 @cindex scripting with python
18446
18447 You can script @value{GDBN} using the @uref{http://www.python.org/,
18448 Python programming language}. This feature is available only if
18449 @value{GDBN} was configured using @option{--with-python}.
18450
18451 @menu
18452 * Python Commands:: Accessing Python from @value{GDBN}.
18453 * Python API:: Accessing @value{GDBN} from Python.
18454 @end menu
18455
18456 @node Python Commands
18457 @subsection Python Commands
18458 @cindex python commands
18459 @cindex commands to access python
18460
18461 @value{GDBN} provides one command for accessing the Python interpreter,
18462 and one related setting:
18463
18464 @table @code
18465 @kindex python
18466 @item python @r{[}@var{code}@r{]}
18467 The @code{python} command can be used to evaluate Python code.
18468
18469 If given an argument, the @code{python} command will evaluate the
18470 argument as a Python command. For example:
18471
18472 @smallexample
18473 (@value{GDBP}) python print 23
18474 23
18475 @end smallexample
18476
18477 If you do not provide an argument to @code{python}, it will act as a
18478 multi-line command, like @code{define}. In this case, the Python
18479 script is made up of subsequent command lines, given after the
18480 @code{python} command. This command list is terminated using a line
18481 containing @code{end}. For example:
18482
18483 @smallexample
18484 (@value{GDBP}) python
18485 Type python script
18486 End with a line saying just "end".
18487 >print 23
18488 >end
18489 23
18490 @end smallexample
18491
18492 @kindex maint set python print-stack
18493 @item maint set python print-stack
18494 By default, @value{GDBN} will print a stack trace when an error occurs
18495 in a Python script. This can be controlled using @code{maint set
18496 python print-stack}: if @code{on}, the default, then Python stack
18497 printing is enabled; if @code{off}, then Python stack printing is
18498 disabled.
18499 @end table
18500
18501 @node Python API
18502 @subsection Python API
18503 @cindex python api
18504 @cindex programming in python
18505
18506 @cindex python stdout
18507 @cindex python pagination
18508 At startup, @value{GDBN} overrides Python's @code{sys.stdout} and
18509 @code{sys.stderr} to print using @value{GDBN}'s output-paging streams.
18510 A Python program which outputs to one of these streams may have its
18511 output interrupted by the user (@pxref{Screen Size}). In this
18512 situation, a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt} exception is thrown.
18513
18514 @menu
18515 * Basic Python:: Basic Python Functions.
18516 * Exception Handling::
18517 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading Python code.
18518 * Values From Inferior::
18519 * Commands In Python:: Implementing new commands in Python.
18520 * Functions In Python:: Writing new convenience functions.
18521 * Objfiles In Python:: Object files.
18522 * Frames In Python:: Acessing inferior stack frames from Python.
18523 @end menu
18524
18525 @node Basic Python
18526 @subsubsection Basic Python
18527
18528 @cindex python functions
18529 @cindex python module
18530 @cindex gdb module
18531 @value{GDBN} introduces a new Python module, named @code{gdb}. All
18532 methods and classes added by @value{GDBN} are placed in this module.
18533 @value{GDBN} automatically @code{import}s the @code{gdb} module for
18534 use in all scripts evaluated by the @code{python} command.
18535
18536 @findex gdb.execute
18537 @defun execute command [from_tty]
18538 Evaluate @var{command}, a string, as a @value{GDBN} CLI command.
18539 If a GDB exception happens while @var{command} runs, it is
18540 translated as described in @ref{Exception Handling,,Exception Handling}.
18541 If no exceptions occur, this function returns @code{None}.
18542
18543 @var{from_tty} specifies whether @value{GDBN} ought to consider this
18544 command as having originated from the user invoking it interactively.
18545 It must be a boolean value. If omitted, it defaults to @code{False}.
18546 @end defun
18547
18548 @findex gdb.get_parameter
18549 @defun get_parameter parameter
18550 Return the value of a @value{GDBN} parameter. @var{parameter} is a
18551 string naming the parameter to look up; @var{parameter} may contain
18552 spaces if the parameter has a multi-part name. For example,
18553 @samp{print object} is a valid parameter name.
18554
18555 If the named parameter does not exist, this function throws a
18556 @code{RuntimeError}. Otherwise, the parameter's value is converted to
18557 a Python value of the appropriate type, and returned.
18558 @end defun
18559
18560 @findex gdb.history
18561 @defun history number
18562 Return a value from @value{GDBN}'s value history (@pxref{Value
18563 History}). @var{number} indicates which history element to return.
18564 If @var{number} is negative, then @value{GDBN} will take its absolute value
18565 and count backward from the last element (i.e., the most recent element) to
18566 find the value to return. If @var{number} is zero, then @value{GDBN} will
18567 return the most recent element. If the element specified by @var{number}
18568 doesn't exist in the value history, a @code{RuntimeError} exception will be
18569 raised.
18570
18571 If no exception is raised, the return value is always an instance of
18572 @code{gdb.Value} (@pxref{Values From Inferior}).
18573 @end defun
18574
18575 @findex gdb.write
18576 @defun write string
18577 Print a string to @value{GDBN}'s paginated standard output stream.
18578 Writing to @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically
18579 call this function.
18580 @end defun
18581
18582 @findex gdb.flush
18583 @defun flush
18584 Flush @value{GDBN}'s paginated standard output stream. Flushing
18585 @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically call this
18586 function.
18587 @end defun
18588
18589 @node Exception Handling
18590 @subsubsection Exception Handling
18591 @cindex python exceptions
18592 @cindex exceptions, python
18593
18594 When executing the @code{python} command, Python exceptions
18595 uncaught within the Python code are translated to calls to
18596 @value{GDBN} error-reporting mechanism. If the command that called
18597 @code{python} does not handle the error, @value{GDBN} will
18598 terminate it and print an error message containing the Python
18599 exception name, the associated value, and the Python call stack
18600 backtrace at the point where the exception was raised. Example:
18601
18602 @smallexample
18603 (@value{GDBP}) python print foo
18604 Traceback (most recent call last):
18605 File "<string>", line 1, in <module>
18606 NameError: name 'foo' is not defined
18607 @end smallexample
18608
18609 @value{GDBN} errors that happen in @value{GDBN} commands invoked by Python
18610 code are converted to Python @code{RuntimeError} exceptions. User
18611 interrupt (via @kbd{C-c} or by typing @kbd{q} at a pagination
18612 prompt) is translated to a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt}
18613 exception. If you catch these exceptions in your Python code, your
18614 exception handler will see @code{RuntimeError} or
18615 @code{KeyboardInterrupt} as the exception type, the @value{GDBN} error
18616 message as its value, and the Python call stack backtrace at the
18617 Python statement closest to where the @value{GDBN} error occured as the
18618 traceback.
18619
18620 @node Auto-loading
18621 @subsubsection Auto-loading
18622 @cindex auto-loading, Python
18623
18624 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
18625 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
18626 @value{GDBN} will look for a file named @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py},
18627 where @var{objfile} is the object file's real name, formed by ensuring
18628 that the file name is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving
18629 @code{.} and @code{..} components. If this file exists and is
18630 readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a Python script.
18631
18632 If this file does not exist, and if the parameter
18633 @code{debug-file-directory} is set (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}),
18634 then @value{GDBN} will use the file named
18635 @file{@var{debug-file-directory}/@var{real-name}}, where
18636 @var{real-name} is the object file's real name, as described above.
18637
18638 Finally, if this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
18639 a file named @file{@var{data-directory}/python/auto-load/@var{real-name}}, where
18640 @var{data-directory} is @value{GDBN}'s data directory (available via
18641 @code{show data-directory}, @pxref{Data Files}), and @var{real-name}
18642 is the object file's real name, as described above.
18643
18644 When reading an auto-loaded file, @value{GDBN} sets the ``current
18645 objfile''. This is available via the @code{gdb.current_objfile}
18646 function (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}). This can be useful for
18647 registering objfile-specific pretty-printers.
18648
18649 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
18650 debugging commands and scripts. You can enable or disable this
18651 feature, and view its current state.
18652
18653 @table @code
18654 @kindex maint set python auto-load
18655 @item maint set python auto-load [yes|no]
18656 Enable or disable the Python auto-loading feature.
18657
18658 @kindex show python auto-load
18659 @item show python auto-load
18660 Show whether Python auto-loading is enabled or disabled.
18661 @end table
18662
18663 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded.
18664 So, your @samp{-gdb.py} file should take care to ensure that it may be
18665 evaluated multiple times without error.
18666
18667 @node Values From Inferior
18668 @subsubsection Values From Inferior
18669 @cindex values from inferior, with Python
18670 @cindex python, working with values from inferior
18671
18672 @cindex @code{gdb.Value}
18673 @value{GDBN} provides values it obtains from the inferior program in
18674 an object of type @code{gdb.Value}. @value{GDBN} uses this object
18675 for its internal bookkeeping of the inferior's values, and for
18676 fetching values when necessary.
18677
18678 Inferior values that are simple scalars can be used directly in
18679 Python expressions that are valid for the value's data type. Here's
18680 an example for an integer or floating-point value @code{some_val}:
18681
18682 @smallexample
18683 bar = some_val + 2
18684 @end smallexample
18685
18686 @noindent
18687 As result of this, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object
18688 whose values are of the same type as those of @code{some_val}.
18689
18690 Inferior values that are structures or instances of some class can
18691 be accessed using the Python @dfn{dictionary syntax}. For example, if
18692 @code{some_val} is a @code{gdb.Value} instance holding a structure, you
18693 can access its @code{foo} element with:
18694
18695 @smallexample
18696 bar = some_val['foo']
18697 @end smallexample
18698
18699 Again, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object.
18700
18701 The following attributes are provided:
18702
18703 @table @code
18704 @defmethod Value address
18705 If this object is addressable, this read-only attribute holds a
18706 @code{gdb.Value} object representing the address. Otherwise,
18707 this attribute holds @code{None}.
18708 @end defmethod
18709
18710 @cindex optimized out value in Python
18711 @defmethod Value is_optimized_out
18712 This read-only boolean attribute is true if the compiler optimized out
18713 this value, thus it is not available for fetching from the inferior.
18714 @end defmethod
18715 @end table
18716
18717 The following methods are provided:
18718
18719 @table @code
18720 @defmethod Value dereference
18721 For pointer data types, this method returns a new @code{gdb.Value} object
18722 whose contents is the object pointed to by the pointer. For example, if
18723 @code{foo} is a C pointer to an @code{int}, declared in your C program as
18724
18725 @smallexample
18726 int *foo;
18727 @end smallexample
18728
18729 @noindent
18730 then you can use the corresponding @code{gdb.Value} to access what
18731 @code{foo} points to like this:
18732
18733 @smallexample
18734 bar = foo.dereference ()
18735 @end smallexample
18736
18737 The result @code{bar} will be a @code{gdb.Value} object holding the
18738 value pointed to by @code{foo}.
18739 @end defmethod
18740
18741 @defmethod Value string @r{[}encoding@r{]} @r{[}errors@r{]}
18742 If this @code{gdb.Value} represents a string, then this method
18743 converts the contents to a Python string. Otherwise, this method will
18744 throw an exception.
18745
18746 Strings are recognized in a language-specific way; whether a given
18747 @code{gdb.Value} represents a string is determined by the current
18748 language.
18749
18750 For C-like languages, a value is a string if it is a pointer to or an
18751 array of characters or ints. The string is assumed to be terminated
18752 by a zero of the appropriate width.
18753
18754 If the optional @var{encoding} argument is given, it must be a string
18755 naming the encoding of the string in the @code{gdb.Value}, such as
18756 @code{"ascii"}, @code{"iso-8859-6"} or @code{"utf-8"}. It accepts
18757 the same encodings as the corresponding argument to Python's
18758 @code{string.decode} method, and the Python codec machinery will be used
18759 to convert the string. If @var{encoding} is not given, or if
18760 @var{encoding} is the empty string, then either the @code{target-charset}
18761 (@pxref{Character Sets}) will be used, or a language-specific encoding
18762 will be used, if the current language is able to supply one.
18763
18764 The optional @var{errors} argument is the same as the corresponding
18765 argument to Python's @code{string.decode} method.
18766 @end defmethod
18767 @end table
18768
18769 @node Commands In Python
18770 @subsubsection Commands In Python
18771
18772 @cindex commands in python
18773 @cindex python commands
18774 You can implement new @value{GDBN} CLI commands in Python. A CLI
18775 command is implemented using an instance of the @code{gdb.Command}
18776 class, most commonly using a subclass.
18777
18778 @defmethod Command __init__ name @var{command_class} @r{[}@var{completer_class}@r{]} @r{[}@var{prefix}@r{]}
18779 The object initializer for @code{Command} registers the new command
18780 with @value{GDBN}. This initializer is normally invoked from the
18781 subclass' own @code{__init__} method.
18782
18783 @var{name} is the name of the command. If @var{name} consists of
18784 multiple words, then the initial words are looked for as prefix
18785 commands. In this case, if one of the prefix commands does not exist,
18786 an exception is raised.
18787
18788 There is no support for multi-line commands.
18789
18790 @var{command_class} should be one of the @samp{COMMAND_} constants
18791 defined below. This argument tells @value{GDBN} how to categorize the
18792 new command in the help system.
18793
18794 @var{completer_class} is an optional argument. If given, it should be
18795 one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined below. This argument
18796 tells @value{GDBN} how to perform completion for this command. If not
18797 given, @value{GDBN} will attempt to complete using the object's
18798 @code{complete} method (see below); if no such method is found, an
18799 error will occur when completion is attempted.
18800
18801 @var{prefix} is an optional argument. If @code{True}, then the new
18802 command is a prefix command; sub-commands of this command may be
18803 registered.
18804
18805 The help text for the new command is taken from the Python
18806 documentation string for the command's class, if there is one. If no
18807 documentation string is provided, the default value ``This command is
18808 not documented.'' is used.
18809 @end defmethod
18810
18811 @cindex don't repeat Python command
18812 @defmethod Command dont_repeat
18813 By default, a @value{GDBN} command is repeated when the user enters a
18814 blank line at the command prompt. A command can suppress this
18815 behavior by invoking the @code{dont_repeat} method. This is similar
18816 to the user command @code{dont-repeat}, see @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
18817 @end defmethod
18818
18819 @defmethod Command invoke argument from_tty
18820 This method is called by @value{GDBN} when this command is invoked.
18821
18822 @var{argument} is a string. It is the argument to the command, after
18823 leading and trailing whitespace has been stripped.
18824
18825 @var{from_tty} is a boolean argument. When true, this means that the
18826 command was entered by the user at the terminal; when false it means
18827 that the command came from elsewhere.
18828
18829 If this method throws an exception, it is turned into a @value{GDBN}
18830 @code{error} call. Otherwise, the return value is ignored.
18831 @end defmethod
18832
18833 @cindex completion of Python commands
18834 @defmethod Command complete text word
18835 This method is called by @value{GDBN} when the user attempts
18836 completion on this command. All forms of completion are handled by
18837 this method, that is, the @key{TAB} and @key{M-?} key bindings
18838 (@pxref{Completion}), and the @code{complete} command (@pxref{Help,
18839 complete}).
18840
18841 The arguments @var{text} and @var{word} are both strings. @var{text}
18842 holds the complete command line up to the cursor's location.
18843 @var{word} holds the last word of the command line; this is computed
18844 using a word-breaking heuristic.
18845
18846 The @code{complete} method can return several values:
18847 @itemize @bullet
18848 @item
18849 If the return value is a sequence, the contents of the sequence are
18850 used as the completions. It is up to @code{complete} to ensure that the
18851 contents actually do complete the word. A zero-length sequence is
18852 allowed, it means that there were no completions available. Only
18853 string elements of the sequence are used; other elements in the
18854 sequence are ignored.
18855
18856 @item
18857 If the return value is one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined
18858 below, then the corresponding @value{GDBN}-internal completion
18859 function is invoked, and its result is used.
18860
18861 @item
18862 All other results are treated as though there were no available
18863 completions.
18864 @end itemize
18865 @end defmethod
18866
18867 When a new command is registered, it must be declared as a member of
18868 some general class of commands. This is used to classify top-level
18869 commands in the on-line help system; note that prefix commands are not
18870 listed under their own category but rather that of their top-level
18871 command. The available classifications are represented by constants
18872 defined in the @code{gdb} module:
18873
18874 @table @code
18875 @findex COMMAND_NONE
18876 @findex gdb.COMMAND_NONE
18877 @item COMMAND_NONE
18878 The command does not belong to any particular class. A command in
18879 this category will not be displayed in any of the help categories.
18880
18881 @findex COMMAND_RUNNING
18882 @findex gdb.COMMAND_RUNNING
18883 @item COMMAND_RUNNING
18884 The command is related to running the inferior. For example,
18885 @code{start}, @code{step}, and @code{continue} are in this category.
18886 Type @kbd{help running} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
18887 commands in this category.
18888
18889 @findex COMMAND_DATA
18890 @findex gdb.COMMAND_DATA
18891 @item COMMAND_DATA
18892 The command is related to data or variables. For example,
18893 @code{call}, @code{find}, and @code{print} are in this category. Type
18894 @kbd{help data} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands
18895 in this category.
18896
18897 @findex COMMAND_STACK
18898 @findex gdb.COMMAND_STACK
18899 @item COMMAND_STACK
18900 The command has to do with manipulation of the stack. For example,
18901 @code{backtrace}, @code{frame}, and @code{return} are in this
18902 category. Type @kbd{help stack} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a
18903 list of commands in this category.
18904
18905 @findex COMMAND_FILES
18906 @findex gdb.COMMAND_FILES
18907 @item COMMAND_FILES
18908 This class is used for file-related commands. For example,
18909 @code{file}, @code{list} and @code{section} are in this category.
18910 Type @kbd{help files} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
18911 commands in this category.
18912
18913 @findex COMMAND_SUPPORT
18914 @findex gdb.COMMAND_SUPPORT
18915 @item COMMAND_SUPPORT
18916 This should be used for ``support facilities'', generally meaning
18917 things that are useful to the user when interacting with @value{GDBN},
18918 but not related to the state of the inferior. For example,
18919 @code{help}, @code{make}, and @code{shell} are in this category. Type
18920 @kbd{help support} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
18921 commands in this category.
18922
18923 @findex COMMAND_STATUS
18924 @findex gdb.COMMAND_STATUS
18925 @item COMMAND_STATUS
18926 The command is an @samp{info}-related command, that is, related to the
18927 state of @value{GDBN} itself. For example, @code{info}, @code{macro},
18928 and @code{show} are in this category. Type @kbd{help status} at the
18929 @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this category.
18930
18931 @findex COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
18932 @findex gdb.COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
18933 @item COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
18934 The command has to do with breakpoints. For example, @code{break},
18935 @code{clear}, and @code{delete} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
18936 breakpoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in
18937 this category.
18938
18939 @findex COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
18940 @findex gdb.COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
18941 @item COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
18942 The command has to do with tracepoints. For example, @code{trace},
18943 @code{actions}, and @code{tfind} are in this category. Type
18944 @kbd{help tracepoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
18945 commands in this category.
18946
18947 @findex COMMAND_OBSCURE
18948 @findex gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE
18949 @item COMMAND_OBSCURE
18950 The command is only used in unusual circumstances, or is not of
18951 general interest to users. For example, @code{checkpoint},
18952 @code{fork}, and @code{stop} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
18953 obscure} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this
18954 category.
18955
18956 @findex COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
18957 @findex gdb.COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
18958 @item COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
18959 The command is only useful to @value{GDBN} maintainers. The
18960 @code{maintenance} and @code{flushregs} commands are in this category.
18961 Type @kbd{help internals} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
18962 commands in this category.
18963 @end table
18964
18965 A new command can use a predefined completion function, either by
18966 specifying it via an argument at initialization, or by returning it
18967 from the @code{complete} method. These predefined completion
18968 constants are all defined in the @code{gdb} module:
18969
18970 @table @code
18971 @findex COMPLETE_NONE
18972 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_NONE
18973 @item COMPLETE_NONE
18974 This constant means that no completion should be done.
18975
18976 @findex COMPLETE_FILENAME
18977 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_FILENAME
18978 @item COMPLETE_FILENAME
18979 This constant means that filename completion should be performed.
18980
18981 @findex COMPLETE_LOCATION
18982 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_LOCATION
18983 @item COMPLETE_LOCATION
18984 This constant means that location completion should be done.
18985 @xref{Specify Location}.
18986
18987 @findex COMPLETE_COMMAND
18988 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_COMMAND
18989 @item COMPLETE_COMMAND
18990 This constant means that completion should examine @value{GDBN}
18991 command names.
18992
18993 @findex COMPLETE_SYMBOL
18994 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_SYMBOL
18995 @item COMPLETE_SYMBOL
18996 This constant means that completion should be done using symbol names
18997 as the source.
18998 @end table
18999
19000 The following code snippet shows how a trivial CLI command can be
19001 implemented in Python:
19002
19003 @smallexample
19004 class HelloWorld (gdb.Command):
19005 """Greet the whole world."""
19006
19007 def __init__ (self):
19008 super (HelloWorld, self).__init__ ("hello-world", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)
19009
19010 def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):
19011 print "Hello, World!"
19012
19013 HelloWorld ()
19014 @end smallexample
19015
19016 The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the
19017 registration of the command with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the
19018 Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the
19019 @code{gdb} module explicitly.
19020
19021 @node Functions In Python
19022 @subsubsection Writing new convenience functions
19023
19024 @cindex writing convenience functions
19025 @cindex convenience functions in python
19026 @cindex python convenience functions
19027 @tindex gdb.Function
19028 @tindex Function
19029 You can implement new convenience functions (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
19030 in Python. A convenience function is an instance of a subclass of the
19031 class @code{gdb.Function}.
19032
19033 @defmethod Function __init__ name
19034 The initializer for @code{Function} registers the new function with
19035 @value{GDBN}. The argument @var{name} is the name of the function,
19036 a string. The function will be visible to the user as a convenience
19037 variable of type @code{internal function}, whose name is the same as
19038 the given @var{name}.
19039
19040 The documentation for the new function is taken from the documentation
19041 string for the new class.
19042 @end defmethod
19043
19044 @defmethod Function invoke @var{*args}
19045 When a convenience function is evaluated, its arguments are converted
19046 to instances of @code{gdb.Value}, and then the function's
19047 @code{invoke} method is called. Note that @value{GDBN} does not
19048 predetermine the arity of convenience functions. Instead, all
19049 available arguments are passed to @code{invoke}, following the
19050 standard Python calling convention. In particular, a convenience
19051 function can have default values for parameters without ill effect.
19052
19053 The return value of this method is used as its value in the enclosing
19054 expression. If an ordinary Python value is returned, it is converted
19055 to a @code{gdb.Value} following the usual rules.
19056 @end defmethod
19057
19058 The following code snippet shows how a trivial convenience function can
19059 be implemented in Python:
19060
19061 @smallexample
19062 class Greet (gdb.Function):
19063 """Return string to greet someone.
19064 Takes a name as argument."""
19065
19066 def __init__ (self):
19067 super (Greet, self).__init__ ("greet")
19068
19069 def invoke (self, name):
19070 return "Hello, %s!" % name.string ()
19071
19072 Greet ()
19073 @end smallexample
19074
19075 The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the
19076 registration of the function with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the
19077 Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the
19078 @code{gdb} module explicitly.
19079
19080 @node Objfiles In Python
19081 @subsubsection Objfiles In Python
19082
19083 @cindex objfiles in python
19084 @tindex gdb.Objfile
19085 @tindex Objfile
19086 @value{GDBN} loads symbols for an inferior from various
19087 symbol-containing files (@pxref{Files}). These include the primary
19088 executable file, any shared libraries used by the inferior, and any
19089 separate debug info files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}).
19090 @value{GDBN} calls these symbol-containing files @dfn{objfiles}.
19091
19092 The following objfile-related functions are available in the
19093 @code{gdb} module:
19094
19095 @findex gdb.current_objfile
19096 @defun current_objfile
19097 When auto-loading a Python script (@pxref{Auto-loading}), @value{GDBN}
19098 sets the ``current objfile'' to the corresponding objfile. This
19099 function returns the current objfile. If there is no current objfile,
19100 this function returns @code{None}.
19101 @end defun
19102
19103 @findex gdb.objfiles
19104 @defun objfiles
19105 Return a sequence of all the objfiles current known to @value{GDBN}.
19106 @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
19107 @end defun
19108
19109 Each objfile is represented by an instance of the @code{gdb.Objfile}
19110 class.
19111
19112 @defivar Objfile filename
19113 The file name of the objfile as a string.
19114 @end defivar
19115
19116 @defivar Objfile pretty_printers
19117 The @code{pretty_printers} attribute is a list of functions. It is
19118 used to look up pretty-printers. A @code{Value} is passed to each
19119 function in order; if the function returns @code{None}, then the
19120 search continues. Otherwise, the return value should be an object
19121 which is used to format the value.
19122 @end defivar
19123
19124 @node Frames In Python
19125 @subsubsection Acessing inferior stack frames from Python.
19126
19127 @cindex frames in python
19128 When the debugged program stops, @value{GDBN} is able to analyze its call
19129 stack (@pxref{Frames,,Stack frames}). The @code{gdb.Frame} class
19130 represents a frame in the stack. A @code{gdb.Frame} object is only valid
19131 while its corresponding frame exists in the inferior's stack. If you try
19132 to use an invalid frame object, @value{GDBN} will throw a @code{RuntimeError}
19133 exception.
19134
19135 Two @code{gdb.Frame} objects can be compared for equality with the @code{==}
19136 operator, like:
19137
19138 @smallexample
19139 (@value{GDBP}) python print gdb.newest_frame() == gdb.selected_frame ()
19140 True
19141 @end smallexample
19142
19143 The following frame-related functions are available in the @code{gdb} module:
19144
19145 @findex gdb.selected_frame
19146 @defun selected_frame
19147 Return the selected frame object. (@pxref{Selection,,Selecting a Frame}).
19148 @end defun
19149
19150 @defun frame_stop_reason_string reason
19151 Return a string explaining the reason why @value{GDBN} stopped unwinding
19152 frames, as expressed by the given @var{reason} code (an integer, see the
19153 @code{unwind_stop_reason} method further down in this section).
19154 @end defun
19155
19156 A @code{gdb.Frame} object has the following methods:
19157
19158 @table @code
19159 @defmethod Frame is_valid
19160 Returns true if the @code{gdb.Frame} object is valid, false if not.
19161 A frame object can become invalid if the frame it refers to doesn't
19162 exist anymore in the inferior. All @code{gdb.Frame} methods will throw
19163 an exception if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
19164 @end defmethod
19165
19166 @defmethod Frame name
19167 Returns the function name of the frame, or @code{None} if it can't be
19168 obtained.
19169 @end defmethod
19170
19171 @defmethod Frame type
19172 Returns the type of the frame. The value can be one of
19173 @code{gdb.NORMAL_FRAME}, @code{gdb.DUMMY_FRAME}, @code{gdb.SIGTRAMP_FRAME}
19174 or @code{gdb.SENTINEL_FRAME}.
19175 @end defmethod
19176
19177 @defmethod Frame unwind_stop_reason
19178 Return an integer representing the reason why it's not possible to find
19179 more frames toward the outermost frame. Use
19180 @code{gdb.frame_stop_reason_string} to convert the value returned by this
19181 function to a string.
19182 @end defmethod
19183
19184 @defmethod Frame pc
19185 Returns the frame's resume address.
19186 @end defmethod
19187
19188 @defmethod Frame older
19189 Return the frame that called this frame.
19190 @end defmethod
19191
19192 @defmethod Frame newer
19193 Return the frame called by this frame.
19194 @end defmethod
19195
19196 @defmethod Frame read_var variable
19197 Return the value of the given variable in this frame. @var{variable} must
19198 be a string.
19199 @end defmethod
19200 @end table
19201
19202 @node Interpreters
19203 @chapter Command Interpreters
19204 @cindex command interpreters
19205
19206 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
19207 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
19208 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
19209
19210 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
19211 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
19212 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
19213 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
19214
19215 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
19216 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
19217 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
19218 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
19219
19220 @table @code
19221 @item console
19222 @cindex console interpreter
19223 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
19224 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
19225 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
19226
19227 @item mi
19228 @cindex mi interpreter
19229 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
19230 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
19231 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
19232 Interface}.
19233
19234 @item mi2
19235 @cindex mi2 interpreter
19236 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
19237
19238 @item mi1
19239 @cindex mi1 interpreter
19240 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
19241
19242 @end table
19243
19244 @cindex invoke another interpreter
19245 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
19246 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
19247 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
19248 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
19249 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
19250 the IDE inoperable!
19251
19252 @kindex interpreter-exec
19253 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
19254 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
19255 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
19256 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
19257
19258 @smallexample
19259 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
19260 @end smallexample
19261
19262 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
19263 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
19264
19265 @node TUI
19266 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
19267 @cindex TUI
19268 @cindex Text User Interface
19269
19270 @menu
19271 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
19272 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
19273 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
19274 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
19275 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
19276 @end menu
19277
19278 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
19279 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
19280 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
19281 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
19282 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
19283 is available.
19284
19285 @pindex @value{GDBTUI}
19286 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
19287 either @samp{@value{GDBTUI}} or @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
19288 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
19289 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
19290 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
19291
19292 @node TUI Overview
19293 @section TUI Overview
19294
19295 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
19296
19297 @table @emph
19298 @item command
19299 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
19300 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
19301 managed using readline.
19302
19303 @item source
19304 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
19305 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
19306
19307 @item assembly
19308 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
19309
19310 @item register
19311 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
19312 when their values change.
19313 @end table
19314
19315 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
19316 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
19317 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
19318 indicates the breakpoint type:
19319
19320 @table @code
19321 @item B
19322 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
19323
19324 @item b
19325 Breakpoint which was never hit.
19326
19327 @item H
19328 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
19329
19330 @item h
19331 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
19332 @end table
19333
19334 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
19335
19336 @table @code
19337 @item +
19338 Breakpoint is enabled.
19339
19340 @item -
19341 Breakpoint is disabled.
19342 @end table
19343
19344 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
19345 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
19346 changes.
19347
19348 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
19349 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
19350 layouts:
19351
19352 @itemize @bullet
19353 @item
19354 source only,
19355
19356 @item
19357 assembly only,
19358
19359 @item
19360 source and assembly,
19361
19362 @item
19363 source and registers, or
19364
19365 @item
19366 assembly and registers.
19367 @end itemize
19368
19369 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
19370
19371 @table @emph
19372 @item target
19373 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
19374 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
19375
19376 @item process
19377 Gives the current process or thread number.
19378 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
19379
19380 @item function
19381 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
19382 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
19383 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
19384 the string @code{??} is displayed.
19385
19386 @item line
19387 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
19388 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
19389
19390 @item pc
19391 Indicates the current program counter address.
19392 @end table
19393
19394 @node TUI Keys
19395 @section TUI Key Bindings
19396 @cindex TUI key bindings
19397
19398 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
19399 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}). The following key bindings
19400 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
19401
19402 @table @kbd
19403 @kindex C-x C-a
19404 @item C-x C-a
19405 @kindex C-x a
19406 @itemx C-x a
19407 @kindex C-x A
19408 @itemx C-x A
19409 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
19410 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
19411 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
19412 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
19413 The screen is then refreshed.
19414
19415 @kindex C-x 1
19416 @item C-x 1
19417 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
19418 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
19419 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
19420
19421 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
19422
19423 @kindex C-x 2
19424 @item C-x 2
19425 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
19426 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
19427 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
19428 previous layout and the new one.
19429
19430 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
19431
19432 @kindex C-x o
19433 @item C-x o
19434 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
19435 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
19436 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
19437
19438 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
19439
19440 @kindex C-x s
19441 @item C-x s
19442 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
19443 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
19444 @end table
19445
19446 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
19447
19448 @table @asis
19449 @kindex PgUp
19450 @item @key{PgUp}
19451 Scroll the active window one page up.
19452
19453 @kindex PgDn
19454 @item @key{PgDn}
19455 Scroll the active window one page down.
19456
19457 @kindex Up
19458 @item @key{Up}
19459 Scroll the active window one line up.
19460
19461 @kindex Down
19462 @item @key{Down}
19463 Scroll the active window one line down.
19464
19465 @kindex Left
19466 @item @key{Left}
19467 Scroll the active window one column left.
19468
19469 @kindex Right
19470 @item @key{Right}
19471 Scroll the active window one column right.
19472
19473 @kindex C-L
19474 @item @kbd{C-L}
19475 Refresh the screen.
19476 @end table
19477
19478 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
19479 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
19480 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
19481 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
19482 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
19483
19484 @node TUI Single Key Mode
19485 @section TUI Single Key Mode
19486 @cindex TUI single key mode
19487
19488 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
19489 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
19490 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
19491
19492 @table @kbd
19493 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
19494 @item c
19495 continue
19496
19497 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
19498 @item d
19499 down
19500
19501 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
19502 @item f
19503 finish
19504
19505 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
19506 @item n
19507 next
19508
19509 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
19510 @item q
19511 exit the SingleKey mode.
19512
19513 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
19514 @item r
19515 run
19516
19517 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
19518 @item s
19519 step
19520
19521 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
19522 @item u
19523 up
19524
19525 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
19526 @item v
19527 info locals
19528
19529 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
19530 @item w
19531 where
19532 @end table
19533
19534 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
19535 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
19536 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
19537 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
19538 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
19539 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
19540
19541
19542 @node TUI Commands
19543 @section TUI-specific Commands
19544 @cindex TUI commands
19545
19546 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
19547 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
19548 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
19549 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
19550
19551 @table @code
19552 @item info win
19553 @kindex info win
19554 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
19555
19556 @item layout next
19557 @kindex layout
19558 Display the next layout.
19559
19560 @item layout prev
19561 Display the previous layout.
19562
19563 @item layout src
19564 Display the source window only.
19565
19566 @item layout asm
19567 Display the assembly window only.
19568
19569 @item layout split
19570 Display the source and assembly window.
19571
19572 @item layout regs
19573 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
19574
19575 @item focus next
19576 @kindex focus
19577 Make the next window active for scrolling.
19578
19579 @item focus prev
19580 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
19581
19582 @item focus src
19583 Make the source window active for scrolling.
19584
19585 @item focus asm
19586 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
19587
19588 @item focus regs
19589 Make the register window active for scrolling.
19590
19591 @item focus cmd
19592 Make the command window active for scrolling.
19593
19594 @item refresh
19595 @kindex refresh
19596 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
19597
19598 @item tui reg float
19599 @kindex tui reg
19600 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
19601
19602 @item tui reg general
19603 Show the general registers in the register window.
19604
19605 @item tui reg next
19606 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
19607 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
19608 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
19609 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
19610
19611 @item tui reg system
19612 Show the system registers in the register window.
19613
19614 @item update
19615 @kindex update
19616 Update the source window and the current execution point.
19617
19618 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
19619 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
19620 @kindex winheight
19621 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
19622 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
19623 decrease it.
19624
19625 @item tabset @var{nchars}
19626 @kindex tabset
19627 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
19628 @end table
19629
19630 @node TUI Configuration
19631 @section TUI Configuration Variables
19632 @cindex TUI configuration variables
19633
19634 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
19635
19636 @table @code
19637 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
19638 @kindex set tui border-kind
19639 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
19640 The possible values are the following:
19641 @table @code
19642 @item space
19643 Use a space character to draw the border.
19644
19645 @item ascii
19646 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
19647
19648 @item acs
19649 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
19650 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
19651 @end table
19652
19653 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
19654 @kindex set tui border-mode
19655 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
19656 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
19657 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
19658 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
19659 @table @code
19660 @item normal
19661 Use normal attributes to display the border.
19662
19663 @item standout
19664 Use standout mode.
19665
19666 @item reverse
19667 Use reverse video mode.
19668
19669 @item half
19670 Use half bright mode.
19671
19672 @item half-standout
19673 Use half bright and standout mode.
19674
19675 @item bold
19676 Use extra bright or bold mode.
19677
19678 @item bold-standout
19679 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
19680 @end table
19681 @end table
19682
19683 @node Emacs
19684 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
19685
19686 @cindex Emacs
19687 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
19688 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
19689 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
19690 @value{GDBN}.
19691
19692 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
19693 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
19694 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
19695 created Emacs buffer.
19696 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
19697
19698 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
19699 things:
19700
19701 @itemize @bullet
19702 @item
19703 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
19704 the GUD buffer.
19705
19706 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
19707 and output done by the program you are debugging.
19708
19709 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
19710 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
19711 in this way.
19712
19713 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
19714 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
19715 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
19716 stop.
19717
19718 @item
19719 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
19720
19721 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
19722 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
19723 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
19724 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
19725 and the source.
19726
19727 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
19728 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
19729 @end itemize
19730
19731 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
19732 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
19733 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
19734 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
19735
19736 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
19737 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
19738 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
19739 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
19740 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
19741 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
19742 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
19743 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
19744 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
19745
19746 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
19747 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
19748 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
19749 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
19750
19751 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
19752 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
19753 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
19754 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
19755 one you want.
19756
19757 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
19758 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
19759
19760 @table @kbd
19761 @item C-h m
19762 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
19763
19764 @item C-c C-s
19765 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
19766 update the display window to show the current file and location.
19767
19768 @item C-c C-n
19769 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
19770 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
19771 to show the current file and location.
19772
19773 @item C-c C-i
19774 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
19775 display window accordingly.
19776
19777 @item C-c C-f
19778 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
19779 @code{finish} command.
19780
19781 @item C-c C-r
19782 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
19783 command.
19784
19785 @item C-c <
19786 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
19787 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
19788 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
19789
19790 @item C-c >
19791 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
19792 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
19793 @end table
19794
19795 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
19796 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
19797
19798 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
19799 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
19800 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
19801 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
19802 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
19803 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
19804 speedbar displays watch expressions.
19805
19806 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
19807 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
19808 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
19809 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
19810 frame.
19811
19812 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
19813 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
19814 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
19815 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
19816 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
19817 to correspond properly with the code.
19818
19819 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
19820 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
19821 Emacs Manual}).
19822
19823 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
19824 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
19825 @ignore
19826 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
19827 @kindex Epoch
19828 @kindex inspect
19829
19830 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
19831 called the @code{epoch}
19832 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
19833 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
19834 each value is printed in its own window.
19835 @end ignore
19836
19837
19838 @node GDB/MI
19839 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
19840
19841 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
19842
19843 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
19844 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
19845 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
19846 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
19847 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
19848 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
19849
19850 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
19851 in the form of a reference manual.
19852
19853 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
19854 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
19855 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
19856
19857 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
19858
19859 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
19860 This chapter uses the following notation:
19861
19862 @itemize @bullet
19863 @item
19864 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
19865
19866 @item
19867 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
19868 it may or may not be given.
19869
19870 @item
19871 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
19872 may repeat zero or more times.
19873
19874 @item
19875 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
19876 may repeat one or more times.
19877
19878 @item
19879 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
19880 @end itemize
19881
19882 @ignore
19883 @heading Dependencies
19884 @end ignore
19885
19886 @menu
19887 * GDB/MI General Design::
19888 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
19889 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
19890 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
19891 * GDB/MI Output Records::
19892 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
19893 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
19894 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
19895 * GDB/MI Program Context::
19896 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
19897 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
19898 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
19899 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
19900 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
19901 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
19902 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
19903 * GDB/MI File Commands::
19904 @ignore
19905 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
19906 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
19907 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
19908 @end ignore
19909 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
19910 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
19911 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
19912 @end menu
19913
19914 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19915 @node GDB/MI General Design
19916 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
19917 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
19918
19919 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
19920 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
19921 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
19922 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
19923 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
19924 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
19925 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
19926 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
19927 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
19928 a command and reported as part of that command response.
19929
19930 The important examples of notifications are:
19931 @itemize @bullet
19932
19933 @item
19934 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
19935 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
19936 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
19937 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
19938 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
19939 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
19940 command itself was successfully executed.
19941
19942 @item
19943 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
19944 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
19945 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
19946 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
19947 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
19948 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
19949
19950 @item
19951 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
19952 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
19953 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
19954 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
19955 orthogonal frontend design.
19956
19957 @end itemize
19958
19959 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
19960 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
19961 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
19962 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
19963 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
19964 the user interface.
19965
19966
19967 @menu
19968 * Context management::
19969 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
19970 * Thread groups::
19971 @end menu
19972
19973 @node Context management
19974 @subsection Context management
19975
19976 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
19977 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
19978 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
19979 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
19980 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
19981 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
19982 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
19983 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
19984 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
19985
19986 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
19987 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
19988 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
19989 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
19990 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
19991 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
19992 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
19993 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
19994 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
19995 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
19996 for thread and frame to operate on.
19997
19998 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
19999 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
20000 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
20001 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
20002 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
20003 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
20004 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
20005 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
20006 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
20007 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
20008
20009 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
20010 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
20011 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
20012 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
20013 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
20014 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
20015 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
20016 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
20017 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
20018 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
20019 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
20020 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
20021 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
20022 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
20023 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
20024 @samp{--frame} options.
20025
20026 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
20027 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
20028
20029 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
20030 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
20031 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
20032 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
20033 @code{-gdb-set target-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
20034 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
20035 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
20036 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
20037 @code{-list-target-features} command.
20038
20039 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
20040 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
20041 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
20042 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
20043 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
20044 are running.
20045
20046 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
20047 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
20048 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
20049 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
20050 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
20051 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
20052 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
20053 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
20054 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
20055 @samp{--thread} option).
20056
20057 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
20058 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
20059 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
20060 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
20061
20062 @node Thread groups
20063 @subsection Thread groups
20064 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
20065 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
20066 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
20067 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
20068 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
20069
20070 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
20071 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
20072 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
20073 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
20074 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
20075 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
20076 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
20077 into processes.
20078
20079 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
20080 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
20081 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
20082 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
20083 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
20084 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
20085 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
20086 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
20087 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
20088 the members of specific thread group.
20089
20090 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
20091 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
20092 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
20093 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
20094 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
20095 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
20096 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
20097 after attaching to that thread group.
20098
20099 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20100 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
20101 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
20102
20103 @menu
20104 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
20105 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
20106 @end menu
20107
20108 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
20109 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
20110
20111 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
20112 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
20113 @table @code
20114 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
20115 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
20116
20117 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
20118 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
20119 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
20120
20121 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
20122 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
20123 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
20124
20125 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
20126 "any sequence of digits"
20127
20128 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
20129 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
20130
20131 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
20132 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
20133
20134 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
20135 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
20136
20137 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
20138 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
20139 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
20140
20141 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
20142 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
20143
20144 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
20145 @code{CR | CR-LF}
20146 @end table
20147
20148 @noindent
20149 Notes:
20150
20151 @itemize @bullet
20152 @item
20153 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
20154 output is described below.
20155
20156 @item
20157 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
20158 finishes.
20159
20160 @item
20161 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
20162 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
20163 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
20164 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
20165 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
20166 @end itemize
20167
20168 Pragmatics:
20169
20170 @itemize @bullet
20171 @item
20172 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
20173
20174 @item
20175 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
20176 @end itemize
20177
20178 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
20179 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
20180
20181 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
20182 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
20183 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
20184 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
20185 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
20186 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
20187
20188 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
20189 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
20190 @var{token}.
20191
20192 @table @code
20193 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
20194 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
20195
20196 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
20197 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
20198
20199 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
20200 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
20201
20202 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
20203 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
20204
20205 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
20206 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
20207
20208 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
20209 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
20210
20211 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
20212 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
20213
20214 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
20215 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
20216
20217 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
20218 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
20219
20220 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
20221 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
20222 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
20223
20224 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
20225 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
20226
20227 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
20228 @code{ @var{string} }
20229
20230 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
20231 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
20232
20233 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
20234 @code{@var{c-string}}
20235
20236 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
20237 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
20238
20239 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
20240 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
20241 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
20242
20243 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
20244 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
20245
20246 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
20247 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
20248
20249 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
20250 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
20251
20252 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
20253 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
20254
20255 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
20256 @code{CR | CR-LF}
20257
20258 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
20259 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
20260 @end table
20261
20262 @noindent
20263 Notes:
20264
20265 @itemize @bullet
20266 @item
20267 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
20268
20269 @item
20270 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
20271 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
20272 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
20273 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
20274 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
20275 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
20276 prior command.
20277
20278 @item
20279 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
20280 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
20281 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
20282 prefixed by @samp{+}.
20283
20284 @item
20285 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
20286 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
20287 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
20288 @samp{*}.
20289
20290 @item
20291 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
20292 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
20293 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
20294 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
20295
20296 @item
20297 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
20298 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
20299 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
20300 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
20301
20302 @item
20303 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
20304 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
20305 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
20306
20307 @item
20308 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
20309 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
20310 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
20311 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
20312
20313 @item
20314 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
20315 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
20316 @var{values}.
20317
20318
20319 @end itemize
20320
20321 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
20322 details about the various output records.
20323
20324 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20325 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
20326 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
20327
20328 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
20329 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
20330
20331 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
20332 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
20333 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
20334 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
20335 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
20336 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
20337
20338 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
20339 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
20340 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
20341
20342 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20343 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
20344 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
20345 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
20346
20347 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
20348 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
20349
20350 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
20351 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
20352 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
20353 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
20354 might change.
20355
20356 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
20357 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
20358 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
20359 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
20360
20361 @itemize @bullet
20362 @item
20363 New MI commands may be added.
20364
20365 @item
20366 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
20367
20368 @item
20369 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
20370 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
20371
20372 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
20373 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
20374
20375 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
20376 @c resolve inconsistencies.
20377 @end itemize
20378
20379 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
20380 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
20381 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
20382 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
20383 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
20384
20385 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
20386 @c version?
20387
20388 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
20389 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
20390 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
20391 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
20392 @cindex mailing lists
20393
20394 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20395 @node GDB/MI Output Records
20396 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
20397
20398 @menu
20399 * GDB/MI Result Records::
20400 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
20401 * GDB/MI Async Records::
20402 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
20403 @end menu
20404
20405 @node GDB/MI Result Records
20406 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
20407
20408 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
20409 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
20410 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
20411 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
20412
20413 @table @code
20414 @findex ^done
20415 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
20416 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
20417 values.
20418
20419 @item "^running"
20420 @findex ^running
20421 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
20422 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
20423 running.
20424
20425 @item "^connected"
20426 @findex ^connected
20427 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
20428
20429 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
20430 @findex ^error
20431 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
20432 error message.
20433
20434 @item "^exit"
20435 @findex ^exit
20436 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
20437
20438 @end table
20439
20440 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
20441 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
20442
20443 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
20444 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
20445 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
20446 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
20447 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
20448
20449 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
20450 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
20451 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
20452 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
20453 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
20454
20455 @table @code
20456 @item "~" @var{string-output}
20457 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
20458 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
20459
20460 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
20461 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
20462 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
20463 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
20464
20465 @item "&" @var{string-output}
20466 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
20467 internals.
20468 @end table
20469
20470 @node GDB/MI Async Records
20471 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
20472
20473 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
20474 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
20475 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
20476 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
20477 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
20478 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
20479
20480 The following is the list of possible async records:
20481
20482 @table @code
20483
20484 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
20485 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
20486 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
20487 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
20488 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
20489 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
20490 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
20491 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
20492 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
20493 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
20494
20495 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}"
20496 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
20497 following values:
20498
20499 @table @code
20500 @item breakpoint-hit
20501 A breakpoint was reached.
20502 @item watchpoint-trigger
20503 A watchpoint was triggered.
20504 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
20505 A read watchpoint was triggered.
20506 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
20507 An access watchpoint was triggered.
20508 @item function-finished
20509 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
20510 @item location-reached
20511 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
20512 @item watchpoint-scope
20513 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
20514 @item end-stepping-range
20515 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
20516 similar CLI command was accomplished.
20517 @item exited-signalled
20518 The inferior exited because of a signal.
20519 @item exited
20520 The inferior exited.
20521 @item exited-normally
20522 The inferior exited normally.
20523 @item signal-received
20524 A signal was received by the inferior.
20525 @end table
20526
20527 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
20528 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
20529 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
20530 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
20531 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
20532 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
20533 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
20534 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
20535 several threads in the list.
20536
20537 @item =thread-group-created,id="@var{id}"
20538 @itemx =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"
20539 A thread thread group either was attached to, or has exited/detached
20540 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
20541 thread group.
20542
20543 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
20544 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
20545 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
20546 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
20547 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
20548
20549 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
20550 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
20551 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
20552 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
20553 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
20554 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
20555 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
20556
20557 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
20558 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
20559 that thread.
20560
20561 @item =library-loaded,...
20562 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
20563 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
20564 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
20565 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
20566 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
20567 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
20568 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
20569 @var{symbols-loaded} field reports if the debug symbols for this
20570 library are loaded.
20571
20572 @item =library-unloaded,...
20573 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
20574 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
20575 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification
20576
20577 @end table
20578
20579 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
20580 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
20581
20582 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
20583 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
20584 fields:
20585
20586 @table @code
20587 @item level
20588 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
20589 zero. This field is always present.
20590
20591 @item func
20592 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
20593 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
20594
20595 @item addr
20596 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
20597
20598 @item file
20599 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
20600 address. This field may be absent.
20601
20602 @item line
20603 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
20604 may be absent.
20605
20606 @item from
20607 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
20608 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
20609
20610 @end table
20611
20612
20613 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20614 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
20615 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
20616 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
20617
20618 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
20619 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
20620 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
20621 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
20622
20623 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
20624 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
20625
20626 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
20627
20628 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
20629 information of the breakpoint.
20630
20631 @smallexample
20632 -> -break-insert main
20633 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
20634 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
20635 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
20636 <- (gdb)
20637 @end smallexample
20638
20639 @subheading Program Execution
20640
20641 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
20642 reason that execution stopped.
20643
20644 @smallexample
20645 -> -exec-run
20646 <- ^running
20647 <- (gdb)
20648 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
20649 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
20650 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
20651 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
20652 <- (gdb)
20653 -> -exec-continue
20654 <- ^running
20655 <- (gdb)
20656 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
20657 <- (gdb)
20658 @end smallexample
20659
20660 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
20661
20662 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
20663
20664 @smallexample
20665 -> (gdb)
20666 <- -gdb-exit
20667 <- ^exit
20668 @end smallexample
20669
20670 @subheading A Bad Command
20671
20672 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
20673
20674 @smallexample
20675 -> -rubbish
20676 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
20677 <- (gdb)
20678 @end smallexample
20679
20680
20681 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20682 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
20683 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
20684
20685 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
20686 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
20687
20688 @subheading Motivation
20689
20690 The motivation for this collection of commands.
20691
20692 @subheading Introduction
20693
20694 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
20695
20696 @subheading Commands
20697
20698 For each command in the block, the following is described:
20699
20700 @subsubheading Synopsis
20701
20702 @smallexample
20703 -command @var{args}@dots{}
20704 @end smallexample
20705
20706 @subsubheading Result
20707
20708 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20709
20710 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
20711
20712 @subsubheading Example
20713
20714 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
20715 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
20716
20717
20718 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20719 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
20720 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
20721
20722 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
20723 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
20724 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
20725 breakpoints.
20726
20727 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
20728 @findex -break-after
20729
20730 @subsubheading Synopsis
20731
20732 @smallexample
20733 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
20734 @end smallexample
20735
20736 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
20737 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
20738 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
20739 @samp{-break-list} command below.
20740
20741 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20742
20743 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
20744
20745 @subsubheading Example
20746
20747 @smallexample
20748 (gdb)
20749 -break-insert main
20750 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
20751 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
20752 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
20753 (gdb)
20754 -break-after 1 3
20755 ~
20756 ^done
20757 (gdb)
20758 -break-list
20759 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
20760 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20761 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20762 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20763 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20764 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20765 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20766 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20767 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
20768 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
20769 (gdb)
20770 @end smallexample
20771
20772 @ignore
20773 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
20774 @findex -break-catch
20775
20776 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
20777 @findex -break-commands
20778 @end ignore
20779
20780
20781 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
20782 @findex -break-condition
20783
20784 @subsubheading Synopsis
20785
20786 @smallexample
20787 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
20788 @end smallexample
20789
20790 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
20791 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
20792 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
20793 command below).
20794
20795 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20796
20797 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
20798
20799 @subsubheading Example
20800
20801 @smallexample
20802 (gdb)
20803 -break-condition 1 1
20804 ^done
20805 (gdb)
20806 -break-list
20807 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
20808 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20809 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20810 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20811 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20812 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20813 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20814 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20815 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
20816 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
20817 (gdb)
20818 @end smallexample
20819
20820 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
20821 @findex -break-delete
20822
20823 @subsubheading Synopsis
20824
20825 @smallexample
20826 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
20827 @end smallexample
20828
20829 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
20830 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
20831
20832 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20833
20834 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
20835
20836 @subsubheading Example
20837
20838 @smallexample
20839 (gdb)
20840 -break-delete 1
20841 ^done
20842 (gdb)
20843 -break-list
20844 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
20845 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20846 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20847 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20848 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20849 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20850 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20851 body=[]@}
20852 (gdb)
20853 @end smallexample
20854
20855 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
20856 @findex -break-disable
20857
20858 @subsubheading Synopsis
20859
20860 @smallexample
20861 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
20862 @end smallexample
20863
20864 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
20865 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
20866
20867 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20868
20869 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
20870
20871 @subsubheading Example
20872
20873 @smallexample
20874 (gdb)
20875 -break-disable 2
20876 ^done
20877 (gdb)
20878 -break-list
20879 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
20880 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20881 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20882 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20883 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20884 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20885 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20886 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
20887 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
20888 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
20889 (gdb)
20890 @end smallexample
20891
20892 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
20893 @findex -break-enable
20894
20895 @subsubheading Synopsis
20896
20897 @smallexample
20898 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
20899 @end smallexample
20900
20901 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
20902
20903 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20904
20905 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
20906
20907 @subsubheading Example
20908
20909 @smallexample
20910 (gdb)
20911 -break-enable 2
20912 ^done
20913 (gdb)
20914 -break-list
20915 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
20916 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20917 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20918 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20919 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20920 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20921 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20922 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20923 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
20924 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
20925 (gdb)
20926 @end smallexample
20927
20928 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
20929 @findex -break-info
20930
20931 @subsubheading Synopsis
20932
20933 @smallexample
20934 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
20935 @end smallexample
20936
20937 @c REDUNDANT???
20938 Get information about a single breakpoint.
20939
20940 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20941
20942 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
20943
20944 @subsubheading Example
20945 N.A.
20946
20947 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
20948 @findex -break-insert
20949
20950 @subsubheading Synopsis
20951
20952 @smallexample
20953 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
20954 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
20955 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{location} ]
20956 @end smallexample
20957
20958 @noindent
20959 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
20960
20961 @itemize @bullet
20962 @item function
20963 @c @item +offset
20964 @c @item -offset
20965 @c @item linenum
20966 @item filename:linenum
20967 @item filename:function
20968 @item *address
20969 @end itemize
20970
20971 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
20972
20973 @table @samp
20974 @item -t
20975 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
20976 @item -h
20977 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
20978 @item -c @var{condition}
20979 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
20980 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
20981 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
20982 @item -f
20983 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
20984 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
20985 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
20986 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
20987 cannot be parsed.
20988 @item -d
20989 Create a disabled breakpoint.
20990 @end table
20991
20992 @subsubheading Result
20993
20994 The result is in the form:
20995
20996 @smallexample
20997 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
20998 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
20999 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
21000 times="@var{times}"@}
21001 @end smallexample
21002
21003 @noindent
21004 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
21005 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
21006 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
21007 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
21008 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
21009 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
21010 which use the same output).
21011
21012 Note: this format is open to change.
21013 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
21014
21015 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21016
21017 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
21018 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
21019
21020 @subsubheading Example
21021
21022 @smallexample
21023 (gdb)
21024 -break-insert main
21025 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
21026 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
21027 (gdb)
21028 -break-insert -t foo
21029 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
21030 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
21031 (gdb)
21032 -break-list
21033 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
21034 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
21035 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
21036 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
21037 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
21038 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
21039 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
21040 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
21041 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
21042 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
21043 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
21044 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
21045 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
21046 (gdb)
21047 -break-insert -r foo.*
21048 ~int foo(int, int);
21049 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
21050 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
21051 (gdb)
21052 @end smallexample
21053
21054 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
21055 @findex -break-list
21056
21057 @subsubheading Synopsis
21058
21059 @smallexample
21060 -break-list
21061 @end smallexample
21062
21063 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
21064
21065 @table @samp
21066 @item Number
21067 number of the breakpoint
21068 @item Type
21069 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
21070 @item Disposition
21071 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
21072 or @samp{nokeep}
21073 @item Enabled
21074 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
21075 @item Address
21076 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
21077 @item What
21078 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
21079 name, line number
21080 @item Times
21081 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
21082 @end table
21083
21084 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
21085 @code{body} field is an empty list.
21086
21087 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21088
21089 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
21090
21091 @subsubheading Example
21092
21093 @smallexample
21094 (gdb)
21095 -break-list
21096 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
21097 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
21098 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
21099 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
21100 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
21101 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
21102 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
21103 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
21104 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
21105 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
21106 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
21107 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
21108 (gdb)
21109 @end smallexample
21110
21111 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
21112
21113 @smallexample
21114 (gdb)
21115 -break-list
21116 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
21117 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
21118 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
21119 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
21120 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
21121 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
21122 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
21123 body=[]@}
21124 (gdb)
21125 @end smallexample
21126
21127 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
21128 @findex -break-watch
21129
21130 @subsubheading Synopsis
21131
21132 @smallexample
21133 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
21134 @end smallexample
21135
21136 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
21137 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
21138 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
21139 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
21140 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
21141 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
21142 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
21143 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
21144
21145 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
21146 breakpoints inserted.
21147
21148 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21149
21150 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
21151 @samp{rwatch}.
21152
21153 @subsubheading Example
21154
21155 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
21156
21157 @smallexample
21158 (gdb)
21159 -break-watch x
21160 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
21161 (gdb)
21162 -exec-continue
21163 ^running
21164 (gdb)
21165 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
21166 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
21167 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
21168 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
21169 (gdb)
21170 @end smallexample
21171
21172 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
21173 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
21174 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
21175
21176 @smallexample
21177 (gdb)
21178 -break-watch C
21179 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
21180 (gdb)
21181 -exec-continue
21182 ^running
21183 (gdb)
21184 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
21185 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
21186 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
21187 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21188 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
21189 (gdb)
21190 -exec-continue
21191 ^running
21192 (gdb)
21193 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
21194 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
21195 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
21196 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21197 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
21198 (gdb)
21199 @end smallexample
21200
21201 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
21202 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
21203 deleted.
21204
21205 @smallexample
21206 (gdb)
21207 -break-watch C
21208 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
21209 (gdb)
21210 -break-list
21211 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
21212 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
21213 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
21214 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
21215 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
21216 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
21217 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
21218 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
21219 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
21220 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21221 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
21222 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
21223 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
21224 (gdb)
21225 -exec-continue
21226 ^running
21227 (gdb)
21228 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
21229 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
21230 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
21231 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21232 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
21233 (gdb)
21234 -break-list
21235 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
21236 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
21237 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
21238 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
21239 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
21240 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
21241 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
21242 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
21243 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
21244 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21245 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
21246 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
21247 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
21248 (gdb)
21249 -exec-continue
21250 ^running
21251 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
21252 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
21253 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
21254 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21255 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
21256 (gdb)
21257 -break-list
21258 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
21259 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
21260 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
21261 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
21262 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
21263 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
21264 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
21265 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
21266 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
21267 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21268 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
21269 times="1"@}]@}
21270 (gdb)
21271 @end smallexample
21272
21273 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21274 @node GDB/MI Program Context
21275 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
21276
21277 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
21278 @findex -exec-arguments
21279
21280
21281 @subsubheading Synopsis
21282
21283 @smallexample
21284 -exec-arguments @var{args}
21285 @end smallexample
21286
21287 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
21288 @samp{-exec-run}.
21289
21290 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21291
21292 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
21293
21294 @subsubheading Example
21295
21296 @smallexample
21297 (gdb)
21298 -exec-arguments -v word
21299 ^done
21300 (gdb)
21301 @end smallexample
21302
21303
21304 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
21305 @findex -exec-show-arguments
21306
21307 @subsubheading Synopsis
21308
21309 @smallexample
21310 -exec-show-arguments
21311 @end smallexample
21312
21313 Print the arguments of the program.
21314
21315 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21316
21317 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
21318
21319 @subsubheading Example
21320 N.A.
21321
21322
21323 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
21324 @findex -environment-cd
21325
21326 @subsubheading Synopsis
21327
21328 @smallexample
21329 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
21330 @end smallexample
21331
21332 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
21333
21334 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21335
21336 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
21337
21338 @subsubheading Example
21339
21340 @smallexample
21341 (gdb)
21342 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
21343 ^done
21344 (gdb)
21345 @end smallexample
21346
21347
21348 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
21349 @findex -environment-directory
21350
21351 @subsubheading Synopsis
21352
21353 @smallexample
21354 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
21355 @end smallexample
21356
21357 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
21358 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
21359 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
21360 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
21361 occurs as normal.
21362 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
21363 multiple directories in a single command
21364 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
21365 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
21366 If blanks are needed as
21367 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
21368 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
21369 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
21370 character must not be used
21371 in any directory name.
21372 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
21373
21374 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21375
21376 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
21377
21378 @subsubheading Example
21379
21380 @smallexample
21381 (gdb)
21382 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
21383 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
21384 (gdb)
21385 -environment-directory ""
21386 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
21387 (gdb)
21388 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
21389 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
21390 (gdb)
21391 -environment-directory -r
21392 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
21393 (gdb)
21394 @end smallexample
21395
21396
21397 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
21398 @findex -environment-path
21399
21400 @subsubheading Synopsis
21401
21402 @smallexample
21403 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
21404 @end smallexample
21405
21406 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
21407 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
21408 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
21409 supplied in addition to the
21410 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
21411 occurs as normal.
21412 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
21413 multiple directories in a single command
21414 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
21415 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
21416 If blanks are needed as
21417 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
21418 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
21419 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
21420 character must not be used
21421 in any directory name.
21422 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
21423
21424
21425 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21426
21427 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
21428
21429 @subsubheading Example
21430
21431 @smallexample
21432 (gdb)
21433 -environment-path
21434 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
21435 (gdb)
21436 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
21437 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
21438 (gdb)
21439 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
21440 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
21441 (gdb)
21442 @end smallexample
21443
21444
21445 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
21446 @findex -environment-pwd
21447
21448 @subsubheading Synopsis
21449
21450 @smallexample
21451 -environment-pwd
21452 @end smallexample
21453
21454 Show the current working directory.
21455
21456 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21457
21458 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
21459
21460 @subsubheading Example
21461
21462 @smallexample
21463 (gdb)
21464 -environment-pwd
21465 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
21466 (gdb)
21467 @end smallexample
21468
21469 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21470 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
21471 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
21472
21473
21474 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
21475 @findex -thread-info
21476
21477 @subsubheading Synopsis
21478
21479 @smallexample
21480 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
21481 @end smallexample
21482
21483 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
21484 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
21485 threads. When printing information about all threads,
21486 also reports the current thread.
21487
21488 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21489
21490 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
21491 about all threads.
21492
21493 @subsubheading Example
21494
21495 @smallexample
21496 -thread-info
21497 ^done,threads=[
21498 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
21499 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
21500 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
21501 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
21502 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}],
21503 current-thread-id="1"
21504 (gdb)
21505 @end smallexample
21506
21507 The @samp{state} field may have the following values:
21508
21509 @table @code
21510 @item stopped
21511 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
21512 threads.
21513
21514 @item running
21515 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
21516 threads.
21517
21518 @end table
21519
21520 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
21521 @findex -thread-list-ids
21522
21523 @subsubheading Synopsis
21524
21525 @smallexample
21526 -thread-list-ids
21527 @end smallexample
21528
21529 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
21530 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
21531
21532 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
21533 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
21534
21535 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21536
21537 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
21538
21539 @subsubheading Example
21540
21541 @smallexample
21542 (gdb)
21543 -thread-list-ids
21544 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
21545 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
21546 (gdb)
21547 @end smallexample
21548
21549
21550 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
21551 @findex -thread-select
21552
21553 @subsubheading Synopsis
21554
21555 @smallexample
21556 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
21557 @end smallexample
21558
21559 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
21560 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
21561
21562 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
21563 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
21564
21565 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21566
21567 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
21568
21569 @subsubheading Example
21570
21571 @smallexample
21572 (gdb)
21573 -exec-next
21574 ^running
21575 (gdb)
21576 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
21577 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
21578 (gdb)
21579 -thread-list-ids
21580 ^done,
21581 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
21582 number-of-threads="3"
21583 (gdb)
21584 -thread-select 3
21585 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
21586 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
21587 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
21588 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
21589 (gdb)
21590 @end smallexample
21591
21592 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21593 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
21594 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
21595
21596 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
21597 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
21598 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
21599 other cases.
21600
21601 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
21602 @findex -exec-continue
21603
21604 @subsubheading Synopsis
21605
21606 @smallexample
21607 -exec-continue [--all|--thread-group N]
21608 @end smallexample
21609
21610 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until a breakpoint is
21611 encountered, or until the inferior exits. In all-stop mode
21612 (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads,
21613 depending on the value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. In
21614 non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), if the @samp{--all} is not
21615 specified, only the thread specified with the @samp{--thread} option
21616 (or current thread, if no @samp{--thread} is provided) is resumed. If
21617 @samp{--all} is specified, all threads will be resumed. The
21618 @samp{--all} option is ignored in all-stop mode. If the
21619 @samp{--thread-group} options is specified, then all threads in that
21620 thread group are resumed.
21621
21622 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21623
21624 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
21625
21626 @subsubheading Example
21627
21628 @smallexample
21629 -exec-continue
21630 ^running
21631 (gdb)
21632 @@Hello world
21633 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
21634 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
21635 line="13"@}
21636 (gdb)
21637 @end smallexample
21638
21639
21640 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
21641 @findex -exec-finish
21642
21643 @subsubheading Synopsis
21644
21645 @smallexample
21646 -exec-finish
21647 @end smallexample
21648
21649 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
21650 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
21651
21652 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21653
21654 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
21655
21656 @subsubheading Example
21657
21658 Function returning @code{void}.
21659
21660 @smallexample
21661 -exec-finish
21662 ^running
21663 (gdb)
21664 @@hello from foo
21665 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
21666 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
21667 (gdb)
21668 @end smallexample
21669
21670 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
21671 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
21672 value itself.
21673
21674 @smallexample
21675 -exec-finish
21676 ^running
21677 (gdb)
21678 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
21679 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
21680 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21681 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
21682 (gdb)
21683 @end smallexample
21684
21685
21686 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
21687 @findex -exec-interrupt
21688
21689 @subsubheading Synopsis
21690
21691 @smallexample
21692 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
21693 @end smallexample
21694
21695 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
21696 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
21697 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
21698 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
21699 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
21700
21701 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
21702 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
21703 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
21704 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
21705
21706 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
21707 All threads will be interrupted if the @samp{--all} option is
21708 specified. If the @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, all
21709 threads in that group will be interrupted.
21710
21711 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21712
21713 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
21714
21715 @subsubheading Example
21716
21717 @smallexample
21718 (gdb)
21719 111-exec-continue
21720 111^running
21721
21722 (gdb)
21723 222-exec-interrupt
21724 222^done
21725 (gdb)
21726 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
21727 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
21728 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
21729 (gdb)
21730
21731 (gdb)
21732 -exec-interrupt
21733 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
21734 (gdb)
21735 @end smallexample
21736
21737 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
21738 @findex -exec-jump
21739
21740 @subsubheading Synopsis
21741
21742 @smallexample
21743 -exec-jump @var{location}
21744 @end smallexample
21745
21746 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
21747 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
21748 different forms of @var{location}.
21749
21750 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21751
21752 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
21753
21754 @subsubheading Example
21755
21756 @smallexample
21757 -exec-jump foo.c:10
21758 *running,thread-id="all"
21759 ^running
21760 @end smallexample
21761
21762
21763 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
21764 @findex -exec-next
21765
21766 @subsubheading Synopsis
21767
21768 @smallexample
21769 -exec-next
21770 @end smallexample
21771
21772 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
21773 of the next source line is reached.
21774
21775 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21776
21777 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
21778
21779 @subsubheading Example
21780
21781 @smallexample
21782 -exec-next
21783 ^running
21784 (gdb)
21785 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
21786 (gdb)
21787 @end smallexample
21788
21789
21790 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
21791 @findex -exec-next-instruction
21792
21793 @subsubheading Synopsis
21794
21795 @smallexample
21796 -exec-next-instruction
21797 @end smallexample
21798
21799 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
21800 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
21801 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
21802 printed as well.
21803
21804 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21805
21806 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
21807
21808 @subsubheading Example
21809
21810 @smallexample
21811 (gdb)
21812 -exec-next-instruction
21813 ^running
21814
21815 (gdb)
21816 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
21817 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
21818 (gdb)
21819 @end smallexample
21820
21821
21822 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
21823 @findex -exec-return
21824
21825 @subsubheading Synopsis
21826
21827 @smallexample
21828 -exec-return
21829 @end smallexample
21830
21831 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
21832 Displays the new current frame.
21833
21834 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21835
21836 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
21837
21838 @subsubheading Example
21839
21840 @smallexample
21841 (gdb)
21842 200-break-insert callee4
21843 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
21844 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
21845 (gdb)
21846 000-exec-run
21847 000^running
21848 (gdb)
21849 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
21850 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
21851 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21852 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
21853 (gdb)
21854 205-break-delete
21855 205^done
21856 (gdb)
21857 111-exec-return
21858 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
21859 args=[@{name="strarg",
21860 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
21861 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21862 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
21863 (gdb)
21864 @end smallexample
21865
21866
21867 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
21868 @findex -exec-run
21869
21870 @subsubheading Synopsis
21871
21872 @smallexample
21873 -exec-run
21874 @end smallexample
21875
21876 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
21877 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
21878 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
21879 the program has exited exceptionally.
21880
21881 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21882
21883 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
21884
21885 @subsubheading Examples
21886
21887 @smallexample
21888 (gdb)
21889 -break-insert main
21890 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
21891 (gdb)
21892 -exec-run
21893 ^running
21894 (gdb)
21895 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
21896 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
21897 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
21898 (gdb)
21899 @end smallexample
21900
21901 @noindent
21902 Program exited normally:
21903
21904 @smallexample
21905 (gdb)
21906 -exec-run
21907 ^running
21908 (gdb)
21909 x = 55
21910 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
21911 (gdb)
21912 @end smallexample
21913
21914 @noindent
21915 Program exited exceptionally:
21916
21917 @smallexample
21918 (gdb)
21919 -exec-run
21920 ^running
21921 (gdb)
21922 x = 55
21923 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
21924 (gdb)
21925 @end smallexample
21926
21927 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
21928 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
21929
21930 @smallexample
21931 (gdb)
21932 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
21933 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
21934 @end smallexample
21935
21936
21937 @c @subheading -exec-signal
21938
21939
21940 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
21941 @findex -exec-step
21942
21943 @subsubheading Synopsis
21944
21945 @smallexample
21946 -exec-step
21947 @end smallexample
21948
21949 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
21950 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
21951 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
21952 function.
21953
21954 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21955
21956 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
21957
21958 @subsubheading Example
21959
21960 Stepping into a function:
21961
21962 @smallexample
21963 -exec-step
21964 ^running
21965 (gdb)
21966 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
21967 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
21968 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
21969 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
21970 (gdb)
21971 @end smallexample
21972
21973 Regular stepping:
21974
21975 @smallexample
21976 -exec-step
21977 ^running
21978 (gdb)
21979 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
21980 (gdb)
21981 @end smallexample
21982
21983
21984 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
21985 @findex -exec-step-instruction
21986
21987 @subsubheading Synopsis
21988
21989 @smallexample
21990 -exec-step-instruction
21991 @end smallexample
21992
21993 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. The
21994 output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on whether
21995 we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the former
21996 case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
21997 well.
21998
21999 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22000
22001 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
22002
22003 @subsubheading Example
22004
22005 @smallexample
22006 (gdb)
22007 -exec-step-instruction
22008 ^running
22009
22010 (gdb)
22011 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
22012 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
22013 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
22014 (gdb)
22015 -exec-step-instruction
22016 ^running
22017
22018 (gdb)
22019 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
22020 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
22021 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
22022 (gdb)
22023 @end smallexample
22024
22025
22026 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
22027 @findex -exec-until
22028
22029 @subsubheading Synopsis
22030
22031 @smallexample
22032 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
22033 @end smallexample
22034
22035 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
22036 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
22037 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
22038 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
22039
22040 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22041
22042 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
22043
22044 @subsubheading Example
22045
22046 @smallexample
22047 (gdb)
22048 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
22049 ^running
22050 (gdb)
22051 x = 55
22052 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
22053 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
22054 (gdb)
22055 @end smallexample
22056
22057 @ignore
22058 @subheading -file-clear
22059 Is this going away????
22060 @end ignore
22061
22062 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22063 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
22064 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
22065
22066
22067 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
22068 @findex -stack-info-frame
22069
22070 @subsubheading Synopsis
22071
22072 @smallexample
22073 -stack-info-frame
22074 @end smallexample
22075
22076 Get info on the selected frame.
22077
22078 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22079
22080 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
22081 (without arguments).
22082
22083 @subsubheading Example
22084
22085 @smallexample
22086 (gdb)
22087 -stack-info-frame
22088 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
22089 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
22090 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
22091 (gdb)
22092 @end smallexample
22093
22094 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
22095 @findex -stack-info-depth
22096
22097 @subsubheading Synopsis
22098
22099 @smallexample
22100 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
22101 @end smallexample
22102
22103 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
22104 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
22105
22106 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22107
22108 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
22109
22110 @subsubheading Example
22111
22112 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
22113
22114 @smallexample
22115 (gdb)
22116 -stack-info-depth
22117 ^done,depth="12"
22118 (gdb)
22119 -stack-info-depth 4
22120 ^done,depth="4"
22121 (gdb)
22122 -stack-info-depth 12
22123 ^done,depth="12"
22124 (gdb)
22125 -stack-info-depth 11
22126 ^done,depth="11"
22127 (gdb)
22128 -stack-info-depth 13
22129 ^done,depth="12"
22130 (gdb)
22131 @end smallexample
22132
22133 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
22134 @findex -stack-list-arguments
22135
22136 @subsubheading Synopsis
22137
22138 @smallexample
22139 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
22140 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
22141 @end smallexample
22142
22143 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
22144 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
22145 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
22146 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
22147 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
22148 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
22149 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
22150 which case only existing frames will be returned.
22151
22152 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
22153 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
22154 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
22155
22156 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22157
22158 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
22159 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
22160 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
22161
22162 @subsubheading Example
22163
22164 @smallexample
22165 (gdb)
22166 -stack-list-frames
22167 ^done,
22168 stack=[
22169 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
22170 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
22171 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
22172 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
22173 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
22174 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
22175 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
22176 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
22177 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
22178 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
22179 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
22180 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
22181 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
22182 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
22183 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
22184 (gdb)
22185 -stack-list-arguments 0
22186 ^done,
22187 stack-args=[
22188 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
22189 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
22190 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
22191 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
22192 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
22193 (gdb)
22194 -stack-list-arguments 1
22195 ^done,
22196 stack-args=[
22197 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
22198 frame=@{level="1",
22199 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
22200 frame=@{level="2",args=[
22201 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
22202 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
22203 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
22204 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
22205 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
22206 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
22207 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
22208 (gdb)
22209 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
22210 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
22211 (gdb)
22212 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
22213 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
22214 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
22215 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
22216 (gdb)
22217 @end smallexample
22218
22219 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
22220
22221
22222 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
22223 @findex -stack-list-frames
22224
22225 @subsubheading Synopsis
22226
22227 @smallexample
22228 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
22229 @end smallexample
22230
22231 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
22232 following info:
22233
22234 @table @samp
22235 @item @var{level}
22236 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
22237 @item @var{addr}
22238 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
22239 @item @var{func}
22240 Function name.
22241 @item @var{file}
22242 File name of the source file where the function lives.
22243 @item @var{line}
22244 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
22245 @end table
22246
22247 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
22248 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
22249 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
22250 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
22251 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
22252 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
22253 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
22254
22255 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22256
22257 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
22258
22259 @subsubheading Example
22260
22261 Full stack backtrace:
22262
22263 @smallexample
22264 (gdb)
22265 -stack-list-frames
22266 ^done,stack=
22267 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
22268 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
22269 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
22270 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
22271 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
22272 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
22273 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
22274 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
22275 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
22276 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
22277 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
22278 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
22279 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
22280 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
22281 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
22282 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
22283 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
22284 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
22285 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
22286 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
22287 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
22288 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
22289 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
22290 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
22291 (gdb)
22292 @end smallexample
22293
22294 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
22295
22296 @smallexample
22297 (gdb)
22298 -stack-list-frames 3 5
22299 ^done,stack=
22300 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
22301 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
22302 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
22303 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
22304 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
22305 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
22306 (gdb)
22307 @end smallexample
22308
22309 Show a single frame:
22310
22311 @smallexample
22312 (gdb)
22313 -stack-list-frames 3 3
22314 ^done,stack=
22315 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
22316 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
22317 (gdb)
22318 @end smallexample
22319
22320
22321 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
22322 @findex -stack-list-locals
22323
22324 @subsubheading Synopsis
22325
22326 @smallexample
22327 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
22328 @end smallexample
22329
22330 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
22331 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
22332 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
22333 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
22334 type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
22335 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
22336 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
22337 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
22338 more detail.
22339
22340 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22341
22342 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
22343
22344 @subsubheading Example
22345
22346 @smallexample
22347 (gdb)
22348 -stack-list-locals 0
22349 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
22350 (gdb)
22351 -stack-list-locals --all-values
22352 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
22353 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
22354 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
22355 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
22356 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
22357 (gdb)
22358 @end smallexample
22359
22360
22361 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
22362 @findex -stack-select-frame
22363
22364 @subsubheading Synopsis
22365
22366 @smallexample
22367 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
22368 @end smallexample
22369
22370 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
22371 the stack.
22372
22373 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
22374 option to every command.
22375
22376 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22377
22378 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
22379 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
22380
22381 @subsubheading Example
22382
22383 @smallexample
22384 (gdb)
22385 -stack-select-frame 2
22386 ^done
22387 (gdb)
22388 @end smallexample
22389
22390 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22391 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
22392 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
22393
22394 @ignore
22395
22396 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
22397
22398 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
22399 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
22400 used by @code{Insight}.
22401
22402 The two main reasons for that are:
22403
22404 @enumerate 1
22405 @item
22406 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
22407
22408 @item
22409 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
22410 now).
22411 @end enumerate
22412
22413 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
22414 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
22415 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
22416 hints about their use.
22417
22418 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
22419 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
22420 least, the following operations:
22421
22422 @itemize @bullet
22423 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
22424 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
22425 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
22426 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
22427 @end itemize
22428
22429 @end ignore
22430
22431 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
22432
22433 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
22434
22435 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
22436 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
22437 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
22438 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
22439 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
22440 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
22441 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
22442 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
22443 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
22444 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
22445 object, or to change display format.
22446
22447 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
22448 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
22449 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
22450 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
22451 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
22452 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
22453 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
22454 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
22455 child will be created.
22456
22457 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
22458 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
22459 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
22460 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
22461 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
22462
22463 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
22464 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
22465 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
22466 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
22467 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
22468 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
22469 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
22470 variables that frontend has created.
22471
22472 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
22473 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
22474 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
22475 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
22476 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
22477 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
22478 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
22479 implicitly updated.
22480
22481 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
22482 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
22483 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
22484 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
22485 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
22486 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
22487 frame. Consider this example:
22488
22489 @smallexample
22490 void do_work(...)
22491 @{
22492 struct work_state state;
22493
22494 if (...)
22495 do_work(...);
22496 @}
22497 @end smallexample
22498
22499 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
22500 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the the variable
22501 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
22502 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
22503 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
22504
22505 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
22506 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
22507 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
22508 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
22509 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
22510 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
22511
22512 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
22513 access this functionality:
22514
22515 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
22516 @item @strong{Operation}
22517 @tab @strong{Description}
22518
22519 @item @code{-var-create}
22520 @tab create a variable object
22521 @item @code{-var-delete}
22522 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
22523 @item @code{-var-set-format}
22524 @tab set the display format of this variable
22525 @item @code{-var-show-format}
22526 @tab show the display format of this variable
22527 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
22528 @tab tells how many children this object has
22529 @item @code{-var-list-children}
22530 @tab return a list of the object's children
22531 @item @code{-var-info-type}
22532 @tab show the type of this variable object
22533 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
22534 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
22535 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
22536 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
22537 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
22538 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
22539 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
22540 @tab get the value of this variable
22541 @item @code{-var-assign}
22542 @tab set the value of this variable
22543 @item @code{-var-update}
22544 @tab update the variable and its children
22545 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
22546 @tab set frozeness attribute
22547 @end multitable
22548
22549 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
22550 how it can be used.
22551
22552 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
22553
22554 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
22555 @findex -var-create
22556
22557 @subsubheading Synopsis
22558
22559 @smallexample
22560 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
22561 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
22562 @end smallexample
22563
22564 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
22565 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
22566 register.
22567
22568 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
22569 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
22570 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
22571 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
22572 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
22573
22574 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
22575 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
22576 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
22577 object must be created.
22578
22579 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
22580 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
22581
22582 @itemize @bullet
22583 @item
22584 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
22585
22586 @item
22587 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
22588
22589 @item
22590 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
22591 @end itemize
22592
22593 @subsubheading Result
22594
22595 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
22596 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
22597 the @value{GDBN} CLI. If a fixed variable object is bound to a
22598 specific thread, the thread is is also printed:
22599
22600 @smallexample
22601 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}"
22602 @end smallexample
22603
22604
22605 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
22606 @findex -var-delete
22607
22608 @subsubheading Synopsis
22609
22610 @smallexample
22611 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
22612 @end smallexample
22613
22614 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
22615 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
22616
22617 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
22618
22619
22620 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
22621 @findex -var-set-format
22622
22623 @subsubheading Synopsis
22624
22625 @smallexample
22626 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
22627 @end smallexample
22628
22629 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
22630 @var{format-spec}.
22631
22632 @anchor{-var-set-format}
22633 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
22634
22635 @smallexample
22636 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
22637 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
22638 @end smallexample
22639
22640 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
22641 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
22642 for pointers, etc.).
22643
22644 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
22645 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
22646
22647 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
22648 @findex -var-show-format
22649
22650 @subsubheading Synopsis
22651
22652 @smallexample
22653 -var-show-format @var{name}
22654 @end smallexample
22655
22656 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
22657
22658 @smallexample
22659 @var{format} @expansion{}
22660 @var{format-spec}
22661 @end smallexample
22662
22663
22664 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
22665 @findex -var-info-num-children
22666
22667 @subsubheading Synopsis
22668
22669 @smallexample
22670 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
22671 @end smallexample
22672
22673 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
22674
22675 @smallexample
22676 numchild=@var{n}
22677 @end smallexample
22678
22679
22680 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
22681 @findex -var-list-children
22682
22683 @subsubheading Synopsis
22684
22685 @smallexample
22686 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
22687 @end smallexample
22688 @anchor{-var-list-children}
22689
22690 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
22691 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
22692 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
22693 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
22694 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
22695 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
22696 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
22697 and unions.
22698
22699 @subsubheading Example
22700
22701 @smallexample
22702 (gdb)
22703 -var-list-children n
22704 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
22705 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
22706 (gdb)
22707 -var-list-children --all-values n
22708 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
22709 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
22710 @end smallexample
22711
22712
22713 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
22714 @findex -var-info-type
22715
22716 @subsubheading Synopsis
22717
22718 @smallexample
22719 -var-info-type @var{name}
22720 @end smallexample
22721
22722 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
22723 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
22724 @value{GDBN} CLI:
22725
22726 @smallexample
22727 type=@var{typename}
22728 @end smallexample
22729
22730
22731 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
22732 @findex -var-info-expression
22733
22734 @subsubheading Synopsis
22735
22736 @smallexample
22737 -var-info-expression @var{name}
22738 @end smallexample
22739
22740 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
22741 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
22742 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
22743
22744 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
22745 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
22746
22747 @smallexample
22748 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
22749 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
22750 @end smallexample
22751
22752 @noindent
22753 Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
22754
22755 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
22756 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
22757 is of limited use.
22758
22759 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
22760 @findex -var-info-path-expression
22761
22762 @subsubheading Synopsis
22763
22764 @smallexample
22765 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
22766 @end smallexample
22767
22768 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
22769 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
22770 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
22771 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
22772 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
22773 watchpoint from a variable object.
22774
22775 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
22776 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
22777 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
22778 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
22779 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
22780 @smallexample
22781 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
22782 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
22783 @end smallexample
22784
22785 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
22786 @findex -var-show-attributes
22787
22788 @subsubheading Synopsis
22789
22790 @smallexample
22791 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
22792 @end smallexample
22793
22794 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
22795
22796 @smallexample
22797 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
22798 @end smallexample
22799
22800 @noindent
22801 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
22802
22803 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
22804 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
22805
22806 @subsubheading Synopsis
22807
22808 @smallexample
22809 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
22810 @end smallexample
22811
22812 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
22813 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
22814 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
22815 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
22816 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
22817 the current display format will be used. The current display format
22818 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
22819
22820 @smallexample
22821 value=@var{value}
22822 @end smallexample
22823
22824 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
22825 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
22826
22827 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
22828 @findex -var-assign
22829
22830 @subsubheading Synopsis
22831
22832 @smallexample
22833 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
22834 @end smallexample
22835
22836 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
22837 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
22838 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
22839 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
22840
22841 @subsubheading Example
22842
22843 @smallexample
22844 (gdb)
22845 -var-assign var1 3
22846 ^done,value="3"
22847 (gdb)
22848 -var-update *
22849 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
22850 (gdb)
22851 @end smallexample
22852
22853 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
22854 @findex -var-update
22855
22856 @subsubheading Synopsis
22857
22858 @smallexample
22859 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
22860 @end smallexample
22861
22862 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
22863 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
22864 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
22865 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
22866 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
22867 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
22868 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
22869 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
22870 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
22871 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
22872 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
22873 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
22874 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
22875
22876 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
22877 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
22878 diagnostic.
22879
22880 @subsubheading Example
22881
22882 @smallexample
22883 (gdb)
22884 -var-assign var1 3
22885 ^done,value="3"
22886 (gdb)
22887 -var-update --all-values var1
22888 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
22889 type_changed="false"@}]
22890 (gdb)
22891 @end smallexample
22892
22893 @anchor{-var-update}
22894 The field in_scope may take three values:
22895
22896 @table @code
22897 @item "true"
22898 The variable object's current value is valid.
22899
22900 @item "false"
22901 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
22902 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
22903 scope.
22904
22905 @item "invalid"
22906 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
22907 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
22908 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
22909 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
22910 objects.
22911 @end table
22912
22913 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
22914 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
22915
22916 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
22917 @findex -var-set-frozen
22918 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
22919
22920 @subsubheading Synopsis
22921
22922 @smallexample
22923 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
22924 @end smallexample
22925
22926 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
22927 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
22928 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
22929 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
22930 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
22931 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
22932 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
22933 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
22934 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
22935 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
22936 @code{-var-update} does.
22937
22938 @subsubheading Example
22939
22940 @smallexample
22941 (gdb)
22942 -var-set-frozen V 1
22943 ^done
22944 (gdb)
22945 @end smallexample
22946
22947
22948 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22949 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
22950 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
22951
22952 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
22953 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
22954 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
22955 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
22956
22957 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
22958 @c @subheading -data-assign
22959 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
22960 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
22961 @c set variable
22962 @c @subsubheading Example
22963 @c N.A.
22964
22965 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
22966 @findex -data-disassemble
22967
22968 @subsubheading Synopsis
22969
22970 @smallexample
22971 -data-disassemble
22972 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
22973 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
22974 -- @var{mode}
22975 @end smallexample
22976
22977 @noindent
22978 Where:
22979
22980 @table @samp
22981 @item @var{start-addr}
22982 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
22983 @item @var{end-addr}
22984 is the end address
22985 @item @var{filename}
22986 is the name of the file to disassemble
22987 @item @var{linenum}
22988 is the line number to disassemble around
22989 @item @var{lines}
22990 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
22991 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
22992 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
22993 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
22994 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
22995 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
22996 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
22997 are displayed.
22998 @item @var{mode}
22999 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
23000 disassembly).
23001 @end table
23002
23003 @subsubheading Result
23004
23005 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
23006
23007 @itemize @bullet
23008 @item Address
23009 @item Func-name
23010 @item Offset
23011 @item Instruction
23012 @end itemize
23013
23014 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
23015 directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
23016
23017 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23018
23019 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
23020
23021 @subsubheading Example
23022
23023 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
23024
23025 @smallexample
23026 (gdb)
23027 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
23028 ^done,
23029 asm_insns=[
23030 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
23031 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
23032 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
23033 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
23034 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
23035 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
23036 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
23037 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
23038 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
23039 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
23040 (gdb)
23041 @end smallexample
23042
23043 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
23044 @code{main}.
23045
23046 @smallexample
23047 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
23048 ^done,asm_insns=[
23049 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
23050 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
23051 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
23052 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
23053 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
23054 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
23055 [@dots{}]
23056 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
23057 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
23058 (gdb)
23059 @end smallexample
23060
23061 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
23062
23063 @smallexample
23064 (gdb)
23065 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
23066 ^done,asm_insns=[
23067 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
23068 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
23069 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
23070 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
23071 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
23072 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
23073 (gdb)
23074 @end smallexample
23075
23076 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
23077
23078 @smallexample
23079 (gdb)
23080 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
23081 ^done,asm_insns=[
23082 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
23083 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
23084 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
23085 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
23086 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
23087 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
23088 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
23089 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
23090 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
23091 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
23092 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
23093 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
23094 (gdb)
23095 @end smallexample
23096
23097
23098 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
23099 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
23100
23101 @subsubheading Synopsis
23102
23103 @smallexample
23104 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
23105 @end smallexample
23106
23107 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
23108 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
23109 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
23110
23111 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23112
23113 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
23114 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
23115 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
23116
23117 @subsubheading Example
23118
23119 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
23120 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
23121 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
23122 output.
23123
23124 @smallexample
23125 211-data-evaluate-expression A
23126 211^done,value="1"
23127 (gdb)
23128 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
23129 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
23130 (gdb)
23131 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
23132 411^done,value="4"
23133 (gdb)
23134 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
23135 511^done,value="4"
23136 (gdb)
23137 @end smallexample
23138
23139
23140 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
23141 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
23142
23143 @subsubheading Synopsis
23144
23145 @smallexample
23146 -data-list-changed-registers
23147 @end smallexample
23148
23149 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
23150
23151 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23152
23153 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
23154 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
23155
23156 @subsubheading Example
23157
23158 On a PPC MBX board:
23159
23160 @smallexample
23161 (gdb)
23162 -exec-continue
23163 ^running
23164
23165 (gdb)
23166 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
23167 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
23168 line="5"@}
23169 (gdb)
23170 -data-list-changed-registers
23171 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
23172 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
23173 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
23174 (gdb)
23175 @end smallexample
23176
23177
23178 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
23179 @findex -data-list-register-names
23180
23181 @subsubheading Synopsis
23182
23183 @smallexample
23184 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
23185 @end smallexample
23186
23187 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
23188 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
23189 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
23190 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
23191 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
23192 include empty register names.
23193
23194 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23195
23196 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
23197 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
23198 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
23199
23200 @subsubheading Example
23201
23202 For the PPC MBX board:
23203 @smallexample
23204 (gdb)
23205 -data-list-register-names
23206 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
23207 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
23208 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
23209 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
23210 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
23211 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
23212 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
23213 (gdb)
23214 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
23215 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
23216 (gdb)
23217 @end smallexample
23218
23219 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
23220 @findex -data-list-register-values
23221
23222 @subsubheading Synopsis
23223
23224 @smallexample
23225 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
23226 @end smallexample
23227
23228 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
23229 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
23230 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
23231 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
23232
23233 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
23234
23235 @table @code
23236 @item x
23237 Hexadecimal
23238 @item o
23239 Octal
23240 @item t
23241 Binary
23242 @item d
23243 Decimal
23244 @item r
23245 Raw
23246 @item N
23247 Natural
23248 @end table
23249
23250 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23251
23252 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
23253 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
23254
23255 @subsubheading Example
23256
23257 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
23258 don't appear in the actual output):
23259
23260 @smallexample
23261 (gdb)
23262 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
23263 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
23264 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
23265 (gdb)
23266 -data-list-register-values x
23267 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
23268 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
23269 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
23270 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
23271 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
23272 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
23273 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
23274 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
23275 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
23276 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
23277 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
23278 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
23279 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
23280 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
23281 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
23282 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
23283 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
23284 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
23285 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
23286 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
23287 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
23288 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
23289 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
23290 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
23291 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
23292 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
23293 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
23294 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
23295 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
23296 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
23297 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
23298 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
23299 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
23300 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
23301 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
23302 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
23303 (gdb)
23304 @end smallexample
23305
23306
23307 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
23308 @findex -data-read-memory
23309
23310 @subsubheading Synopsis
23311
23312 @smallexample
23313 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
23314 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
23315 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
23316 @end smallexample
23317
23318 @noindent
23319 where:
23320
23321 @table @samp
23322 @item @var{address}
23323 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
23324 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
23325 quoted using the C convention.
23326
23327 @item @var{word-format}
23328 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
23329 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
23330 ,Output Formats}).
23331
23332 @item @var{word-size}
23333 The size of each memory word in bytes.
23334
23335 @item @var{nr-rows}
23336 The number of rows in the output table.
23337
23338 @item @var{nr-cols}
23339 The number of columns in the output table.
23340
23341 @item @var{aschar}
23342 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
23343 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
23344 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
23345 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
23346
23347 @item @var{byte-offset}
23348 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
23349 @end table
23350
23351 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
23352 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
23353 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
23354 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
23355 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
23356 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
23357 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
23358 @samp{addr}.
23359
23360 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
23361 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
23362 @samp{prev-page}.
23363
23364 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23365
23366 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
23367 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
23368
23369 @subsubheading Example
23370
23371 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
23372 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
23373 word. Display each word in hex.
23374
23375 @smallexample
23376 (gdb)
23377 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
23378 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
23379 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
23380 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
23381 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
23382 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
23383 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
23384 (gdb)
23385 @end smallexample
23386
23387 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
23388 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
23389
23390 @smallexample
23391 (gdb)
23392 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
23393 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
23394 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
23395 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
23396 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
23397 (gdb)
23398 @end smallexample
23399
23400 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
23401 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
23402 used as the non-printable character.
23403
23404 @smallexample
23405 (gdb)
23406 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
23407 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
23408 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
23409 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
23410 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
23411 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
23412 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
23413 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
23414 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
23415 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
23416 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
23417 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
23418 (gdb)
23419 @end smallexample
23420
23421 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23422 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
23423 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
23424
23425 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
23426
23427 @c @subheading -trace-actions
23428
23429 @c @subheading -trace-delete
23430
23431 @c @subheading -trace-disable
23432
23433 @c @subheading -trace-dump
23434
23435 @c @subheading -trace-enable
23436
23437 @c @subheading -trace-exists
23438
23439 @c @subheading -trace-find
23440
23441 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
23442
23443 @c @subheading -trace-info
23444
23445 @c @subheading -trace-insert
23446
23447 @c @subheading -trace-list
23448
23449 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
23450
23451 @c @subheading -trace-save
23452
23453 @c @subheading -trace-start
23454
23455 @c @subheading -trace-stop
23456
23457
23458 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23459 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
23460 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
23461
23462
23463 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
23464 @findex -symbol-info-address
23465
23466 @subsubheading Synopsis
23467
23468 @smallexample
23469 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
23470 @end smallexample
23471
23472 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
23473
23474 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23475
23476 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
23477
23478 @subsubheading Example
23479 N.A.
23480
23481
23482 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
23483 @findex -symbol-info-file
23484
23485 @subsubheading Synopsis
23486
23487 @smallexample
23488 -symbol-info-file
23489 @end smallexample
23490
23491 Show the file for the symbol.
23492
23493 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23494
23495 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
23496 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
23497
23498 @subsubheading Example
23499 N.A.
23500
23501
23502 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
23503 @findex -symbol-info-function
23504
23505 @subsubheading Synopsis
23506
23507 @smallexample
23508 -symbol-info-function
23509 @end smallexample
23510
23511 Show which function the symbol lives in.
23512
23513 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23514
23515 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
23516
23517 @subsubheading Example
23518 N.A.
23519
23520
23521 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
23522 @findex -symbol-info-line
23523
23524 @subsubheading Synopsis
23525
23526 @smallexample
23527 -symbol-info-line
23528 @end smallexample
23529
23530 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
23531
23532 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23533
23534 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
23535 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
23536
23537 @subsubheading Example
23538 N.A.
23539
23540
23541 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
23542 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
23543
23544 @subsubheading Synopsis
23545
23546 @smallexample
23547 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
23548 @end smallexample
23549
23550 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
23551
23552 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23553
23554 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
23555
23556 @subsubheading Example
23557 N.A.
23558
23559
23560 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
23561 @findex -symbol-list-functions
23562
23563 @subsubheading Synopsis
23564
23565 @smallexample
23566 -symbol-list-functions
23567 @end smallexample
23568
23569 List the functions in the executable.
23570
23571 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23572
23573 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
23574 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
23575
23576 @subsubheading Example
23577 N.A.
23578
23579
23580 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
23581 @findex -symbol-list-lines
23582
23583 @subsubheading Synopsis
23584
23585 @smallexample
23586 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
23587 @end smallexample
23588
23589 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
23590 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
23591 ascending PC order.
23592
23593 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23594
23595 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
23596
23597 @subsubheading Example
23598 @smallexample
23599 (gdb)
23600 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
23601 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
23602 (gdb)
23603 @end smallexample
23604
23605
23606 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
23607 @findex -symbol-list-types
23608
23609 @subsubheading Synopsis
23610
23611 @smallexample
23612 -symbol-list-types
23613 @end smallexample
23614
23615 List all the type names.
23616
23617 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23618
23619 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
23620 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
23621
23622 @subsubheading Example
23623 N.A.
23624
23625
23626 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
23627 @findex -symbol-list-variables
23628
23629 @subsubheading Synopsis
23630
23631 @smallexample
23632 -symbol-list-variables
23633 @end smallexample
23634
23635 List all the global and static variable names.
23636
23637 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23638
23639 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
23640
23641 @subsubheading Example
23642 N.A.
23643
23644
23645 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
23646 @findex -symbol-locate
23647
23648 @subsubheading Synopsis
23649
23650 @smallexample
23651 -symbol-locate
23652 @end smallexample
23653
23654 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23655
23656 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
23657
23658 @subsubheading Example
23659 N.A.
23660
23661
23662 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
23663 @findex -symbol-type
23664
23665 @subsubheading Synopsis
23666
23667 @smallexample
23668 -symbol-type @var{variable}
23669 @end smallexample
23670
23671 Show type of @var{variable}.
23672
23673 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23674
23675 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
23676 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
23677
23678 @subsubheading Example
23679 N.A.
23680
23681
23682 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23683 @node GDB/MI File Commands
23684 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
23685
23686 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
23687 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
23688
23689 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
23690 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
23691
23692 @subsubheading Synopsis
23693
23694 @smallexample
23695 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
23696 @end smallexample
23697
23698 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
23699 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
23700 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
23701 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
23702 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
23703 notification.
23704
23705 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23706
23707 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
23708
23709 @subsubheading Example
23710
23711 @smallexample
23712 (gdb)
23713 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
23714 ^done
23715 (gdb)
23716 @end smallexample
23717
23718
23719 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
23720 @findex -file-exec-file
23721
23722 @subsubheading Synopsis
23723
23724 @smallexample
23725 -file-exec-file @var{file}
23726 @end smallexample
23727
23728 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
23729 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
23730 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
23731 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
23732 notification.
23733
23734 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23735
23736 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
23737
23738 @subsubheading Example
23739
23740 @smallexample
23741 (gdb)
23742 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
23743 ^done
23744 (gdb)
23745 @end smallexample
23746
23747
23748 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
23749 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
23750
23751 @subsubheading Synopsis
23752
23753 @smallexample
23754 -file-list-exec-sections
23755 @end smallexample
23756
23757 List the sections of the current executable file.
23758
23759 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23760
23761 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
23762 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
23763 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
23764
23765 @subsubheading Example
23766 N.A.
23767
23768
23769 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
23770 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
23771
23772 @subsubheading Synopsis
23773
23774 @smallexample
23775 -file-list-exec-source-file
23776 @end smallexample
23777
23778 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
23779 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
23780 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
23781 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
23782
23783 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23784
23785 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
23786
23787 @subsubheading Example
23788
23789 @smallexample
23790 (gdb)
23791 123-file-list-exec-source-file
23792 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
23793 (gdb)
23794 @end smallexample
23795
23796
23797 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
23798 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
23799
23800 @subsubheading Synopsis
23801
23802 @smallexample
23803 -file-list-exec-source-files
23804 @end smallexample
23805
23806 List the source files for the current executable.
23807
23808 It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
23809 the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
23810
23811 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23812
23813 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
23814 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
23815
23816 @subsubheading Example
23817 @smallexample
23818 (gdb)
23819 -file-list-exec-source-files
23820 ^done,files=[
23821 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
23822 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
23823 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
23824 (gdb)
23825 @end smallexample
23826
23827 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
23828 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
23829
23830 @subsubheading Synopsis
23831
23832 @smallexample
23833 -file-list-shared-libraries
23834 @end smallexample
23835
23836 List the shared libraries in the program.
23837
23838 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23839
23840 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
23841
23842 @subsubheading Example
23843 N.A.
23844
23845
23846 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
23847 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
23848
23849 @subsubheading Synopsis
23850
23851 @smallexample
23852 -file-list-symbol-files
23853 @end smallexample
23854
23855 List symbol files.
23856
23857 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23858
23859 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
23860
23861 @subsubheading Example
23862 N.A.
23863
23864
23865 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
23866 @findex -file-symbol-file
23867
23868 @subsubheading Synopsis
23869
23870 @smallexample
23871 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
23872 @end smallexample
23873
23874 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
23875 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
23876 produced, except for a completion notification.
23877
23878 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23879
23880 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
23881
23882 @subsubheading Example
23883
23884 @smallexample
23885 (gdb)
23886 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
23887 ^done
23888 (gdb)
23889 @end smallexample
23890
23891 @ignore
23892 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23893 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
23894 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
23895
23896 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
23897
23898 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
23899
23900 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
23901
23902 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
23903
23904 @c @subheading -overlay-map
23905
23906 @c @subheading -overlay-off
23907
23908 @c @subheading -overlay-on
23909
23910 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
23911
23912 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23913 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
23914 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
23915
23916 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
23917
23918 @c @subheading -signal-handle
23919
23920 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
23921
23922 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
23923 @end ignore
23924
23925
23926 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23927 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
23928 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
23929
23930
23931 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
23932 @findex -target-attach
23933
23934 @subsubheading Synopsis
23935
23936 @smallexample
23937 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
23938 @end smallexample
23939
23940 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
23941 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
23942 group, the id previously returned by
23943 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
23944
23945 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23946
23947 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
23948
23949 @subsubheading Example
23950 @smallexample
23951 (gdb)
23952 -target-attach 34
23953 =thread-created,id="1"
23954 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
23955 ^done
23956 (gdb)
23957 @end smallexample
23958
23959 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
23960 @findex -target-compare-sections
23961
23962 @subsubheading Synopsis
23963
23964 @smallexample
23965 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
23966 @end smallexample
23967
23968 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
23969 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
23970
23971 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23972
23973 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
23974
23975 @subsubheading Example
23976 N.A.
23977
23978
23979 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
23980 @findex -target-detach
23981
23982 @subsubheading Synopsis
23983
23984 @smallexample
23985 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
23986 @end smallexample
23987
23988 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
23989 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
23990 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
23991
23992 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23993
23994 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
23995
23996 @subsubheading Example
23997
23998 @smallexample
23999 (gdb)
24000 -target-detach
24001 ^done
24002 (gdb)
24003 @end smallexample
24004
24005
24006 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
24007 @findex -target-disconnect
24008
24009 @subsubheading Synopsis
24010
24011 @smallexample
24012 -target-disconnect
24013 @end smallexample
24014
24015 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
24016 generally not resumed.
24017
24018 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24019
24020 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
24021
24022 @subsubheading Example
24023
24024 @smallexample
24025 (gdb)
24026 -target-disconnect
24027 ^done
24028 (gdb)
24029 @end smallexample
24030
24031
24032 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
24033 @findex -target-download
24034
24035 @subsubheading Synopsis
24036
24037 @smallexample
24038 -target-download
24039 @end smallexample
24040
24041 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
24042 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
24043
24044 @table @samp
24045 @item section
24046 The name of the section.
24047 @item section-sent
24048 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
24049 @item section-size
24050 The size of the section.
24051 @item total-sent
24052 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
24053 @item total-size
24054 The size of the overall executable to download.
24055 @end table
24056
24057 @noindent
24058 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
24059 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
24060
24061 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
24062 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
24063
24064 @table @samp
24065 @item section
24066 The name of the section.
24067 @item section-size
24068 The size of the section.
24069 @item total-size
24070 The size of the overall executable to download.
24071 @end table
24072
24073 @noindent
24074 At the end, a summary is printed.
24075
24076 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24077
24078 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
24079
24080 @subsubheading Example
24081
24082 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
24083 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
24084
24085 @smallexample
24086 (gdb)
24087 -target-download
24088 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
24089 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
24090 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
24091 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
24092 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
24093 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
24094 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
24095 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
24096 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
24097 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
24098 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
24099 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
24100 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
24101 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
24102 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
24103 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
24104 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
24105 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
24106 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
24107 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
24108 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
24109 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
24110 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
24111 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
24112 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
24113 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
24114 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
24115 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
24116 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
24117 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
24118 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
24119 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
24120 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
24121 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
24122 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
24123 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
24124 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
24125 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
24126 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
24127 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
24128 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
24129 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
24130 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
24131 write-rate="429"
24132 (gdb)
24133 @end smallexample
24134
24135
24136 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
24137 @findex -target-exec-status
24138
24139 @subsubheading Synopsis
24140
24141 @smallexample
24142 -target-exec-status
24143 @end smallexample
24144
24145 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
24146 not, for instance).
24147
24148 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24149
24150 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
24151
24152 @subsubheading Example
24153 N.A.
24154
24155
24156 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
24157 @findex -target-list-available-targets
24158
24159 @subsubheading Synopsis
24160
24161 @smallexample
24162 -target-list-available-targets
24163 @end smallexample
24164
24165 List the possible targets to connect to.
24166
24167 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24168
24169 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
24170
24171 @subsubheading Example
24172 N.A.
24173
24174
24175 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
24176 @findex -target-list-current-targets
24177
24178 @subsubheading Synopsis
24179
24180 @smallexample
24181 -target-list-current-targets
24182 @end smallexample
24183
24184 Describe the current target.
24185
24186 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24187
24188 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
24189 other things).
24190
24191 @subsubheading Example
24192 N.A.
24193
24194
24195 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
24196 @findex -target-list-parameters
24197
24198 @subsubheading Synopsis
24199
24200 @smallexample
24201 -target-list-parameters
24202 @end smallexample
24203
24204 @c ????
24205
24206 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24207
24208 No equivalent.
24209
24210 @subsubheading Example
24211 N.A.
24212
24213
24214 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
24215 @findex -target-select
24216
24217 @subsubheading Synopsis
24218
24219 @smallexample
24220 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
24221 @end smallexample
24222
24223 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
24224
24225 @table @samp
24226 @item @var{type}
24227 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
24228 @item @var{parameters}
24229 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
24230 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
24231 @end table
24232
24233 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
24234 which the target program is, in the following form:
24235
24236 @smallexample
24237 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
24238 args=[@var{arg list}]
24239 @end smallexample
24240
24241 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24242
24243 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
24244
24245 @subsubheading Example
24246
24247 @smallexample
24248 (gdb)
24249 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
24250 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
24251 (gdb)
24252 @end smallexample
24253
24254 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24255 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
24256 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
24257
24258
24259 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
24260 @findex -target-file-put
24261
24262 @subsubheading Synopsis
24263
24264 @smallexample
24265 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
24266 @end smallexample
24267
24268 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
24269 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
24270
24271 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24272
24273 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
24274
24275 @subsubheading Example
24276
24277 @smallexample
24278 (gdb)
24279 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
24280 ^done
24281 (gdb)
24282 @end smallexample
24283
24284
24285 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
24286 @findex -target-file-get
24287
24288 @subsubheading Synopsis
24289
24290 @smallexample
24291 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
24292 @end smallexample
24293
24294 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
24295 on the host system.
24296
24297 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24298
24299 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
24300
24301 @subsubheading Example
24302
24303 @smallexample
24304 (gdb)
24305 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
24306 ^done
24307 (gdb)
24308 @end smallexample
24309
24310
24311 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
24312 @findex -target-file-delete
24313
24314 @subsubheading Synopsis
24315
24316 @smallexample
24317 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
24318 @end smallexample
24319
24320 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
24321
24322 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24323
24324 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
24325
24326 @subsubheading Example
24327
24328 @smallexample
24329 (gdb)
24330 -target-file-delete remotefile
24331 ^done
24332 (gdb)
24333 @end smallexample
24334
24335
24336 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24337 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
24338 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
24339
24340 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
24341
24342 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
24343 @findex -gdb-exit
24344
24345 @subsubheading Synopsis
24346
24347 @smallexample
24348 -gdb-exit
24349 @end smallexample
24350
24351 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
24352
24353 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24354
24355 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
24356
24357 @subsubheading Example
24358
24359 @smallexample
24360 (gdb)
24361 -gdb-exit
24362 ^exit
24363 @end smallexample
24364
24365
24366 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
24367 @findex -exec-abort
24368
24369 @subsubheading Synopsis
24370
24371 @smallexample
24372 -exec-abort
24373 @end smallexample
24374
24375 Kill the inferior running program.
24376
24377 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24378
24379 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
24380
24381 @subsubheading Example
24382 N.A.
24383
24384
24385 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
24386 @findex -gdb-set
24387
24388 @subsubheading Synopsis
24389
24390 @smallexample
24391 -gdb-set
24392 @end smallexample
24393
24394 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
24395 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
24396
24397 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24398
24399 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
24400
24401 @subsubheading Example
24402
24403 @smallexample
24404 (gdb)
24405 -gdb-set $foo=3
24406 ^done
24407 (gdb)
24408 @end smallexample
24409
24410
24411 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
24412 @findex -gdb-show
24413
24414 @subsubheading Synopsis
24415
24416 @smallexample
24417 -gdb-show
24418 @end smallexample
24419
24420 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
24421
24422 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24423
24424 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
24425
24426 @subsubheading Example
24427
24428 @smallexample
24429 (gdb)
24430 -gdb-show annotate
24431 ^done,value="0"
24432 (gdb)
24433 @end smallexample
24434
24435 @c @subheading -gdb-source
24436
24437
24438 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
24439 @findex -gdb-version
24440
24441 @subsubheading Synopsis
24442
24443 @smallexample
24444 -gdb-version
24445 @end smallexample
24446
24447 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
24448
24449 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24450
24451 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
24452 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
24453
24454 @subsubheading Example
24455
24456 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
24457 @c box in TeX.
24458 @smallexample
24459 (gdb)
24460 -gdb-version
24461 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
24462 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
24463 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
24464 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
24465 ~ certain conditions.
24466 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
24467 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
24468 ~ details.
24469 ~This GDB was configured as
24470 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
24471 ^done
24472 (gdb)
24473 @end smallexample
24474
24475 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
24476 @findex -list-features
24477
24478 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
24479 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
24480 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
24481 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
24482 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
24483 startup.
24484
24485 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
24486 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
24487 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
24488 is given below.
24489
24490 Example output:
24491
24492 @smallexample
24493 (gdb) -list-features
24494 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
24495 @end smallexample
24496
24497 The current list of features is:
24498
24499 @table @samp
24500 @item frozen-varobjs
24501 Indicates presence of the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
24502 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
24503 of @code{-varobj-create}.
24504 @item pending-breakpoints
24505 Indicates presence of the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert} command.
24506 @item thread-info
24507 Indicates presence of the @code{-thread-info} command.
24508
24509 @end table
24510
24511 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
24512 @findex -list-target-features
24513
24514 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
24515 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
24516 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
24517 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
24518 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
24519 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
24520 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
24521 Example output:
24522
24523 @smallexample
24524 (gdb) -list-features
24525 ^done,result=["async"]
24526 @end smallexample
24527
24528 The current list of features is:
24529
24530 @table @samp
24531 @item async
24532 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
24533 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
24534 while the target is running.
24535
24536 @end table
24537
24538 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
24539 @findex -list-thread-groups
24540
24541 @subheading Synopsis
24542
24543 @smallexample
24544 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ @var{group} ]
24545 @end smallexample
24546
24547 When used without the @var{group} parameter, lists top-level thread
24548 groups that are being debugged. When used with the @var{group}
24549 parameter, the children of the specified group are listed. The
24550 children can be either threads, or other groups. At present,
24551 @value{GDBN} will not report both threads and groups as children at
24552 the same time, but it may change in future.
24553
24554 With the @samp{--available} option, instead of reporting groups that
24555 are been debugged, GDB will report all thread groups available on the
24556 target. Using the @samp{--available} option together with @var{group}
24557 is not allowed.
24558
24559 @subheading Example
24560
24561 @smallexample
24562 @value{GDBP}
24563 -list-thread-groups
24564 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
24565 -list-thread-groups 17
24566 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
24567 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
24568 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
24569 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
24570 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
24571 @end smallexample
24572
24573 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
24574 @findex -interpreter-exec
24575
24576 @subheading Synopsis
24577
24578 @smallexample
24579 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
24580 @end smallexample
24581 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
24582
24583 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
24584
24585 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
24586
24587 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
24588
24589 @subheading Example
24590
24591 @smallexample
24592 (gdb)
24593 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
24594 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
24595 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
24596 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
24597 ^done
24598 (gdb)
24599 @end smallexample
24600
24601 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
24602 @findex -inferior-tty-set
24603
24604 @subheading Synopsis
24605
24606 @smallexample
24607 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
24608 @end smallexample
24609
24610 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
24611
24612 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
24613
24614 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
24615
24616 @subheading Example
24617
24618 @smallexample
24619 (gdb)
24620 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
24621 ^done
24622 (gdb)
24623 @end smallexample
24624
24625 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
24626 @findex -inferior-tty-show
24627
24628 @subheading Synopsis
24629
24630 @smallexample
24631 -inferior-tty-show
24632 @end smallexample
24633
24634 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
24635
24636 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
24637
24638 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
24639
24640 @subheading Example
24641
24642 @smallexample
24643 (gdb)
24644 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
24645 ^done
24646 (gdb)
24647 -inferior-tty-show
24648 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
24649 (gdb)
24650 @end smallexample
24651
24652 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
24653 @findex -enable-timings
24654
24655 @subheading Synopsis
24656
24657 @smallexample
24658 -enable-timings [yes | no]
24659 @end smallexample
24660
24661 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
24662 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
24663 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
24664 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
24665
24666 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
24667
24668 No equivalent.
24669
24670 @subheading Example
24671
24672 @smallexample
24673 (gdb)
24674 -enable-timings
24675 ^done
24676 (gdb)
24677 -break-insert main
24678 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
24679 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
24680 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
24681 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
24682 (gdb)
24683 -enable-timings no
24684 ^done
24685 (gdb)
24686 -exec-run
24687 ^running
24688 (gdb)
24689 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
24690 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
24691 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
24692 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
24693 (gdb)
24694 @end smallexample
24695
24696 @node Annotations
24697 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
24698
24699 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
24700 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
24701 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
24702 relatively high level.
24703
24704 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
24705 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
24706
24707 @ignore
24708 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
24709 @end ignore
24710
24711 @menu
24712 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
24713 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
24714 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
24715 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
24716 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
24717 * Annotations for Running::
24718 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
24719 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
24720 @end menu
24721
24722 @node Annotations Overview
24723 @section What is an Annotation?
24724 @cindex annotations
24725
24726 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
24727 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
24728 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
24729 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
24730 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
24731 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
24732 cannot contain newline characters.
24733
24734 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
24735 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
24736 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
24737 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
24738 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
24739 means those three characters as output.
24740
24741 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
24742 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
24743 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
24744 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
24745 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
24746 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
24747 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
24748 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
24749 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
24750
24751 @table @code
24752 @kindex set annotate
24753 @item set annotate @var{level}
24754 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
24755 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
24756
24757 @item show annotate
24758 @kindex show annotate
24759 Show the current annotation level.
24760 @end table
24761
24762 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
24763
24764 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
24765
24766 @smallexample
24767 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
24768 GNU gdb 6.0
24769 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
24770 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
24771 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
24772 under certain conditions.
24773 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
24774 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
24775 for details.
24776 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
24777
24778 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
24779 (@value{GDBP})
24780 ^Z^Zprompt
24781 @kbd{quit}
24782
24783 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
24784 $
24785 @end smallexample
24786
24787 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
24788 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
24789 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
24790 output from @value{GDBN}.
24791
24792 @node Server Prefix
24793 @section The Server Prefix
24794 @cindex server prefix
24795
24796 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
24797 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
24798 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
24799 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
24800 a transparent manner.
24801
24802 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
24803 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
24804 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
24805
24806 @node Prompting
24807 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
24808
24809 @cindex annotations for prompts
24810 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
24811 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
24812 over, etc.
24813
24814 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
24815 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
24816 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
24817 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
24818 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
24819 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
24820 features the following annotations:
24821
24822 @smallexample
24823 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
24824 ^Z^Zprompt
24825 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
24826 @end smallexample
24827
24828 The input types are
24829
24830 @table @code
24831 @findex pre-prompt annotation
24832 @findex prompt annotation
24833 @findex post-prompt annotation
24834 @item prompt
24835 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
24836
24837 @findex pre-commands annotation
24838 @findex commands annotation
24839 @findex post-commands annotation
24840 @item commands
24841 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
24842 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
24843
24844 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
24845 @findex overload-choice annotation
24846 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
24847 @item overload-choice
24848 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
24849
24850 @findex pre-query annotation
24851 @findex query annotation
24852 @findex post-query annotation
24853 @item query
24854 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
24855
24856 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
24857 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
24858 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
24859 @item prompt-for-continue
24860 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
24861 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
24862 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
24863 presence of annotations.
24864 @end table
24865
24866 @node Errors
24867 @section Errors
24868 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
24869
24870 @findex quit annotation
24871 @smallexample
24872 ^Z^Zquit
24873 @end smallexample
24874
24875 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
24876
24877 @findex error annotation
24878 @smallexample
24879 ^Z^Zerror
24880 @end smallexample
24881
24882 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
24883
24884 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
24885 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
24886 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
24887 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
24888 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
24889 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
24890 to the top level.
24891
24892 @findex error-begin annotation
24893 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
24894
24895 @smallexample
24896 ^Z^Zerror-begin
24897 @end smallexample
24898
24899 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
24900 message.
24901
24902 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
24903 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
24904 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
24905
24906 @node Invalidation
24907 @section Invalidation Notices
24908
24909 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
24910 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
24911 changed.
24912
24913 @table @code
24914 @findex frames-invalid annotation
24915 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
24916
24917 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
24918 have changed.
24919
24920 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
24921 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
24922
24923 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
24924 deleted a breakpoint.
24925 @end table
24926
24927 @node Annotations for Running
24928 @section Running the Program
24929 @cindex annotations for running programs
24930
24931 @findex starting annotation
24932 @findex stopping annotation
24933 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
24934 @code{step} or @code{continue},
24935
24936 @smallexample
24937 ^Z^Zstarting
24938 @end smallexample
24939
24940 is output. When the program stops,
24941
24942 @smallexample
24943 ^Z^Zstopped
24944 @end smallexample
24945
24946 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
24947 annotations describe how the program stopped.
24948
24949 @table @code
24950 @findex exited annotation
24951 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
24952 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
24953 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
24954
24955 @findex signalled annotation
24956 @findex signal-name annotation
24957 @findex signal-name-end annotation
24958 @findex signal-string annotation
24959 @findex signal-string-end annotation
24960 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
24961 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
24962 annotation continues:
24963
24964 @smallexample
24965 @var{intro-text}
24966 ^Z^Zsignal-name
24967 @var{name}
24968 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
24969 @var{middle-text}
24970 ^Z^Zsignal-string
24971 @var{string}
24972 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
24973 @var{end-text}
24974 @end smallexample
24975
24976 @noindent
24977 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
24978 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
24979 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
24980 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
24981 user's benefit and have no particular format.
24982
24983 @findex signal annotation
24984 @item ^Z^Zsignal
24985 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
24986 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
24987 terminated with it.
24988
24989 @findex breakpoint annotation
24990 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
24991 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
24992
24993 @findex watchpoint annotation
24994 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
24995 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
24996 @end table
24997
24998 @node Source Annotations
24999 @section Displaying Source
25000 @cindex annotations for source display
25001
25002 @findex source annotation
25003 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
25004
25005 @smallexample
25006 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
25007 @end smallexample
25008
25009 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
25010 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
25011 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
25012 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
25013 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
25014 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
25015 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
25016 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
25017 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
25018 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
25019 depend on the language).
25020
25021 @node GDB Bugs
25022 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
25023 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
25024 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
25025
25026 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
25027
25028 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
25029 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
25030 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
25031 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
25032
25033 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
25034 information that enables us to fix the bug.
25035
25036 @menu
25037 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
25038 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
25039 @end menu
25040
25041 @node Bug Criteria
25042 @section Have You Found a Bug?
25043 @cindex bug criteria
25044
25045 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
25046
25047 @itemize @bullet
25048 @cindex fatal signal
25049 @cindex debugger crash
25050 @cindex crash of debugger
25051 @item
25052 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
25053 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
25054
25055 @cindex error on valid input
25056 @item
25057 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
25058 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
25059 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
25060
25061 @cindex invalid input
25062 @item
25063 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
25064 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
25065 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
25066 for traditional practice''.
25067
25068 @item
25069 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
25070 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
25071 @end itemize
25072
25073 @node Bug Reporting
25074 @section How to Report Bugs
25075 @cindex bug reports
25076 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
25077
25078 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
25079 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
25080 contact that organization first.
25081
25082 You can find contact information for many support companies and
25083 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
25084 distribution.
25085 @c should add a web page ref...
25086
25087 @ifset BUGURL
25088 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
25089 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
25090 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
25091 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
25092 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
25093 be used.
25094
25095 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
25096 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
25097 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
25098 @samp{bug-gdb}.
25099
25100 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
25101 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
25102 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
25103 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
25104 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
25105 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
25106 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
25107 bug reports to the mailing list.
25108 @end ifset
25109 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
25110 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
25111 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
25112 @end ifclear
25113 @end ifset
25114
25115 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
25116 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
25117 fact or leave it out, state it!
25118
25119 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
25120 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
25121 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
25122 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
25123 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
25124 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
25125 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
25126 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
25127 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
25128
25129 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
25130 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
25131 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
25132 self-contained.
25133
25134 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
25135 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
25136 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
25137 bugs properly.
25138
25139 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
25140
25141 @itemize @bullet
25142 @item
25143 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
25144 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
25145 version}.
25146
25147 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
25148 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
25149
25150 @item
25151 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
25152 version number.
25153
25154 @item
25155 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
25156 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
25157
25158 @item
25159 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
25160 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
25161 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
25162 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
25163 those compilers.
25164
25165 @item
25166 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
25167 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
25168 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
25169 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
25170
25171 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
25172 and then we might not encounter the bug.
25173
25174 @item
25175 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
25176 reproduce the bug.
25177
25178 @item
25179 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
25180 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
25181
25182 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
25183 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
25184 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
25185 a chance to make a mistake.
25186
25187 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
25188 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
25189 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
25190 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
25191 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
25192 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
25193 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
25194 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
25195
25196 @pindex script
25197 @cindex recording a session script
25198 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
25199 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
25200 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
25201 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
25202
25203 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
25204 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
25205
25206 @item
25207 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
25208 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
25209 it by context, not by line number.
25210
25211 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
25212 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
25213
25214 @end itemize
25215
25216 Here are some things that are not necessary:
25217
25218 @itemize @bullet
25219 @item
25220 A description of the envelope of the bug.
25221
25222 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
25223 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
25224 changes will not affect it.
25225
25226 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
25227 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
25228 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
25229 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
25230
25231 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
25232 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
25233 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
25234 less time, and so on.
25235
25236 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
25237 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
25238
25239 @item
25240 A patch for the bug.
25241
25242 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
25243 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
25244 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
25245 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
25246
25247 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
25248 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
25249 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
25250 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
25251
25252 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
25253 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
25254 help us to understand.
25255
25256 @item
25257 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
25258
25259 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
25260 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
25261 @end itemize
25262
25263 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
25264 @c and consists of the two following files:
25265 @c rluser.texinfo
25266 @c inc-hist.texinfo
25267 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
25268 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
25269 @include rluser.texi
25270 @include inc-hist.texinfo
25271
25272
25273 @node Formatting Documentation
25274 @appendix Formatting Documentation
25275
25276 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
25277 @cindex reference card
25278 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
25279 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
25280 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
25281 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
25282 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
25283 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
25284
25285 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
25286 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
25287
25288 @smallexample
25289 make refcard.dvi
25290 @end smallexample
25291
25292 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
25293 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
25294 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
25295 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
25296 your @sc{dvi} output program.
25297
25298 @cindex documentation
25299
25300 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
25301 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
25302 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
25303 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
25304 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
25305 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
25306
25307 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
25308 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
25309 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
25310 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
25311 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
25312 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
25313 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
25314 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
25315
25316 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
25317 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
25318 @code{makeinfo}.
25319
25320 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
25321 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
25322 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
25323
25324 @smallexample
25325 cd gdb
25326 make gdb.info
25327 @end smallexample
25328
25329 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
25330 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
25331 Texinfo definitions file.
25332
25333 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
25334 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
25335 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
25336 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
25337 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
25338 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
25339 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
25340
25341 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
25342 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
25343 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
25344 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
25345 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
25346 directory.
25347
25348 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
25349 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
25350 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
25351 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
25352
25353 @smallexample
25354 make gdb.dvi
25355 @end smallexample
25356
25357 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
25358
25359 @node Installing GDB
25360 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
25361 @cindex installation
25362
25363 @menu
25364 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
25365 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
25366 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
25367 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
25368 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
25369 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
25370 @end menu
25371
25372 @node Requirements
25373 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
25374 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
25375
25376 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
25377 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
25378
25379 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
25380 @table @asis
25381 @item ISO C90 compiler
25382 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
25383 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
25384
25385 @end table
25386
25387 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
25388 @table @asis
25389 @item Expat
25390 @anchor{Expat}
25391 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
25392 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
25393 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
25394 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
25395 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
25396 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
25397
25398 Expat is used for:
25399
25400 @itemize @bullet
25401 @item
25402 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
25403 @item
25404 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
25405 @item
25406 Remote shared library lists (@pxref{Library List Format})
25407 @item
25408 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
25409 @end itemize
25410
25411 @item zlib
25412 @cindex compressed debug sections
25413 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
25414 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
25415 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
25416 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
25417 information in such binaries.
25418
25419 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
25420 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
25421 @url{http://zlib.net}.
25422
25423 @item iconv
25424 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
25425 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
25426 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
25427 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
25428
25429 On systems with @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
25430 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
25431 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
25432
25433 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
25434 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
25435 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
25436 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
25437 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
25438 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
25439 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
25440 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
25441 @end table
25442
25443 @node Running Configure
25444 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
25445 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
25446 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
25447 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
25448 build the @code{gdb} program.
25449 @iftex
25450 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
25451 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
25452 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
25453 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
25454 @end iftex
25455
25456 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
25457 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
25458 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
25459
25460 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
25461 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
25462
25463 @table @code
25464 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
25465 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
25466
25467 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
25468 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
25469
25470 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
25471 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
25472
25473 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
25474 @sc{gnu} include files
25475
25476 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
25477 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
25478
25479 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
25480 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
25481
25482 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
25483 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
25484
25485 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
25486 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
25487
25488 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
25489 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
25490 @end table
25491
25492 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
25493 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
25494 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
25495
25496 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
25497 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
25498 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
25499 argument.
25500
25501 For example:
25502
25503 @smallexample
25504 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
25505 ./configure @var{host}
25506 make
25507 @end smallexample
25508
25509 @noindent
25510 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
25511 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
25512 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
25513 correct value by examining your system.)
25514
25515 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
25516 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
25517 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
25518 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
25519
25520 @need 750
25521 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
25522 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
25523 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
25524
25525 @smallexample
25526 sh configure @var{host}
25527 @end smallexample
25528
25529 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
25530 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
25531 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
25532 @file{configure}
25533 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
25534 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
25535
25536 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
25537 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
25538 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
25539 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
25540 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
25541 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
25542 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
25543 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
25544 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
25545
25546 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
25547 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
25548 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
25549 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
25550 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
25551
25552 @node Separate Objdir
25553 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
25554
25555 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
25556 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
25557 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
25558 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
25559 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
25560 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
25561 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
25562 program specified there.
25563
25564 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
25565 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
25566 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
25567 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
25568 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
25569 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
25570
25571 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
25572 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
25573
25574 @smallexample
25575 @group
25576 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
25577 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
25578 cd ../gdb-sun4
25579 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
25580 make
25581 @end group
25582 @end smallexample
25583
25584 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
25585 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
25586 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
25587 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
25588 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
25589 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
25590
25591 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
25592 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
25593 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
25594 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
25595 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
25596
25597 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
25598 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
25599 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
25600 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
25601 You specify a cross-debugging target by
25602 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
25603
25604 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
25605 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
25606 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
25607
25608 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
25609 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
25610 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
25611 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
25612 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
25613
25614 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
25615 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
25616 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
25617 with each other.
25618
25619 @node Config Names
25620 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
25621
25622 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
25623 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
25624 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
25625 of information in the following pattern:
25626
25627 @smallexample
25628 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
25629 @end smallexample
25630
25631 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
25632 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
25633 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
25634
25635 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
25636 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
25637 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
25638 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
25639 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
25640 abbreviations---for example:
25641
25642 @smallexample
25643 % sh config.sub i386-linux
25644 i386-pc-linux-gnu
25645 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
25646 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
25647 % sh config.sub hp9k700
25648 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
25649 % sh config.sub sun4
25650 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
25651 % sh config.sub sun3
25652 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
25653 % sh config.sub i986v
25654 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
25655 @end smallexample
25656
25657 @noindent
25658 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
25659 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
25660
25661 @node Configure Options
25662 @section @file{configure} Options
25663
25664 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
25665 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
25666 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
25667 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
25668
25669 @smallexample
25670 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
25671 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
25672 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
25673 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
25674 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
25675 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
25676 @var{host}
25677 @end smallexample
25678
25679 @noindent
25680 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
25681 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
25682 @samp{--}.
25683
25684 @table @code
25685 @item --help
25686 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
25687
25688 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
25689 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
25690 @file{@var{dir}}.
25691
25692 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
25693 Configure the source to install programs under directory
25694 @file{@var{dir}}.
25695
25696 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
25697 @need 2000
25698 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
25699 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
25700 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
25701 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
25702 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
25703 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
25704 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
25705 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
25706 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
25707 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
25708 @var{dirname}.
25709
25710 @item --norecursion
25711 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
25712 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
25713
25714 @item --target=@var{target}
25715 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
25716 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
25717 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
25718
25719 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
25720
25721 @item @var{host} @dots{}
25722 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
25723
25724 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
25725 @end table
25726
25727 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
25728 needed for special purposes only.
25729
25730 @node System-wide configuration
25731 @section System-wide configuration and settings
25732 @cindex system-wide init file
25733
25734 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
25735 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
25736 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
25737
25738 Here is the corresponding configure option:
25739
25740 @table @code
25741 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
25742 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
25743 @var{file}.
25744 @end table
25745
25746 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
25747 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
25748
25749 @itemize @bullet
25750 @item
25751 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
25752 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
25753 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
25754 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
25755 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
25756 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
25757
25758 @item
25759 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
25760 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
25761 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
25762 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
25763 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
25764 @end itemize
25765
25766 @node Maintenance Commands
25767 @appendix Maintenance Commands
25768 @cindex maintenance commands
25769 @cindex internal commands
25770
25771 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
25772 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
25773 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
25774 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
25775 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
25776
25777 @table @code
25778 @kindex maint agent
25779 @item maint agent @var{expression}
25780 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
25781 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
25782 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
25783
25784 @kindex maint info breakpoints
25785 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
25786 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
25787 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
25788 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
25789 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
25790 is shown:
25791
25792 @table @code
25793 @item breakpoint
25794 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
25795
25796 @item watchpoint
25797 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
25798
25799 @item longjmp
25800 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
25801 @code{longjmp} calls.
25802
25803 @item longjmp resume
25804 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
25805
25806 @item until
25807 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
25808
25809 @item finish
25810 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
25811
25812 @item shlib events
25813 Shared library events.
25814
25815 @end table
25816
25817 @kindex set displaced-stepping
25818 @kindex show displaced-stepping
25819 @cindex displaced stepping support
25820 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
25821 @item set displaced-stepping
25822 @itemx show displaced-stepping
25823 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
25824 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
25825 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
25826 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
25827 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
25828
25829 @table @code
25830 @item set displaced-stepping on
25831 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
25832 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
25833
25834 @item set displaced-stepping off
25835 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
25836 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
25837
25838 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
25839 @item set displaced-stepping auto
25840 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
25841 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
25842 architecture supports displaced stepping.
25843 @end table
25844
25845 @kindex maint check-symtabs
25846 @item maint check-symtabs
25847 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
25848
25849 @kindex maint cplus first_component
25850 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
25851 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
25852
25853 @kindex maint cplus namespace
25854 @item maint cplus namespace
25855 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
25856
25857 @kindex maint demangle
25858 @item maint demangle @var{name}
25859 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
25860
25861 @kindex maint deprecate
25862 @kindex maint undeprecate
25863 @cindex deprecated commands
25864 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
25865 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
25866 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
25867 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
25868 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
25869 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
25870 the replacement as part of the warning.
25871
25872 @kindex maint dump-me
25873 @item maint dump-me
25874 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
25875 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
25876 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
25877 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
25878
25879 @kindex maint internal-error
25880 @kindex maint internal-warning
25881 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
25882 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
25883 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
25884 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
25885 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
25886 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
25887 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
25888 @value{GDBN} session.
25889
25890 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
25891 used as the text of the error or warning message.
25892
25893 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
25894
25895 @smallexample
25896 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
25897 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
25898 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
25899 debugging may prove unreliable.
25900 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
25901 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
25902 (@value{GDBP})
25903 @end smallexample
25904
25905 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
25906 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
25907
25908 @kindex maint set internal-error
25909 @kindex maint show internal-error
25910 @kindex maint set internal-warning
25911 @kindex maint show internal-warning
25912 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
25913 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
25914 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
25915 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
25916 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
25917 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
25918 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
25919 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
25920 described in the table below.
25921
25922 @table @samp
25923 @item quit
25924 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
25925 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
25926
25927 @item corefile
25928 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
25929 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do.
25930 @end table
25931
25932 @kindex maint packet
25933 @item maint packet @var{text}
25934 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
25935 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
25936 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
25937 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
25938 checksum.
25939
25940 @kindex maint print architecture
25941 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
25942 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
25943 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
25944
25945 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
25946 @item maint print c-tdesc
25947 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
25948 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
25949 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
25950
25951 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
25952 @item maint print dummy-frames
25953 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
25954
25955 @smallexample
25956 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
25957 @dots{}
25958 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
25959 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
25960 58 return (a + b);
25961 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
25962 @dots{}
25963 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
25964 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
25965 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
25966 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
25967 (@value{GDBP})
25968 @end smallexample
25969
25970 Takes an optional file parameter.
25971
25972 @kindex maint print registers
25973 @kindex maint print raw-registers
25974 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
25975 @kindex maint print register-groups
25976 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
25977 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
25978 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
25979 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
25980 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
25981
25982 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
25983 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
25984 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
25985 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
25986 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
25987 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
25988
25989 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
25990 write the information.
25991
25992 @kindex maint print reggroups
25993 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
25994 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
25995 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
25996 information.
25997
25998 The register groups info looks like this:
25999
26000 @smallexample
26001 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
26002 Group Type
26003 general user
26004 float user
26005 all user
26006 vector user
26007 system user
26008 save internal
26009 restore internal
26010 @end smallexample
26011
26012 @kindex flushregs
26013 @item flushregs
26014 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
26015
26016 @kindex maint print objfiles
26017 @cindex info for known object files
26018 @item maint print objfiles
26019 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
26020 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
26021 and symtabs.
26022
26023 @kindex maint print statistics
26024 @cindex bcache statistics
26025 @item maint print statistics
26026 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
26027 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
26028 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
26029 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
26030 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
26031 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
26032 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
26033 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
26034 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
26035 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
26036 lengths.
26037
26038 @kindex maint print target-stack
26039 @cindex target stack description
26040 @item maint print target-stack
26041 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
26042 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
26043 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
26044 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
26045 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
26046 address.
26047
26048 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
26049 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
26050
26051 @kindex maint print type
26052 @cindex type chain of a data type
26053 @item maint print type @var{expr}
26054 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
26055 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
26056 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
26057 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
26058 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
26059
26060 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
26061 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
26062 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
26063 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
26064 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
26065
26066 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
26067 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
26068 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
26069 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
26070 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
26071 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
26072 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
26073 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
26074 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
26075
26076 @kindex maint set profile
26077 @kindex maint show profile
26078 @cindex profiling GDB
26079 @item maint set profile
26080 @itemx maint show profile
26081 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
26082
26083 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
26084 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
26085 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
26086 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
26087 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
26088 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
26089 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
26090
26091 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
26092 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
26093
26094 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
26095 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
26096 @cindex hardware debug registers
26097 @item maint set show-debug-regs
26098 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
26099 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
26100 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
26101 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
26102 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
26103 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
26104
26105 @kindex maint space
26106 @cindex memory used by commands
26107 @item maint space
26108 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
26109 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
26110 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
26111 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
26112 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
26113
26114 @kindex maint time
26115 @cindex time of command execution
26116 @item maint time
26117 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
26118 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
26119 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
26120 The time is not printed for the commands that run the target, since
26121 there's no mechanism currently to compute how much time was spend
26122 by @value{GDBN} and how much time was spend by the program been debugged.
26123 it's not possibly currently
26124 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
26125 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
26126
26127 @kindex maint translate-address
26128 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
26129 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
26130 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
26131 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
26132 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
26133 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
26134 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
26135
26136 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
26137 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
26138 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
26139
26140 @end table
26141
26142 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
26143 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
26144
26145 @table @code
26146 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
26147 @kindex set watchdog
26148 @cindex watchdog timer
26149 @cindex timeout for commands
26150 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
26151 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
26152 reports and error and the command is aborted.
26153
26154 @item show watchdog
26155 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
26156 @end table
26157
26158 @node Remote Protocol
26159 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
26160
26161 @menu
26162 * Overview::
26163 * Packets::
26164 * Stop Reply Packets::
26165 * General Query Packets::
26166 * Register Packet Format::
26167 * Tracepoint Packets::
26168 * Host I/O Packets::
26169 * Interrupts::
26170 * Notification Packets::
26171 * Remote Non-Stop::
26172 * Packet Acknowledgment::
26173 * Examples::
26174 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
26175 * Library List Format::
26176 * Memory Map Format::
26177 @end menu
26178
26179 @node Overview
26180 @section Overview
26181
26182 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
26183 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
26184 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
26185 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
26186
26187 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
26188 transmitted and received data, respectively.
26189
26190 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
26191 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
26192 @cindex remote serial protocol
26193 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
26194 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
26195 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
26196 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
26197 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
26198
26199 @smallexample
26200 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
26201 @end smallexample
26202 @noindent
26203
26204 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
26205 @noindent
26206 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
26207 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
26208 eight bit unsigned checksum).
26209
26210 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
26211 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
26212
26213 @smallexample
26214 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
26215 @end smallexample
26216
26217 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
26218 @noindent
26219 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
26220 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
26221 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
26222
26223 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
26224 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
26225 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
26226 retransmission):
26227
26228 @smallexample
26229 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
26230 <- @code{+}
26231 @end smallexample
26232 @noindent
26233
26234 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
26235 once a connection is established.
26236 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
26237
26238 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
26239 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
26240 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
26241 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
26242 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
26243 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
26244 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
26245
26246 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
26247 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
26248 exceptions).
26249
26250 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
26251 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
26252 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
26253 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
26254
26255 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
26256 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
26257 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
26258
26259 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
26260 @anchor{Binary Data}
26261 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
26262 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
26263 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
26264 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
26265 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
26266 binary data.
26267
26268 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
26269 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
26270 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
26271 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
26272 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
26273 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
26274 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
26275 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
26276 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
26277 (described next).
26278
26279 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
26280 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
26281 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
26282 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
26283 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
26284 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
26285 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
26286 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
26287 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
26288 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
26289 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
26290 3}} more times.
26291
26292 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
26293 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
26294 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
26295 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
26296 @samp{0*"00}.
26297
26298 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
26299 error number. That number is not well defined.
26300
26301 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
26302 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
26303 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
26304 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
26305 on that response.
26306
26307 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
26308 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
26309 optional.
26310
26311 @node Packets
26312 @section Packets
26313
26314 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
26315 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
26316 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
26317 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
26318
26319 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
26320 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
26321 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
26322 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
26323 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
26324 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
26325 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
26326 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
26327 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
26328 @var{baz}.
26329
26330 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
26331 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
26332 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
26333 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
26334 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
26335 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
26336 pick any thread.
26337
26338 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
26339 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
26340 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
26341 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
26342 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
26343 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
26344 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
26345 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
26346 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
26347 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
26348 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
26349 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
26350 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
26351
26352 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
26353 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
26354 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
26355 more information.
26356
26357 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
26358 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
26359
26360 Here are the packet descriptions.
26361
26362 @table @samp
26363
26364 @item !
26365 @cindex @samp{!} packet
26366 @anchor{extended mode}
26367 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
26368 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
26369 debugged.
26370
26371 Reply:
26372 @table @samp
26373 @item OK
26374 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
26375 @end table
26376
26377 @item ?
26378 @cindex @samp{?} packet
26379 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
26380 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
26381 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
26382
26383 Reply:
26384 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
26385
26386 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
26387 @cindex @samp{A} packet
26388 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
26389 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
26390 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
26391
26392 Reply:
26393 @table @samp
26394 @item OK
26395 The arguments were set.
26396 @item E @var{NN}
26397 An error occurred.
26398 @end table
26399
26400 @item b @var{baud}
26401 @cindex @samp{b} packet
26402 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
26403 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
26404
26405 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
26406 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
26407 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
26408
26409 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
26410 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
26411 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
26412 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
26413 of view, nothing actually happened.}
26414
26415 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
26416 @cindex @samp{B} packet
26417 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
26418 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
26419
26420 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
26421 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
26422
26423 @item bc
26424 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
26425 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
26426 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
26427
26428 Reply:
26429 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
26430
26431 @item bs
26432 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
26433 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
26434 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
26435
26436 Reply:
26437 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
26438
26439 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
26440 @cindex @samp{c} packet
26441 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
26442 resume at current address.
26443
26444 Reply:
26445 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
26446
26447 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
26448 @cindex @samp{C} packet
26449 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
26450 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
26451
26452 Reply:
26453 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
26454
26455 @item d
26456 @cindex @samp{d} packet
26457 Toggle debug flag.
26458
26459 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
26460 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
26461
26462 @item D
26463 @itemx D;@var{pid}
26464 @cindex @samp{D} packet
26465 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
26466 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
26467 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
26468
26469 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
26470 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
26471 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
26472 big-endian hex string.
26473
26474 Reply:
26475 @table @samp
26476 @item OK
26477 for success
26478 @item E @var{NN}
26479 for an error
26480 @end table
26481
26482 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
26483 @cindex @samp{F} packet
26484 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
26485 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
26486 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
26487
26488 @item g
26489 @anchor{read registers packet}
26490 @cindex @samp{g} packet
26491 Read general registers.
26492
26493 Reply:
26494 @table @samp
26495 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
26496 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
26497 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
26498 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
26499 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
26500 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
26501 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
26502 @item E @var{NN}
26503 for an error.
26504 @end table
26505
26506 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
26507 @cindex @samp{G} packet
26508 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
26509 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
26510
26511 Reply:
26512 @table @samp
26513 @item OK
26514 for success
26515 @item E @var{NN}
26516 for an error
26517 @end table
26518
26519 @item H @var{c} @var{thread-id}
26520 @cindex @samp{H} packet
26521 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
26522 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
26523 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
26524 operations. The thread designator @var{thread-id} has the format and
26525 interpretation described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
26526
26527 Reply:
26528 @table @samp
26529 @item OK
26530 for success
26531 @item E @var{NN}
26532 for an error
26533 @end table
26534
26535 @c FIXME: JTC:
26536 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
26537 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
26538 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
26539 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
26540 @c described. For example:
26541 @c
26542 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
26543 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
26544 @c otherwise returns current registers.
26545 @c
26546 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
26547 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
26548 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
26549
26550 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
26551 @anchor{cycle step packet}
26552 @cindex @samp{i} packet
26553 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
26554 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
26555 step starting at that address.
26556
26557 @item I
26558 @cindex @samp{I} packet
26559 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
26560 step packet}.
26561
26562 @item k
26563 @cindex @samp{k} packet
26564 Kill request.
26565
26566 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
26567 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
26568 thread?)}.
26569
26570 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
26571 @cindex @samp{m} packet
26572 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
26573 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
26574
26575 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
26576 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
26577 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
26578 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
26579 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
26580 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
26581 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
26582 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
26583
26584 Reply:
26585 @table @samp
26586 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
26587 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
26588 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
26589 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
26590 @item E @var{NN}
26591 @var{NN} is errno
26592 @end table
26593
26594 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
26595 @cindex @samp{M} packet
26596 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
26597 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
26598 hexadecimal number.
26599
26600 Reply:
26601 @table @samp
26602 @item OK
26603 for success
26604 @item E @var{NN}
26605 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
26606 written).
26607 @end table
26608
26609 @item p @var{n}
26610 @cindex @samp{p} packet
26611 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
26612 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
26613 register value is encoded.
26614
26615 Reply:
26616 @table @samp
26617 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
26618 the register's value
26619 @item E @var{NN}
26620 for an error
26621 @item
26622 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
26623 @end table
26624
26625 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
26626 @anchor{write register packet}
26627 @cindex @samp{P} packet
26628 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
26629 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
26630 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
26631
26632 Reply:
26633 @table @samp
26634 @item OK
26635 for success
26636 @item E @var{NN}
26637 for an error
26638 @end table
26639
26640 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
26641 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
26642 @cindex @samp{q} packet
26643 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
26644 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
26645 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
26646
26647 @item r
26648 @cindex @samp{r} packet
26649 Reset the entire system.
26650
26651 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
26652
26653 @item R @var{XX}
26654 @cindex @samp{R} packet
26655 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
26656 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
26657
26658 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
26659
26660 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
26661 @cindex @samp{s} packet
26662 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
26663 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
26664
26665 Reply:
26666 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
26667
26668 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
26669 @anchor{step with signal packet}
26670 @cindex @samp{S} packet
26671 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
26672 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
26673
26674 Reply:
26675 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
26676
26677 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
26678 @cindex @samp{t} packet
26679 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
26680 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
26681 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
26682
26683 @item T @var{thread-id}
26684 @cindex @samp{T} packet
26685 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
26686
26687 Reply:
26688 @table @samp
26689 @item OK
26690 thread is still alive
26691 @item E @var{NN}
26692 thread is dead
26693 @end table
26694
26695 @item v
26696 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
26697 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
26698
26699 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
26700 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
26701 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
26702 The process ID is a
26703 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
26704 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
26705 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
26706
26707 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
26708 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
26709 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
26710 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
26711 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
26712 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
26713 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
26714 @c stopping or restarting threads.
26715
26716 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
26717
26718 Reply:
26719 @table @samp
26720 @item E @var{nn}
26721 for an error
26722 @item @r{Any stop packet}
26723 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
26724 @item OK
26725 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
26726 @end table
26727
26728 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
26729 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
26730 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
26731 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
26732 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
26733 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
26734 in their current state in non-stop mode.
26735 Specifying multiple
26736 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
26737 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
26738
26739 Currently supported actions are:
26740
26741 @table @samp
26742 @item c
26743 Continue.
26744 @item C @var{sig}
26745 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
26746 @item s
26747 Step.
26748 @item S @var{sig}
26749 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
26750 @item t
26751 Stop.
26752 @item T @var{sig}
26753 Stop with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
26754 @end table
26755
26756 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
26757 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
26758 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
26759
26760 The @samp{t} and @samp{T} actions are only relevant in non-stop mode
26761 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
26762 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
26763 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
26764 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
26765 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
26766 as an implementation detail.
26767
26768 Reply:
26769 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
26770
26771 @item vCont?
26772 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
26773 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
26774
26775 Reply:
26776 @table @samp
26777 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
26778 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
26779 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
26780 @item
26781 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
26782 @end table
26783
26784 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
26785 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
26786 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
26787 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
26788
26789 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
26790 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
26791 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
26792 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
26793 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
26794 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
26795 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
26796 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
26797 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
26798 packet is received.
26799
26800 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
26801 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
26802 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
26803 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
26804 @var{thread-id}.
26805
26806 Reply:
26807 @table @samp
26808 @item OK
26809 for success
26810 @item E @var{NN}
26811 for an error
26812 @end table
26813
26814 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
26815 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
26816 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
26817 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
26818 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
26819 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
26820 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
26821 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
26822 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
26823 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
26824 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
26825 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
26826
26827
26828 Reply:
26829 @table @samp
26830 @item OK
26831 for success
26832 @item E.memtype
26833 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
26834 @item E @var{NN}
26835 for an error
26836 @end table
26837
26838 @item vFlashDone
26839 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
26840 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
26841 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
26842 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
26843 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
26844 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
26845 request is completed.
26846
26847 @item vKill;@var{pid}
26848 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
26849 Kill the process with the specified process ID. @var{pid} is a
26850 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
26851 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
26852 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
26853
26854 Reply:
26855 @table @samp
26856 @item E @var{nn}
26857 for an error
26858 @item OK
26859 for success
26860 @end table
26861
26862 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
26863 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
26864 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
26865 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
26866 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
26867 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
26868 state.
26869
26870 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
26871
26872 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
26873
26874 Reply:
26875 @table @samp
26876 @item E @var{nn}
26877 for an error
26878 @item @r{Any stop packet}
26879 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
26880 @end table
26881
26882 @item vStopped
26883 @anchor{vStopped packet}
26884 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
26885
26886 In non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}), acknowledge a previous stop
26887 reply and prompt for the stub to report another one.
26888
26889 Reply:
26890 @table @samp
26891 @item @r{Any stop packet}
26892 if there is another unreported stop event (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
26893 @item OK
26894 if there are no unreported stop events
26895 @end table
26896
26897 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
26898 @anchor{X packet}
26899 @cindex @samp{X} packet
26900 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
26901 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
26902 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
26903
26904 Reply:
26905 @table @samp
26906 @item OK
26907 for success
26908 @item E @var{NN}
26909 for an error
26910 @end table
26911
26912 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
26913 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
26914 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
26915 @cindex @samp{z} packet
26916 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
26917 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
26918 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
26919 @var{length} bytes.
26920
26921 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
26922 separately.
26923
26924 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
26925 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
26926 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
26927 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
26928 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
26929 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
26930
26931 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
26932 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
26933 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
26934 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
26935 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
26936 @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
26937
26938 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
26939 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
26940 @var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
26941 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
26942 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
26943
26944 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
26945 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
26946 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
26947 target, is not defined.}
26948
26949 Reply:
26950 @table @samp
26951 @item OK
26952 success
26953 @item
26954 not supported
26955 @item E @var{NN}
26956 for an error
26957 @end table
26958
26959 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
26960 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
26961 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
26962 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
26963 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
26964 address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
26965
26966 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
26967 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
26968
26969 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
26970 movement.}
26971
26972 Reply:
26973 @table @samp
26974 @item OK
26975 success
26976 @item
26977 not supported
26978 @item E @var{NN}
26979 for an error
26980 @end table
26981
26982 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
26983 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
26984 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
26985 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
26986 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
26987
26988 Reply:
26989 @table @samp
26990 @item OK
26991 success
26992 @item
26993 not supported
26994 @item E @var{NN}
26995 for an error
26996 @end table
26997
26998 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
26999 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
27000 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
27001 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
27002 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
27003
27004 Reply:
27005 @table @samp
27006 @item OK
27007 success
27008 @item
27009 not supported
27010 @item E @var{NN}
27011 for an error
27012 @end table
27013
27014 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
27015 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
27016 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
27017 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
27018 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
27019
27020 Reply:
27021 @table @samp
27022 @item OK
27023 success
27024 @item
27025 not supported
27026 @item E @var{NN}
27027 for an error
27028 @end table
27029
27030 @end table
27031
27032 @node Stop Reply Packets
27033 @section Stop Reply Packets
27034 @cindex stop reply packets
27035
27036 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
27037 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
27038 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
27039 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
27040 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
27041 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
27042 @value{GDBN} source code.
27043
27044 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
27045 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
27046 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
27047 components.
27048
27049 @table @samp
27050
27051 @item S @var{AA}
27052 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
27053 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
27054 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
27055
27056 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
27057 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
27058 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
27059 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
27060 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
27061 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
27062 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
27063 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
27064
27065 @itemize @bullet
27066 @item
27067 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
27068 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
27069 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
27070 two-digit hex number.
27071
27072 @item
27073 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
27074 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
27075
27076 @item
27077 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
27078 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
27079 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
27080 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
27081
27082 @item
27083 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
27084 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
27085 future.
27086 @end itemize
27087
27088 The currently defined stop reasons are:
27089
27090 @table @samp
27091 @item watch
27092 @itemx rwatch
27093 @itemx awatch
27094 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
27095 hex.
27096
27097 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
27098 @item library
27099 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
27100 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
27101 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
27102
27103 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
27104 @item replaylog
27105 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
27106 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
27107 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
27108 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
27109 for more information.
27110
27111
27112 @end table
27113
27114 @item W @var{AA}
27115 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
27116 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
27117 applicable to certain targets.
27118
27119 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
27120 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
27121 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
27122 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
27123
27124 @item X @var{AA}
27125 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
27126 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
27127
27128 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
27129 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
27130 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
27131 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
27132
27133 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
27134 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
27135 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
27136 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
27137 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
27138
27139 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
27140 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
27141 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
27142 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
27143 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
27144 system calls.
27145
27146 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
27147 this very system call.
27148
27149 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
27150 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
27151 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
27152 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
27153 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
27154 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
27155
27156 @end table
27157
27158 @node General Query Packets
27159 @section General Query Packets
27160 @cindex remote query requests
27161
27162 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
27163 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
27164 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
27165 sending information to and from the stub.
27166
27167 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
27168 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
27169 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
27170 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
27171 conventions:
27172
27173 @itemize @bullet
27174 @item
27175 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
27176 @item
27177 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
27178 letter.
27179 @item
27180 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
27181 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
27182 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
27183 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
27184 @end itemize
27185
27186 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
27187 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
27188 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
27189 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
27190 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
27191 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
27192 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
27193 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
27194 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
27195 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
27196 packet.}.
27197
27198 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
27199 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
27200 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
27201 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
27202 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
27203
27204 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
27205
27206 @table @samp
27207
27208 @item qC
27209 @cindex current thread, remote request
27210 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
27211 Return the current thread ID.
27212
27213 Reply:
27214 @table @samp
27215 @item QC @var{thread-id}
27216 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
27217 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
27218 @item @r{(anything else)}
27219 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
27220 @end table
27221
27222 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
27223 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
27224 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
27225 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory.
27226 Reply:
27227 @table @samp
27228 @item E @var{NN}
27229 An error (such as memory fault)
27230 @item C @var{crc32}
27231 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
27232 @end table
27233
27234 @item qfThreadInfo
27235 @itemx qsThreadInfo
27236 @cindex list active threads, remote request
27237 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
27238 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
27239 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
27240 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
27241 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
27242 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
27243 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
27244 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
27245
27246 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
27247
27248 Reply:
27249 @table @samp
27250 @item m @var{thread-id}
27251 A single thread ID
27252 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
27253 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
27254 @item l
27255 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
27256 @end table
27257
27258 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
27259 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
27260 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
27261 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
27262 with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
27263 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
27264 fields.
27265
27266 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
27267 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
27268 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
27269 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
27270 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
27271
27272 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
27273 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
27274
27275 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
27276 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
27277 information associated with the variable.)
27278
27279 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
27280 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
27281 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
27282 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
27283 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
27284 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
27285
27286 Reply:
27287 @table @samp
27288 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
27289 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
27290 local storage requested.
27291
27292 @item E @var{nn}
27293 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
27294
27295 @item
27296 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
27297 @end table
27298
27299 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
27300 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
27301 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
27302 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
27303 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
27304 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
27305 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
27306
27307 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
27308
27309 Reply:
27310 @table @samp
27311 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
27312 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
27313 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
27314 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
27315 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
27316 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
27317 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
27318 @end table
27319
27320 @item qOffsets
27321 @cindex section offsets, remote request
27322 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
27323 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
27324 image.
27325
27326 Reply:
27327 @table @samp
27328 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
27329 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
27330 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
27331 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
27332 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
27333 segments by the supplied offsets.
27334
27335 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
27336 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
27337 to the @code{Bss} section.}
27338
27339 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
27340 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
27341 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
27342 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
27343 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
27344 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
27345 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
27346 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
27347 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
27348 @end table
27349
27350 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
27351 @cindex thread information, remote request
27352 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
27353 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
27354 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
27355 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
27356
27357 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
27358 (see below).
27359
27360 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
27361
27362 @item QNonStop:1
27363 @item QNonStop:0
27364 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
27365 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
27366 @anchor{QNonStop}
27367 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
27368 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
27369
27370 Reply:
27371 @table @samp
27372 @item OK
27373 The request succeeded.
27374
27375 @item E @var{nn}
27376 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
27377
27378 @item
27379 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
27380 the stub.
27381 @end table
27382
27383 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27384 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
27385 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
27386 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
27387
27388 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
27389 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
27390 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
27391 @anchor{QPassSignals}
27392 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
27393 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
27394 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
27395 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
27396 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
27397 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
27398 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
27399 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
27400 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
27401
27402 Reply:
27403 @table @samp
27404 @item OK
27405 The request succeeded.
27406
27407 @item E @var{nn}
27408 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
27409
27410 @item
27411 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
27412 the stub.
27413 @end table
27414
27415 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
27416 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
27417 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27418 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
27419
27420 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
27421 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
27422 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
27423 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
27424 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
27425 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
27426 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
27427 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
27428 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
27429
27430 Reply:
27431 @table @samp
27432 @item OK
27433 A command response with no output.
27434 @item @var{OUTPUT}
27435 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
27436 @item E @var{NN}
27437 Indicate a badly formed request.
27438 @item
27439 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
27440 @end table
27441
27442 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
27443 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
27444 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
27445 packets.)
27446
27447 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
27448 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
27449 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
27450 @anchor{qSearch memory}
27451 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
27452 @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex.
27453 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, hex encoded.
27454
27455 Reply:
27456 @table @samp
27457 @item 0
27458 The pattern was not found.
27459 @item 1,address
27460 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
27461 @item E @var{NN}
27462 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
27463 @item
27464 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
27465 @end table
27466
27467 @item QStartNoAckMode
27468 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
27469 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
27470 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
27471 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
27472
27473 Reply:
27474 @table @samp
27475 @item OK
27476 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
27477 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
27478 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
27479 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
27480 @item
27481 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
27482 @end table
27483
27484 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
27485 @cindex supported packets, remote query
27486 @cindex features of the remote protocol
27487 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
27488 @anchor{qSupported}
27489 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
27490 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
27491 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
27492 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
27493 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
27494 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
27495 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
27496 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
27497 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
27498 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
27499 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
27500 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
27501 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
27502 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
27503
27504 Reply:
27505 @table @samp
27506 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
27507 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
27508 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
27509 possible forms).
27510 @item
27511 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
27512 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
27513 @end table
27514
27515 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
27516 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
27517 are:
27518
27519 @table @samp
27520 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
27521 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
27522 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
27523 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
27524 @item @var{name}+
27525 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
27526 need an associated value.
27527 @item @var{name}-
27528 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
27529 @item @var{name}?
27530 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
27531 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
27532 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
27533 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
27534 @end table
27535
27536 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
27537 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
27538 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
27539 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
27540 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
27541
27542 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
27543 are defined:
27544
27545 @table @samp
27546 @item multiprocess
27547 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
27548 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
27549 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
27550 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
27551 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
27552 @end table
27553
27554 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
27555 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
27556 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
27557 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
27558 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
27559 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
27560 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
27561 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
27562 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
27563 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
27564 all the features it supports.
27565
27566 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
27567 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
27568
27569 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
27570 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
27571 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
27572 form response.
27573
27574 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
27575 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
27576 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
27577 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
27578
27579 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
27580 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
27581 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
27582 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
27583 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
27584
27585 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
27586
27587 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
27588 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
27589 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
27590 @item Feature Name
27591 @tab Value Required
27592 @tab Default
27593 @tab Probe Allowed
27594
27595 @item @samp{PacketSize}
27596 @tab Yes
27597 @tab @samp{-}
27598 @tab No
27599
27600 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
27601 @tab No
27602 @tab @samp{-}
27603 @tab Yes
27604
27605 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
27606 @tab No
27607 @tab @samp{-}
27608 @tab Yes
27609
27610 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
27611 @tab No
27612 @tab @samp{-}
27613 @tab Yes
27614
27615 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
27616 @tab No
27617 @tab @samp{-}
27618 @tab Yes
27619
27620 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
27621 @tab No
27622 @tab @samp{-}
27623 @tab Yes
27624
27625 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
27626 @tab No
27627 @tab @samp{-}
27628 @tab Yes
27629
27630 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
27631 @tab No
27632 @tab @samp{-}
27633 @tab Yes
27634
27635 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
27636 @tab No
27637 @tab @samp{-}
27638 @tab Yes
27639
27640 @item @samp{QNonStop}
27641 @tab No
27642 @tab @samp{-}
27643 @tab Yes
27644
27645 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
27646 @tab No
27647 @tab @samp{-}
27648 @tab Yes
27649
27650 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
27651 @tab No
27652 @tab @samp{-}
27653 @tab Yes
27654
27655 @item @samp{multiprocess}
27656 @tab No
27657 @tab @samp{-}
27658 @tab No
27659
27660 @end multitable
27661
27662 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
27663
27664 @table @samp
27665 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
27666 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
27667 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
27668 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
27669 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
27670 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
27671 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
27672 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
27673 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
27674 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
27675
27676 @item qXfer:auxv:read
27677 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
27678 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
27679
27680 @item qXfer:features:read
27681 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
27682 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
27683
27684 @item qXfer:libraries:read
27685 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
27686 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
27687
27688 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
27689 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
27690 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
27691
27692 @item qXfer:spu:read
27693 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
27694 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
27695
27696 @item qXfer:spu:write
27697 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
27698 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
27699
27700 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
27701 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
27702 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
27703
27704 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
27705 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
27706 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
27707
27708 @item QNonStop
27709 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
27710 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
27711
27712 @item QPassSignals
27713 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
27714 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
27715
27716 @item QStartNoAckMode
27717 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
27718 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
27719
27720 @item multiprocess
27721 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
27722 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
27723 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
27724 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
27725 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
27726 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
27727 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
27728 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
27729 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
27730 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
27731 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
27732
27733 @item qXfer:osdata:read
27734 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
27735 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
27736
27737 @end table
27738
27739 @item qSymbol::
27740 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
27741 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
27742 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
27743 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
27744
27745 Reply:
27746 @table @samp
27747 @item OK
27748 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
27749 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
27750 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
27751 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
27752 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
27753 below.
27754 @end table
27755
27756 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
27757 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
27758
27759 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
27760 target has previously requested.
27761
27762 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
27763 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
27764 will be empty.
27765
27766 Reply:
27767 @table @samp
27768 @item OK
27769 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
27770 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
27771 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
27772 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
27773 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
27774 @end table
27775
27776 @item QTDP
27777 @itemx QTFrame
27778 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
27779
27780 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
27781 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
27782 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
27783 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
27784 the target OS. @var{thread-id} is a thread ID;
27785 see @ref{thread-id syntax}. This
27786 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
27787 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
27788 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
27789 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
27790 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
27791
27792 Reply:
27793 @table @samp
27794 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
27795 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
27796 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
27797 the thread's attributes.
27798 @end table
27799
27800 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
27801 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
27802 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
27803 packets.)
27804
27805 @item QTStart
27806 @itemx QTStop
27807 @itemx QTinit
27808 @itemx QTro
27809 @itemx qTStatus
27810 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
27811
27812 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
27813 @cindex read special object, remote request
27814 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
27815 @anchor{qXfer read}
27816 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
27817 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
27818 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
27819 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
27820 additional details about what data to access.
27821
27822 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
27823 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
27824 formats, listed below.
27825
27826 @table @samp
27827 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
27828 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
27829 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
27830 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
27831
27832 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27833 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
27834
27835 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
27836 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
27837 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
27838 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
27839 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
27840
27841 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27842 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
27843
27844 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
27845 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
27846 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
27847 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
27848 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
27849
27850 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
27851 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
27852 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
27853
27854 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27855 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
27856
27857 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
27858 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
27859 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
27860 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
27861 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
27862
27863 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27864 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
27865
27866 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
27867 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
27868 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
27869 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
27870 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
27871
27872 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27873 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
27874 (@pxref{qSupported}).
27875
27876 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
27877 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
27878 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
27879 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
27880 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
27881 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
27882 in that context to be accessed.
27883
27884 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27885 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
27886 (@pxref{qSupported}).
27887
27888 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
27889 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
27890 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
27891 @xref{Operating System Information}.
27892
27893 @end table
27894
27895 Reply:
27896 @table @samp
27897 @item m @var{data}
27898 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
27899 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
27900 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
27901 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
27902 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
27903 request.
27904
27905 @item l @var{data}
27906 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
27907 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
27908 than the @var{length} in the request.
27909
27910 @item l
27911 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
27912 There is no more data to be read.
27913
27914 @item E00
27915 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
27916
27917 @item E @var{nn}
27918 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
27919 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
27920
27921 @item
27922 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
27923 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
27924 @end table
27925
27926 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
27927 @cindex write data into object, remote request
27928 @anchor{qXfer write}
27929 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
27930 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
27931 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
27932 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
27933 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
27934 to access.
27935
27936 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
27937 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
27938 formats, listed below.
27939
27940 @table @samp
27941 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
27942 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
27943 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
27944 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
27945 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
27946
27947 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27948 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
27949 (@pxref{qSupported}).
27950
27951 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
27952 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
27953 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
27954 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
27955 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
27956 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
27957 in that context to be accessed.
27958
27959 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27960 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
27961 @end table
27962
27963 Reply:
27964 @table @samp
27965 @item @var{nn}
27966 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
27967 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
27968
27969 @item E00
27970 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
27971
27972 @item E @var{nn}
27973 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
27974 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
27975
27976 @item
27977 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
27978 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
27979 @end table
27980
27981 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
27982 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
27983 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
27984 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
27985 must respond with an empty packet.
27986
27987 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
27988 @cindex query attached, remote request
27989 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
27990 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
27991 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
27992 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
27993 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
27994 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
27995 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
27996
27997 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
27998 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
27999 the @code{quit} command.
28000
28001 Reply:
28002 @table @samp
28003 @item 1
28004 The remote server attached to an existing process.
28005 @item 0
28006 The remote server created a new process.
28007 @item E @var{NN}
28008 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
28009 @end table
28010
28011 @end table
28012
28013 @node Register Packet Format
28014 @section Register Packet Format
28015
28016 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
28017 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
28018 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
28019 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
28020 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
28021 most-significant - least-significant.
28022
28023 @table @r
28024
28025 @item MIPS32
28026
28027 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
28028 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
28029 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
28030
28031 @item MIPS64
28032
28033 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
28034 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
28035 as @code{MIPS32}.
28036
28037 @end table
28038
28039 @node Tracepoint Packets
28040 @section Tracepoint Packets
28041 @cindex tracepoint packets
28042 @cindex packets, tracepoint
28043
28044 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
28045 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
28046
28047 @table @samp
28048
28049 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}@r{[}-@r{]}
28050 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
28051 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
28052 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
28053 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If the trailing @samp{-} is
28054 present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this
28055 tracepoint's actions.
28056
28057 Replies:
28058 @table @samp
28059 @item OK
28060 The packet was understood and carried out.
28061 @item
28062 The packet was not recognized.
28063 @end table
28064
28065 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
28066 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
28067 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
28068 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
28069 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
28070 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
28071 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
28072
28073 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
28074 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
28075 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
28076 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
28077 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
28078 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
28079 tracepoint actions.
28080
28081 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
28082 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
28083 following forms:
28084
28085 @table @samp
28086
28087 @item R @var{mask}
28088 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
28089 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
28090 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
28091 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
28092 not fit in a 32-bit word.
28093
28094 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
28095 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
28096 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
28097 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
28098 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
28099 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
28100 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
28101
28102 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
28103 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
28104 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
28105 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
28106 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
28107 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
28108 packet).
28109
28110 @end table
28111
28112 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
28113 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
28114 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
28115 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
28116 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
28117 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
28118 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
28119 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
28120
28121 Replies:
28122 @table @samp
28123 @item OK
28124 The packet was understood and carried out.
28125 @item
28126 The packet was not recognized.
28127 @end table
28128
28129 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
28130 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
28131 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
28132 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
28133
28134 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
28135 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
28136 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
28137 one of the following forms:
28138
28139 @table @samp
28140 @item F @var{f}
28141 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
28142 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
28143 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
28144
28145 @item T @var{t}
28146 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
28147 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
28148
28149 @end table
28150
28151 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
28152 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
28153 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
28154 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
28155
28156 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
28157 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
28158 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
28159 is a hexadecimal number.
28160
28161 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
28162 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
28163 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
28164 and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
28165 numbers.
28166
28167 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
28168 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
28169 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
28170
28171 @item QTStart
28172 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
28173 hits in the trace frame buffer.
28174
28175 @item QTStop
28176 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
28177
28178 @item QTinit
28179 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
28180
28181 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
28182 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
28183 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
28184 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
28185
28186 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
28187 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
28188 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
28189 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
28190
28191 @item qTStatus
28192 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
28193
28194 Replies:
28195 @table @samp
28196 @item T0
28197 There is no trace experiment running.
28198 @item T1
28199 There is a trace experiment running.
28200 @end table
28201
28202 @end table
28203
28204
28205 @node Host I/O Packets
28206 @section Host I/O Packets
28207 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
28208 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
28209
28210 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
28211 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
28212 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
28213 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
28214 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
28215 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
28216 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
28217 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
28218 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
28219 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
28220
28221 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
28222 its arguments. They have this format:
28223
28224 @table @samp
28225
28226 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
28227 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
28228 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
28229 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
28230 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
28231 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
28232 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
28233 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
28234 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
28235
28236 @end table
28237
28238 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
28239
28240 @table @samp
28241
28242 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
28243 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
28244 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
28245 @var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
28246 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
28247 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
28248 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
28249 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
28250 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
28251 @var{attachment}.
28252
28253 @item
28254 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
28255
28256 @end table
28257
28258 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
28259
28260 @table @samp
28261 @item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
28262 Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
28263 return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
28264 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
28265 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
28266 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
28267 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
28268
28269 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
28270 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
28271 -1 if an error occurs.
28272
28273 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
28274 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
28275 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
28276 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
28277 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
28278 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
28279 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
28280 @var{count} was zero.
28281
28282 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
28283 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
28284 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
28285 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
28286 some characters were escaped.
28287
28288 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
28289 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
28290 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
28291 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
28292 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
28293 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
28294 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
28295 error occurred.
28296
28297 @item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
28298 Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
28299 or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
28300
28301 @end table
28302
28303 @node Interrupts
28304 @section Interrupts
28305 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
28306
28307 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
28308 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C} or a @code{BREAK},
28309 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{remotebreak}
28310 setting (@pxref{set remotebreak}).
28311
28312 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
28313 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
28314 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
28315 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
28316 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
28317
28318 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
28319 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
28320 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
28321 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
28322 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
28323 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
28324 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
28325 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
28326
28327 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
28328 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
28329 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
28330 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
28331 currently-executing threads and processes.
28332 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
28333 running program, it should send one of the stop
28334 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
28335 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
28336 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
28337 Interrupts received while the
28338 program is stopped are discarded.
28339
28340 @node Notification Packets
28341 @section Notification Packets
28342 @cindex notification packets
28343 @cindex packets, notification
28344
28345 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
28346 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
28347 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
28348 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
28349 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
28350 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
28351 is not a problem.
28352
28353 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
28354 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
28355 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
28356 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
28357 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
28358 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
28359 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
28360
28361 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
28362 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
28363
28364 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
28365 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
28366 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
28367 not they understand it.
28368
28369 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
28370 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
28371 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
28372 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
28373 recipients.
28374
28375 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
28376 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
28377 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
28378 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
28379 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
28380
28381 The following notification packets from the stub to @value{GDBN} are
28382 defined:
28383
28384 @table @samp
28385 @item Stop: @var{reply}
28386 Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
28387 The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
28388 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
28389 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
28390 @value{GDBN}.
28391 @end table
28392
28393 @node Remote Non-Stop
28394 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
28395
28396 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
28397 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
28398 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
28399 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
28400
28401 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
28402 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
28403 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
28404 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
28405 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
28406 probe the target state after a mode change.
28407
28408 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
28409 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
28410 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
28411 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
28412 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
28413 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
28414 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
28415 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
28416 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
28417 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
28418 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
28419
28420 Only one stop reply notification at a time may be pending; if
28421 additional stop events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
28422 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
28423 synchronous transmission in response to @samp{vStopped} packets from
28424 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
28425 the stub is permitted to resend a stop reply notification
28426 if it believes @value{GDBN} may not have received it. @value{GDBN}
28427 ignores additional stop reply notifications received before it has
28428 finished processing a previous notification and the stub has completed
28429 sending any queued stop events.
28430
28431 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} must be prepared to receive a stop reply
28432 notification at any time. Specifically, they may appear when
28433 @value{GDBN} is not otherwise reading input from the stub, or when
28434 @value{GDBN} is expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
28435 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
28436 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
28437 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
28438
28439 After receiving a stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall
28440 acknowledge it by sending a @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{vStopped packet})
28441 as a regular, synchronous request to the stub. Such acknowledgment
28442 is not required to happen immediately, as @value{GDBN} is permitted to
28443 send other, unrelated packets to the stub first, which the stub should
28444 process normally.
28445
28446 Upon receiving a @samp{vStopped} packet, if the stub has other queued
28447 stop events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
28448 normal stop reply response. @value{GDBN} shall then send another
28449 @samp{vStopped} packet to solicit further responses; again, it is
28450 permitted to send other, unrelated packets as well which the stub
28451 should process normally.
28452
28453 If the stub receives a @samp{vStopped} packet and there are no
28454 additional stop events to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK}
28455 response. At this point, if further stop events occur, the stub shall
28456 send a new stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the
28457 notification, and the process shall be repeated.
28458
28459 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
28460 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
28461 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
28462 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
28463 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
28464 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
28465 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
28466 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
28467 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
28468 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
28469 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
28470 @samp{OK}.
28471
28472 @node Packet Acknowledgment
28473 @section Packet Acknowledgment
28474
28475 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
28476 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
28477 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
28478 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
28479 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
28480 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
28481 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
28482
28483 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
28484 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
28485 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
28486 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
28487 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
28488
28489 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
28490 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
28491 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
28492 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
28493
28494 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
28495 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
28496 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
28497 @pxref{qSupported}.
28498 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
28499 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
28500 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
28501 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
28502 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
28503 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
28504 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
28505
28506 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
28507 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
28508 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
28509 connection.
28510 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
28511 new connection is established,
28512 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
28513 for the current connection, once disabled.
28514
28515 @node Examples
28516 @section Examples
28517
28518 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
28519 does not get any direct output:
28520
28521 @smallexample
28522 -> @code{R00}
28523 <- @code{+}
28524 @emph{target restarts}
28525 -> @code{?}
28526 <- @code{+}
28527 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
28528 -> @code{+}
28529 @end smallexample
28530
28531 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
28532
28533 @smallexample
28534 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
28535 <- @code{+}
28536 -> @code{s}
28537 <- @code{+}
28538 @emph{time passes}
28539 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
28540 -> @code{+}
28541 -> @code{g}
28542 <- @code{+}
28543 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
28544 -> @code{+}
28545 @end smallexample
28546
28547 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
28548 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
28549 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
28550
28551 @menu
28552 * File-I/O Overview::
28553 * Protocol Basics::
28554 * The F Request Packet::
28555 * The F Reply Packet::
28556 * The Ctrl-C Message::
28557 * Console I/O::
28558 * List of Supported Calls::
28559 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
28560 * Constants::
28561 * File-I/O Examples::
28562 @end menu
28563
28564 @node File-I/O Overview
28565 @subsection File-I/O Overview
28566 @cindex file-i/o overview
28567
28568 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
28569 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
28570 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
28571 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
28572 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
28573 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
28574
28575 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
28576 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
28577 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
28578 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
28579 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
28580
28581 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
28582 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
28583 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
28584 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
28585 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
28586 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
28587 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
28588
28589 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
28590 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
28591 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
28592 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
28593 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
28594
28595 @smallexample
28596 (@value{GDBP}) continue
28597 <- target requests 'system call X'
28598 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
28599 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
28600 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
28601 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
28602 @end smallexample
28603
28604 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
28605 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
28606 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
28607 system are not supported by this protocol.
28608
28609 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
28610
28611 @node Protocol Basics
28612 @subsection Protocol Basics
28613 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
28614
28615 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
28616 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
28617 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
28618 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
28619 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
28620 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
28621 to call the appropriate host system call:
28622
28623 @itemize @bullet
28624 @item
28625 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
28626
28627 @item
28628 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
28629 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
28630 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
28631 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
28632
28633 @end itemize
28634
28635 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
28636
28637 @itemize @bullet
28638 @item
28639 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
28640 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
28641 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
28642 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
28643 packet.
28644
28645 @item
28646 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
28647 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
28648
28649 @item
28650 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
28651
28652 @item
28653 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
28654
28655 @item
28656 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
28657 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
28658 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
28659 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
28660 packet.
28661
28662 @end itemize
28663
28664 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
28665 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
28666
28667 @itemize @bullet
28668 @item
28669 Return value.
28670
28671 @item
28672 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
28673
28674 @item
28675 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
28676
28677 @end itemize
28678
28679 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
28680 the latest continue or step action.
28681
28682 @node The F Request Packet
28683 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
28684 @cindex file-i/o request packet
28685 @cindex @code{F} request packet
28686
28687 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
28688
28689 @table @samp
28690 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
28691
28692 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
28693 This is just the name of the function.
28694
28695 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
28696 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
28697 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
28698 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
28699 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
28700 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
28701 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
28702
28703 @end table
28704
28705
28706
28707 @node The F Reply Packet
28708 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
28709 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
28710 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
28711
28712 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
28713
28714 @table @samp
28715
28716 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
28717
28718 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
28719
28720 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
28721 representation.
28722 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
28723
28724 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
28725 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
28726 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
28727
28728 @smallexample
28729 F0,0,C
28730 @end smallexample
28731
28732 @noindent
28733 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
28734
28735 @smallexample
28736 F-1,4,C
28737 @end smallexample
28738
28739 @noindent
28740 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
28741
28742 @end table
28743
28744
28745 @node The Ctrl-C Message
28746 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
28747 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
28748
28749 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
28750 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
28751 the target should behave as if it had
28752 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
28753 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
28754 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
28755 packet.
28756
28757 It's important for the target to know in which
28758 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
28759
28760 @itemize @bullet
28761 @item
28762 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
28763
28764 @item
28765 The system call on the host has been finished.
28766
28767 @end itemize
28768
28769 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
28770 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
28771 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
28772 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
28773 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
28774 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
28775
28776 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
28777 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
28778 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
28779 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
28780 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
28781 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
28782 or the full action has been completed.
28783
28784 @node Console I/O
28785 @subsection Console I/O
28786 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
28787
28788 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
28789 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
28790 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
28791 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
28792 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
28793 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
28794 conditions is met:
28795
28796 @itemize @bullet
28797 @item
28798 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
28799 @code{read}
28800 system call is treated as finished.
28801
28802 @item
28803 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
28804 newline.
28805
28806 @item
28807 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
28808 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
28809
28810 @end itemize
28811
28812 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
28813 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
28814 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
28815 is stopped at the user's request.
28816
28817
28818 @node List of Supported Calls
28819 @subsection List of Supported Calls
28820 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
28821
28822 @menu
28823 * open::
28824 * close::
28825 * read::
28826 * write::
28827 * lseek::
28828 * rename::
28829 * unlink::
28830 * stat/fstat::
28831 * gettimeofday::
28832 * isatty::
28833 * system::
28834 @end menu
28835
28836 @node open
28837 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
28838 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
28839
28840 @table @asis
28841 @item Synopsis:
28842 @smallexample
28843 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
28844 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
28845 @end smallexample
28846
28847 @item Request:
28848 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
28849
28850 @noindent
28851 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
28852
28853 @table @code
28854 @item O_CREAT
28855 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
28856 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
28857 are concerned.
28858
28859 @item O_EXCL
28860 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
28861 an error and open() fails.
28862
28863 @item O_TRUNC
28864 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
28865 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
28866 truncated to zero length.
28867
28868 @item O_APPEND
28869 The file is opened in append mode.
28870
28871 @item O_RDONLY
28872 The file is opened for reading only.
28873
28874 @item O_WRONLY
28875 The file is opened for writing only.
28876
28877 @item O_RDWR
28878 The file is opened for reading and writing.
28879 @end table
28880
28881 @noindent
28882 Other bits are silently ignored.
28883
28884
28885 @noindent
28886 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
28887
28888 @table @code
28889 @item S_IRUSR
28890 User has read permission.
28891
28892 @item S_IWUSR
28893 User has write permission.
28894
28895 @item S_IRGRP
28896 Group has read permission.
28897
28898 @item S_IWGRP
28899 Group has write permission.
28900
28901 @item S_IROTH
28902 Others have read permission.
28903
28904 @item S_IWOTH
28905 Others have write permission.
28906 @end table
28907
28908 @noindent
28909 Other bits are silently ignored.
28910
28911
28912 @item Return value:
28913 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
28914 occurred.
28915
28916 @item Errors:
28917
28918 @table @code
28919 @item EEXIST
28920 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
28921
28922 @item EISDIR
28923 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
28924
28925 @item EACCES
28926 The requested access is not allowed.
28927
28928 @item ENAMETOOLONG
28929 @var{pathname} was too long.
28930
28931 @item ENOENT
28932 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
28933
28934 @item ENODEV
28935 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
28936
28937 @item EROFS
28938 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
28939 write access was requested.
28940
28941 @item EFAULT
28942 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
28943
28944 @item ENOSPC
28945 No space on device to create the file.
28946
28947 @item EMFILE
28948 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
28949
28950 @item ENFILE
28951 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
28952 has been reached.
28953
28954 @item EINTR
28955 The call was interrupted by the user.
28956 @end table
28957
28958 @end table
28959
28960 @node close
28961 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
28962 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
28963
28964 @table @asis
28965 @item Synopsis:
28966 @smallexample
28967 int close(int fd);
28968 @end smallexample
28969
28970 @item Request:
28971 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
28972
28973 @item Return value:
28974 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
28975
28976 @item Errors:
28977
28978 @table @code
28979 @item EBADF
28980 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
28981
28982 @item EINTR
28983 The call was interrupted by the user.
28984 @end table
28985
28986 @end table
28987
28988 @node read
28989 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
28990 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
28991
28992 @table @asis
28993 @item Synopsis:
28994 @smallexample
28995 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
28996 @end smallexample
28997
28998 @item Request:
28999 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
29000
29001 @item Return value:
29002 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
29003 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
29004 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
29005
29006 @item Errors:
29007
29008 @table @code
29009 @item EBADF
29010 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
29011 reading.
29012
29013 @item EFAULT
29014 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
29015
29016 @item EINTR
29017 The call was interrupted by the user.
29018 @end table
29019
29020 @end table
29021
29022 @node write
29023 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
29024 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
29025
29026 @table @asis
29027 @item Synopsis:
29028 @smallexample
29029 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
29030 @end smallexample
29031
29032 @item Request:
29033 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
29034
29035 @item Return value:
29036 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
29037 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
29038 is returned.
29039
29040 @item Errors:
29041
29042 @table @code
29043 @item EBADF
29044 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
29045 writing.
29046
29047 @item EFAULT
29048 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
29049
29050 @item EFBIG
29051 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
29052 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
29053
29054 @item ENOSPC
29055 No space on device to write the data.
29056
29057 @item EINTR
29058 The call was interrupted by the user.
29059 @end table
29060
29061 @end table
29062
29063 @node lseek
29064 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
29065 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
29066
29067 @table @asis
29068 @item Synopsis:
29069 @smallexample
29070 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
29071 @end smallexample
29072
29073 @item Request:
29074 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
29075
29076 @var{flag} is one of:
29077
29078 @table @code
29079 @item SEEK_SET
29080 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
29081
29082 @item SEEK_CUR
29083 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
29084 bytes.
29085
29086 @item SEEK_END
29087 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
29088 bytes.
29089 @end table
29090
29091 @item Return value:
29092 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
29093 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
29094 value of -1 is returned.
29095
29096 @item Errors:
29097
29098 @table @code
29099 @item EBADF
29100 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
29101
29102 @item ESPIPE
29103 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
29104
29105 @item EINVAL
29106 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
29107
29108 @item EINTR
29109 The call was interrupted by the user.
29110 @end table
29111
29112 @end table
29113
29114 @node rename
29115 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
29116 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
29117
29118 @table @asis
29119 @item Synopsis:
29120 @smallexample
29121 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
29122 @end smallexample
29123
29124 @item Request:
29125 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
29126
29127 @item Return value:
29128 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
29129
29130 @item Errors:
29131
29132 @table @code
29133 @item EISDIR
29134 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
29135 directory.
29136
29137 @item EEXIST
29138 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
29139
29140 @item EBUSY
29141 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
29142 process.
29143
29144 @item EINVAL
29145 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
29146 of itself.
29147
29148 @item ENOTDIR
29149 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
29150 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
29151 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
29152
29153 @item EFAULT
29154 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
29155
29156 @item EACCES
29157 No access to the file or the path of the file.
29158
29159 @item ENAMETOOLONG
29160
29161 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
29162
29163 @item ENOENT
29164 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
29165
29166 @item EROFS
29167 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
29168
29169 @item ENOSPC
29170 The device containing the file has no room for the new
29171 directory entry.
29172
29173 @item EINTR
29174 The call was interrupted by the user.
29175 @end table
29176
29177 @end table
29178
29179 @node unlink
29180 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
29181 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
29182
29183 @table @asis
29184 @item Synopsis:
29185 @smallexample
29186 int unlink(const char *pathname);
29187 @end smallexample
29188
29189 @item Request:
29190 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
29191
29192 @item Return value:
29193 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
29194
29195 @item Errors:
29196
29197 @table @code
29198 @item EACCES
29199 No access to the file or the path of the file.
29200
29201 @item EPERM
29202 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
29203
29204 @item EBUSY
29205 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
29206 being used by another process.
29207
29208 @item EFAULT
29209 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
29210
29211 @item ENAMETOOLONG
29212 @var{pathname} was too long.
29213
29214 @item ENOENT
29215 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
29216
29217 @item ENOTDIR
29218 A component of the path is not a directory.
29219
29220 @item EROFS
29221 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
29222
29223 @item EINTR
29224 The call was interrupted by the user.
29225 @end table
29226
29227 @end table
29228
29229 @node stat/fstat
29230 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
29231 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
29232 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
29233
29234 @table @asis
29235 @item Synopsis:
29236 @smallexample
29237 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
29238 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
29239 @end smallexample
29240
29241 @item Request:
29242 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
29243 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
29244
29245 @item Return value:
29246 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
29247
29248 @item Errors:
29249
29250 @table @code
29251 @item EBADF
29252 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
29253
29254 @item ENOENT
29255 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
29256 path is an empty string.
29257
29258 @item ENOTDIR
29259 A component of the path is not a directory.
29260
29261 @item EFAULT
29262 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
29263
29264 @item EACCES
29265 No access to the file or the path of the file.
29266
29267 @item ENAMETOOLONG
29268 @var{pathname} was too long.
29269
29270 @item EINTR
29271 The call was interrupted by the user.
29272 @end table
29273
29274 @end table
29275
29276 @node gettimeofday
29277 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
29278 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
29279
29280 @table @asis
29281 @item Synopsis:
29282 @smallexample
29283 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
29284 @end smallexample
29285
29286 @item Request:
29287 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
29288
29289 @item Return value:
29290 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
29291
29292 @item Errors:
29293
29294 @table @code
29295 @item EINVAL
29296 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
29297
29298 @item EFAULT
29299 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
29300 @end table
29301
29302 @end table
29303
29304 @node isatty
29305 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
29306 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
29307
29308 @table @asis
29309 @item Synopsis:
29310 @smallexample
29311 int isatty(int fd);
29312 @end smallexample
29313
29314 @item Request:
29315 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
29316
29317 @item Return value:
29318 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
29319
29320 @item Errors:
29321
29322 @table @code
29323 @item EINTR
29324 The call was interrupted by the user.
29325 @end table
29326
29327 @end table
29328
29329 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
29330 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
29331 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
29332 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
29333 needed.
29334
29335
29336 @node system
29337 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
29338 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
29339
29340 @table @asis
29341 @item Synopsis:
29342 @smallexample
29343 int system(const char *command);
29344 @end smallexample
29345
29346 @item Request:
29347 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
29348
29349 @item Return value:
29350 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
29351 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
29352 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
29353 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
29354 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
29355 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
29356 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
29357
29358 @item Errors:
29359
29360 @table @code
29361 @item EINTR
29362 The call was interrupted by the user.
29363 @end table
29364
29365 @end table
29366
29367 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
29368 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
29369 the host is simplified before it's returned
29370 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
29371 is discarded, and the return value consists
29372 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
29373
29374 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
29375 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
29376 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
29377
29378 @table @code
29379 @item set remote system-call-allowed
29380 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
29381 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
29382 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
29383
29384 @item show remote system-call-allowed
29385 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
29386 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
29387 protocol.
29388 @end table
29389
29390 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
29391 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
29392 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
29393
29394 @menu
29395 * Integral Datatypes::
29396 * Pointer Values::
29397 * Memory Transfer::
29398 * struct stat::
29399 * struct timeval::
29400 @end menu
29401
29402 @node Integral Datatypes
29403 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
29404 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
29405
29406 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
29407 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
29408 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
29409
29410 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
29411 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
29412
29413 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
29414
29415 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
29416 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
29417
29418 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
29419
29420 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
29421 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
29422 byte order.
29423
29424 @node Pointer Values
29425 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
29426 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
29427
29428 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
29429 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
29430 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
29431 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
29432
29433 @smallexample
29434 @code{1aaf/12}
29435 @end smallexample
29436
29437 @noindent
29438 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
29439 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
29440 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
29441 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
29442
29443 @smallexample
29444 @code{123456/d}
29445 @end smallexample
29446
29447 @node Memory Transfer
29448 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
29449 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
29450
29451 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
29452 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
29453 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
29454 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
29455 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
29456 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
29457 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
29458
29459
29460 @node struct stat
29461 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
29462 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
29463
29464 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
29465 is defined as follows:
29466
29467 @smallexample
29468 struct stat @{
29469 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
29470 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
29471 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
29472 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
29473 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
29474 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
29475 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
29476 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
29477 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
29478 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
29479 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
29480 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
29481 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
29482 @};
29483 @end smallexample
29484
29485 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
29486 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
29487 structure is of size 64 bytes.
29488
29489 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
29490 range of values.
29491
29492 @table @code
29493
29494 @item st_dev
29495 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
29496
29497 @item st_ino
29498 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
29499
29500 @item st_mode
29501 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
29502 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
29503
29504 @item st_uid
29505 @itemx st_gid
29506 @itemx st_rdev
29507 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
29508
29509 @item st_atime
29510 @itemx st_mtime
29511 @itemx st_ctime
29512 These values have a host and file system dependent
29513 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
29514 support exact timing values.
29515 @end table
29516
29517 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
29518 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
29519 continuing.
29520
29521 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
29522 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
29523 get truncated on the target.
29524
29525 @node struct timeval
29526 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
29527 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
29528
29529 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
29530 is defined as follows:
29531
29532 @smallexample
29533 struct timeval @{
29534 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
29535 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
29536 @};
29537 @end smallexample
29538
29539 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
29540 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
29541 structure is of size 8 bytes.
29542
29543 @node Constants
29544 @subsection Constants
29545 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
29546
29547 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
29548 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
29549 values before and after the call as needed.
29550
29551 @menu
29552 * Open Flags::
29553 * mode_t Values::
29554 * Errno Values::
29555 * Lseek Flags::
29556 * Limits::
29557 @end menu
29558
29559 @node Open Flags
29560 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
29561 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
29562
29563 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
29564
29565 @smallexample
29566 O_RDONLY 0x0
29567 O_WRONLY 0x1
29568 O_RDWR 0x2
29569 O_APPEND 0x8
29570 O_CREAT 0x200
29571 O_TRUNC 0x400
29572 O_EXCL 0x800
29573 @end smallexample
29574
29575 @node mode_t Values
29576 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
29577 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
29578
29579 All values are given in octal representation.
29580
29581 @smallexample
29582 S_IFREG 0100000
29583 S_IFDIR 040000
29584 S_IRUSR 0400
29585 S_IWUSR 0200
29586 S_IXUSR 0100
29587 S_IRGRP 040
29588 S_IWGRP 020
29589 S_IXGRP 010
29590 S_IROTH 04
29591 S_IWOTH 02
29592 S_IXOTH 01
29593 @end smallexample
29594
29595 @node Errno Values
29596 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
29597 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
29598
29599 All values are given in decimal representation.
29600
29601 @smallexample
29602 EPERM 1
29603 ENOENT 2
29604 EINTR 4
29605 EBADF 9
29606 EACCES 13
29607 EFAULT 14
29608 EBUSY 16
29609 EEXIST 17
29610 ENODEV 19
29611 ENOTDIR 20
29612 EISDIR 21
29613 EINVAL 22
29614 ENFILE 23
29615 EMFILE 24
29616 EFBIG 27
29617 ENOSPC 28
29618 ESPIPE 29
29619 EROFS 30
29620 ENAMETOOLONG 91
29621 EUNKNOWN 9999
29622 @end smallexample
29623
29624 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
29625 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
29626
29627 @node Lseek Flags
29628 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
29629 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
29630
29631 @smallexample
29632 SEEK_SET 0
29633 SEEK_CUR 1
29634 SEEK_END 2
29635 @end smallexample
29636
29637 @node Limits
29638 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
29639 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
29640
29641 All values are given in decimal representation.
29642
29643 @smallexample
29644 INT_MIN -2147483648
29645 INT_MAX 2147483647
29646 UINT_MAX 4294967295
29647 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
29648 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
29649 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
29650 @end smallexample
29651
29652 @node File-I/O Examples
29653 @subsection File-I/O Examples
29654 @cindex file-i/o examples
29655
29656 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
29657 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
29658
29659 @smallexample
29660 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
29661 @emph{request memory read from target}
29662 -> @code{m1234,6}
29663 <- XXXXXX
29664 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
29665 -> @code{F6}
29666 @end smallexample
29667
29668 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
29669 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
29670
29671 @smallexample
29672 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
29673 @emph{request memory write to target}
29674 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
29675 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
29676 -> @code{F6}
29677 @end smallexample
29678
29679 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
29680 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
29681
29682 @smallexample
29683 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
29684 -> @code{F-1,9}
29685 @end smallexample
29686
29687 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
29688 host is called:
29689
29690 @smallexample
29691 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
29692 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
29693 <- @code{T02}
29694 @end smallexample
29695
29696 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
29697 host is called:
29698
29699 @smallexample
29700 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
29701 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
29702 <- @code{T02}
29703 @end smallexample
29704
29705 @node Library List Format
29706 @section Library List Format
29707 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
29708
29709 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
29710 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
29711 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
29712 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
29713 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
29714 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
29715 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
29716 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
29717 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
29718 are loaded.
29719
29720 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
29721 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
29722 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
29723 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
29724
29725 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
29726 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
29727 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
29728 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
29729 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
29730 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
29731
29732 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
29733 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
29734
29735 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
29736 offset, looks like this:
29737
29738 @smallexample
29739 <library-list>
29740 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
29741 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
29742 </library>
29743 </library-list>
29744 @end smallexample
29745
29746 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
29747 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
29748
29749 @smallexample
29750 <library-list>
29751 <library name="sharedlib.o">
29752 <section address="0x10000000"/>
29753 <section address="0x20000000"/>
29754 <section address="0x30000000"/>
29755 </library>
29756 </library-list>
29757 @end smallexample
29758
29759 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
29760
29761 @smallexample
29762 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
29763 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
29764 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
29765 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
29766 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
29767 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
29768 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
29769 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
29770 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
29771 @end smallexample
29772
29773 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
29774 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
29775 section for each library.
29776
29777 @node Memory Map Format
29778 @section Memory Map Format
29779 @cindex memory map format
29780
29781 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
29782 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
29783 memory map.
29784
29785 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
29786 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
29787 lists memory regions.
29788
29789 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
29790 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
29791
29792 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
29793
29794 @smallexample
29795 <?xml version="1.0"?>
29796 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
29797 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
29798 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
29799 <memory-map>
29800 region...
29801 </memory-map>
29802 @end smallexample
29803
29804 Each region can be either:
29805
29806 @itemize
29807
29808 @item
29809 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
29810 bytes from there:
29811
29812 @smallexample
29813 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
29814 @end smallexample
29815
29816
29817 @item
29818 A region of read-only memory:
29819
29820 @smallexample
29821 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
29822 @end smallexample
29823
29824
29825 @item
29826 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
29827 bytes in length:
29828
29829 @smallexample
29830 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
29831 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
29832 </memory>
29833 @end smallexample
29834
29835 @end itemize
29836
29837 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
29838 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
29839 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
29840
29841 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
29842
29843 @smallexample
29844 <!-- ................................................... -->
29845 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
29846 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
29847 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
29848 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
29849 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
29850 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
29851 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
29852 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
29853 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
29854 and its type, or device. -->
29855 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
29856 start CDATA #REQUIRED
29857 length CDATA #REQUIRED
29858 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
29859 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
29860 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
29861 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
29862 @end smallexample
29863
29864 @include agentexpr.texi
29865
29866 @node Target Descriptions
29867 @appendix Target Descriptions
29868 @cindex target descriptions
29869
29870 @strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
29871 and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
29872 The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
29873
29874 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
29875 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
29876 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
29877 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
29878 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
29879 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
29880 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
29881
29882 @itemize @bullet
29883 @item
29884 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
29885 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
29886 @item
29887 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
29888 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
29889 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
29890 @item
29891 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
29892 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
29893 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
29894 @end itemize
29895
29896 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
29897 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
29898 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
29899 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
29900 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
29901
29902 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
29903 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
29904
29905 @menu
29906 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
29907 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
29908 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
29909 descriptions.
29910 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
29911 @end menu
29912
29913 @node Retrieving Descriptions
29914 @section Retrieving Descriptions
29915
29916 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
29917 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
29918 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
29919 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
29920 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
29921 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
29922 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
29923 Format}.
29924
29925 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
29926 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
29927 specify a file are:
29928
29929 @table @code
29930 @cindex set tdesc filename
29931 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
29932 Read the target description from @var{path}.
29933
29934 @cindex unset tdesc filename
29935 @item unset tdesc filename
29936 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
29937 will use the description supplied by the current target.
29938
29939 @cindex show tdesc filename
29940 @item show tdesc filename
29941 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
29942 @end table
29943
29944
29945 @node Target Description Format
29946 @section Target Description Format
29947 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
29948
29949 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
29950 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
29951 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
29952 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
29953 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
29954 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
29955 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
29956
29957 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
29958 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
29959 sets. @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
29960 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
29961
29962 Here is a simple target description:
29963
29964 @smallexample
29965 <target version="1.0">
29966 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
29967 </target>
29968 @end smallexample
29969
29970 @noindent
29971 This minimal description only says that the target uses
29972 the x86-64 architecture.
29973
29974 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
29975 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
29976 are explained further below.
29977
29978 @smallexample
29979 <?xml version="1.0"?>
29980 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
29981 <target version="1.0">
29982 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
29983 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
29984 </target>
29985 @end smallexample
29986
29987 @noindent
29988 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
29989 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
29990 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
29991 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
29992 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
29993 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
29994 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
29995 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
29996 the version mismatch.
29997
29998 @subsection Inclusion
29999 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
30000 @cindex XInclude
30001 @ifnotinfo
30002 @cindex <xi:include>
30003 @end ifnotinfo
30004
30005 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
30006 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
30007 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
30008 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
30009 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
30010
30011 @smallexample
30012 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
30013 @end smallexample
30014
30015 @noindent
30016 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
30017 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
30018 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
30019 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
30020 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
30021 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
30022 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
30023 original description.
30024
30025 @subsection Architecture
30026 @cindex <architecture>
30027
30028 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
30029
30030 @smallexample
30031 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
30032 @end smallexample
30033
30034 @var{arch} is an architecture name from the same selection
30035 accepted by @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a
30036 Debugging Target}).
30037
30038 @subsection Features
30039 @cindex <feature>
30040
30041 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
30042 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
30043 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
30044 has this form:
30045
30046 @smallexample
30047 <feature name="@var{name}">
30048 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
30049 @var{reg}@dots{}
30050 </feature>
30051 @end smallexample
30052
30053 @noindent
30054 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
30055 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
30056 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
30057 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
30058
30059 @subsection Types
30060
30061 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
30062 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
30063 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
30064 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
30065 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
30066
30067 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
30068 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
30069 Types must be defined before they are used.
30070
30071 @cindex <vector>
30072 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
30073 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
30074 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
30075 @var{count}:
30076
30077 @smallexample
30078 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
30079 @end smallexample
30080
30081 @cindex <union>
30082 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
30083 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
30084 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
30085 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
30086
30087 @smallexample
30088 <union id="@var{id}">
30089 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
30090 @dots{}
30091 </union>
30092 @end smallexample
30093
30094 @subsection Registers
30095 @cindex <reg>
30096
30097 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
30098
30099 @smallexample
30100 <reg name="@var{name}"
30101 bitsize="@var{size}"
30102 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
30103 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
30104 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
30105 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
30106 @end smallexample
30107
30108 @noindent
30109 The components are as follows:
30110
30111 @table @var
30112
30113 @item name
30114 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
30115
30116 @item bitsize
30117 The register's size, in bits.
30118
30119 @item regnum
30120 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
30121 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
30122 a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description
30123 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
30124 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
30125 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
30126 in order of increasing register number.
30127
30128 @item save-restore
30129 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
30130 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
30131 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
30132 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
30133 ABI.
30134
30135 @item type
30136 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
30137 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
30138 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
30139 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
30140 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
30141 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
30142
30143 @item group
30144 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
30145 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
30146 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
30147 in @code{info registers}.
30148
30149 @end table
30150
30151 @node Predefined Target Types
30152 @section Predefined Target Types
30153 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
30154
30155 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
30156 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
30157 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
30158 types. The currently supported types are:
30159
30160 @table @code
30161
30162 @item int8
30163 @itemx int16
30164 @itemx int32
30165 @itemx int64
30166 @itemx int128
30167 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
30168
30169 @item uint8
30170 @itemx uint16
30171 @itemx uint32
30172 @itemx uint64
30173 @itemx uint128
30174 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
30175
30176 @item code_ptr
30177 @itemx data_ptr
30178 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
30179 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
30180 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
30181 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
30182 may be marked as data pointers.
30183
30184 @item ieee_single
30185 Single precision IEEE floating point.
30186
30187 @item ieee_double
30188 Double precision IEEE floating point.
30189
30190 @item arm_fpa_ext
30191 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
30192
30193 @end table
30194
30195 @node Standard Target Features
30196 @section Standard Target Features
30197 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
30198
30199 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
30200 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
30201 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
30202 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
30203 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
30204 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
30205 can recognize them.
30206
30207 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
30208 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
30209 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
30210 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
30211 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
30212 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
30213 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
30214 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
30215
30216 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
30217 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
30218 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
30219
30220 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
30221 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
30222 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
30223 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
30224
30225 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
30226 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
30227 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
30228
30229 @menu
30230 * ARM Features::
30231 * MIPS Features::
30232 * M68K Features::
30233 * PowerPC Features::
30234 @end menu
30235
30236
30237 @node ARM Features
30238 @subsection ARM Features
30239 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
30240
30241 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for ARM targets.
30242 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
30243 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
30244
30245 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
30246 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
30247
30248 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
30249 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
30250 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
30251 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
30252
30253 @node MIPS Features
30254 @subsection MIPS Features
30255 @cindex target descriptions, MIPS features
30256
30257 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for MIPS targets.
30258 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
30259 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
30260 on the target.
30261
30262 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
30263 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
30264 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
30265
30266 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
30267 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
30268 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
30269 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
30270
30271 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
30272 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
30273 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
30274
30275 @node M68K Features
30276 @subsection M68K Features
30277 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
30278
30279 @table @code
30280 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
30281 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
30282 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
30283 One of those features must be always present.
30284 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
30285 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
30286 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
30287 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
30288
30289 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
30290 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
30291 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
30292 @samp{fpiaddr}.
30293 @end table
30294
30295 @node PowerPC Features
30296 @subsection PowerPC Features
30297 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
30298
30299 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
30300 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
30301 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
30302 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
30303
30304 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
30305 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
30306
30307 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
30308 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
30309 and @samp{vrsave}.
30310
30311 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
30312 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
30313 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
30314 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
30315 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
30316 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
30317
30318 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
30319 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
30320 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
30321 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
30322 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
30323 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
30324 user.
30325
30326 @node Operating System Information
30327 @appendix Operating System Information
30328 @cindex operating system information
30329
30330 @menu
30331 * Process list::
30332 @end menu
30333
30334 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
30335 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
30336 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
30337 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
30338 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
30339 on a different aspect of target.
30340
30341 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
30342 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
30343 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
30344 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
30345
30346 @node Process list
30347 @appendixsection Process list
30348 @cindex operating system information, process list
30349
30350 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
30351 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
30352 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
30353 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
30354
30355 An example document is:
30356
30357 @smallexample
30358 <?xml version="1.0"?>
30359 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
30360 <osdata type="processes">
30361 <item>
30362 <column name="pid">1</column>
30363 <column name="user">root</column>
30364 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
30365 </item>
30366 </osdata>
30367 @end smallexample
30368
30369 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
30370 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
30371 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
30372 displayed by @value{GDBN}. Target may provide additional columns,
30373 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
30374
30375 @include gpl.texi
30376
30377 @raisesections
30378 @include fdl.texi
30379 @lowersections
30380
30381 @node Index
30382 @unnumbered Index
30383
30384 @printindex cp
30385
30386 @tex
30387 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
30388 % meantime:
30389 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
30390 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
30391 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
30392 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
30393 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
30394 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
30395 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
30396 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
30397 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
30398 \page\colophon
30399 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
30400 @end tex
30401
30402 @bye
This page took 0.620683 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.